Preface SIMATIC HMI HMI Device TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) 1 Overview ______________ SIMATIC HMI HMI Device TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions Safety Instructions and General Notes 2 ______________ 3 Planning Use ______________ 4 Installation and connection ______________ Operator Controls and Displays 5 ______________ Configuring the Operating System 6 ______________ 7 Commissioning a project ______________ 8 Operating a Project ______________ 9 Operating Alarms ______________ 10 Operating Recipes ______________ 11 Maintenance and care ______________ 12 Specifications ______________ A Appendix ______________ Order no.: 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 08/2008 A5E01006556-03 B Abbreviations ______________ Safety Guidelines Safety Guidelines This manual contains notices you have to observe in order to ensure your personal safety, as well as to prevent damage to property. The notices referring to your personal safety are highlighted in the manual by a safety alert symbol, notices referring only to property damage have no safety alert symbol. These notices shown below are graded according to the degree of danger. DANGER indicates that death or severe personal injury will result if proper precautions are not taken. WARNING indicates that death or severe personal injury may result if proper precautions are not taken. CAUTION with a safety alert symbol, indicates that minor personal injury can result if proper precautions are not taken. CAUTION without a safety alert symbol, indicates that property damage can result if proper precautions are not taken. NOTICE indicates that an unintended result or situation can occur if the corresponding information is not taken into account. If more than one degree of danger is present, the warning notice representing the highest degree of danger will be used. A notice warning of injury to persons with a safety alert symbol may also include a warning relating to property damage. Qualified Personnel The device/system may only be set up and used in conjunction with this documentation. Commissioning and operation of a device/system may only be performed by qualified personnel. Within the context of the safety notes in this documentation qualified persons are defined as persons who are authorized to commission, ground and label devices, systems and circuits in accordance with established safety practices and standards. Prescribed Usage Note the following: WARNING This device may only be used for the applications described in the catalog or the technical description and only in connection with devices or components from other manufacturers which have been approved or recommended by Siemens. Correct, reliable operation of the product requires proper transport, storage, positioning and assembly as well as careful operation and maintenance. Trademarks All names identified by (R) are registered trademarks of the Siemens AG. The remaining trademarks in this publication may be trademarks whose use by third parties for their own purposes could violate the rights of the owner. Disclaimer of Liability We have reviewed the contents of this publication to ensure consistency with the hardware and software described. Since variance cannot be precluded entirely, we cannot guarantee full consistency. However, the information in this publication is reviewed regularly and any necessary corrections are included in subsequent editions. Siemens AG Industry Sector Postfach 48 48 90327 NURNBERG GERMANY Ordernumber: 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 08/2008 Copyright (c) Siemens AG 2008. Technical data subject to change Preface Purpose of the Operating Instructions These operating instructions provide information based on the requirements defined by DIN EN 62079 for mechanical engineering documentation. The information relates to the HMI device, its place of use, transportation, storage, installation, use, and maintenance. These operating instructions are intended for: Users Commissioning engineers Service technicians Maintenance technicians Please read the section "Safety instructions and general notes" carefully. The help integrated in WinCC flexible, the WinCC flexible Information System, contains detailed information. The information system contains instructions, examples and reference information in electronic form. Basic Knowledge Requirements General knowledge of automation technology and process communication is needed to understand the operating instructions. It is also assumed that those using the manual have experience in using personal computers and knowledge of Microsoft operating systems. Range of Validity for the Operating Instructions These operating instructions apply to the HMI devices TP 177A, TP 177B and OP 177B in combination with the WinCC flexible software package. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 3 Preface Position in the Information Scheme These operating instructions form part of the SIMATIC HMI documentation. The following provides an overview of the information landscape for SIMATIC HMI. User manuals WinCC flexible Micro Describes the basics of configuration with the WinCC flexible Micro engineering system. WinCC flexible Compact/Standard/Advanced Describes basic principles of configuration using the WinCC flexible Compact/ WinCC flexible Standard/WinCC flexible Advanced engineering systems. WinCC flexible Runtime Describes how to commission and operate your runtime project on a PC. WinCC flexible Migration - Describes how to convert an existing ProTool project to WinCC flexible. - Describes how to convert an existing WinCC project to WinCC flexible. - Describes how to convert an existing ProTool project including a change of the HMI device, for example from OP3 to OP 73 or from OP7 to OP 77B - Describes how to convert an existing ProTool project including a change from a graphics device to a Windows CE device. Communication - Communication Part 1 describes the connection of the HMI device to SIMATIC PLCs. - Communication Part 2 describes the connection of the HMI device to third-party controllers. 4 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Preface Operating instructions Operating instructions for SIMATIC HMI devices. - OP 73, OP 77A, OP 77B - TP 170micro, TP 170A, TP 170B, OP 170B - OP 73micro, TP 177micro - TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B - TP 270, OP 270 - MP 270B - MP 277 - MP 370 - MP 377 Operating instructions for mobile SIMATIC HMI devices - Mobile Panel 170 - Mobile Panel 177 - Mobile Panel 277 Operating Instructions(Compact) for SIMATIC HMI devices - OP 77B - Mobile Panel 170 - Mobile Panel 177 Getting Started WinCC flexible for first time users Based on an example project, this is a step-by-step introduction to the basics of configuring screens, alarms, recipes and screen navigation. WinCC flexible for power users Based on an example project, this is a step-by-step introduction to the basics of configuring logs, project reports, scripts, user management, multilingual projects and integration in STEP 7. WinCC flexible Options Based on an example project, this is a step-by-step introduction to the basics of configuring the WinCC flexible Sm@rtServices, Sm@rtAccess and OPC server options. Online Availability Technical documentation on SIMATIC products and SIMATIC systems is available in PDF format in various languages at the following addresses: SIMATIC Guide Technical Documentation: "http://www.automation.siemens.com/simatic/portal/html_00/techdoku.htm" TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 5 Preface Conventions Configuration and runtime software differ with regard to their names as follows: "WinCC flexible 2008," for example, refers to the configuration software. The term "WinCC flexible" is used in a general context. The full name, for example "WinCC flexible 2008", is always used when it is necessary to differentiate between different versions of the configuration software. "WinCC flexible Runtime" refers to the runtime software that can run on HMI devices. The name "TP 177B" is the umbrella term for the following HMI devices: TP 177B 4" TP 177B 6" Text is highlighted as follows to simplify reading the operating instructions: Notation Scope "Add screen" * * * Terms that appear in the user interface, for example, dialog names, tabs, buttons, menu commands Required input, for example, limits, tag values. Path information "File > Edit" Operator actions, for example, menu commands, shortcut menu commands. , Keyboard operation Please observe notes labeled as follows: Note Notes contain important information concerning the product, its use or a specific section of the documentation to which you should pay particular attention. Trademarks Names labeled with a (R) symbol are registered trademarks of the Siemens AG. Other names used in this documentation may be trademarks, the use of which by third parties for their own purposes could violate the rights of the owner. HMI(R) SIMATIC(R) SIMATIC HMI(R) SIMATIC ProTool(R) SIMATIC WinCC(R) SIMATIC WinCC flexible(R) SIMATIC TP 177A(R) SIMATIC TP 177B(R) SIMATIC OP 177B(R) 6 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Preface Representatives and offices If you have any further questions relating to the products described in this manual, please contact your local representative at the SIEMENS branch nearest you. You can locate your contact partner on this Internet URL: "http://www.siemens.com/automation/partner" Training Center Siemens AG offers a variety of training courses to familiarize you with automation systems. Please contact your regional Training Center, or the central Training Center in D90327 Nuremberg. Phone: +49 (911) 895-3200 Internet: "http://www.sitrain.com" Technical Support You can reach the Technical Support for all A&D products using the support request form on the web: "http://www.siemens.de/automation/support-request" Phone: + 49 180 5050 222 Fax: + 49 180 5050 223 For further information about Siemens Technical Support, refer to the Internet at "http://www.siemens.com/automation/support-request" Service & Support on the Internet Service & Support provides additional comprehensive information on SIMATIC products through online services at "http://support.automation.siemens.com:" The newsletter provides up-to-date information relating to your products. Our Service & Support search engine provides you access to all available documentation. A forum for global exchange of information by users and experts Current product information, FAQs and downloads Your local Automation & Drives representative Information about on-site services, repairs, spare parts and much more is available on our "Services" pages. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 7 Preface 8 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Table of contents Preface ...................................................................................................................................................... 3 1 2 3 4 Overview.................................................................................................................................................. 15 1.1 Product Overview.........................................................................................................................15 1.2 Design of the TP 177A HMI Device .............................................................................................16 1.3 Design of the TP 177B 6" HMI device .........................................................................................17 1.4 Design of the TP 177B 4" HMI device .........................................................................................19 1.5 Design of the OP 177B HMI Device ............................................................................................20 1.6 Accessories..................................................................................................................................22 1.7 Miscellaneous ..............................................................................................................................22 1.8 Functional scope with WinCC flexible..........................................................................................23 1.9 Software options ..........................................................................................................................26 1.10 Communication Using the TP 177A.............................................................................................26 1.11 Communication Using the TP 177B and OP 177B ......................................................................27 Safety Instructions and General Notes .................................................................................................... 29 2.1 Safety Information........................................................................................................................29 2.2 Standards and Approvals.............................................................................................................30 2.3 Notes about Usage ......................................................................................................................33 2.4 Electromagnetic Compatibility......................................................................................................36 2.5 Transport and Storage Conditions ...............................................................................................38 Planning Use ........................................................................................................................................... 39 3.1 Mounting Information ...................................................................................................................39 3.2 Mounting Positions and Fixation ..................................................................................................41 3.3 Preparing for Mounting ................................................................................................................43 3.4 Specifications for Insulation Tests, Protection Class and Degree of Protection..........................45 3.5 Nominal Voltages.........................................................................................................................45 Installation and connection ...................................................................................................................... 47 4.1 Checking the package contents...................................................................................................47 4.2 Mounting the HMI Device.............................................................................................................47 4.3 4.3.1 4.3.2 4.3.3 4.3.4 Connecting the HMI Device .........................................................................................................50 Interfaces on the TP 177A ...........................................................................................................51 Interfaces on the TP 177B 4".......................................................................................................51 Interfaces on the TP 177B 6".......................................................................................................52 Interfaces on the OP 177B...........................................................................................................52 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 9 Table of contents 5 6 10 4.3.5 4.3.6 4.3.7 4.3.8 4.3.9 4.3.10 4.3.11 Connecting the Equipotential Bonding Circuit............................................................................. 53 Connecting the Power Supply..................................................................................................... 55 Connecting uninterruptible power supply on the TP 177B 4" ..................................................... 58 Connecting the Controller ........................................................................................................... 58 Connecting a configuration PC ................................................................................................... 61 Connecting USB devices to TP 177B and OP 177B .................................................................. 65 Connecting printers to TP 177B and OP 177B ........................................................................... 66 4.4 Switching on and Testing the HMI Device .................................................................................. 68 Operator Controls and Displays............................................................................................................... 71 5.1 Front-side Operator Controls ...................................................................................................... 71 5.2 Connecting a memory card to the TP 177B 6" and OP 177B..................................................... 73 5.3 Insert a memory card in the TP 177B 4" ..................................................................................... 76 5.4 Labeling function keys on the TP 177B 4" and OP 177B ........................................................... 78 Configuring the Operating System ........................................................................................................... 81 6.1 6.1.1 6.1.2 6.1.2.1 6.1.2.2 6.1.2.3 6.1.2.4 6.1.2.5 6.1.2.6 6.1.2.7 6.1.2.8 6.1.2.9 Configuring the Operating System on the TP 177A.................................................................... 81 Overview ..................................................................................................................................... 81 Control Panel .............................................................................................................................. 82 Overview ..................................................................................................................................... 82 Changing Screen Settings .......................................................................................................... 84 Displaying Information about the HMI Device............................................................................. 86 Calibrating the Touch Screen ..................................................................................................... 87 Display License Information ........................................................................................................ 89 Changing the Password Settings................................................................................................ 89 Changing MPI/DP Settings ......................................................................................................... 91 Setting the Screen Saver ............................................................................................................ 92 Configuring the Data Channel..................................................................................................... 93 6.2 6.2.1 6.2.2 6.2.2.1 6.2.2.2 6.2.2.3 6.2.2.4 6.2.2.5 6.2.2.6 6.2.2.7 6.2.2.8 6.2.2.9 6.2.2.10 6.2.2.11 6.2.2.12 6.2.2.13 6.2.2.14 6.2.2.15 6.2.2.16 6.2.2.17 6.2.2.18 6.2.2.19 6.2.2.20 6.2.2.21 6.2.2.22 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B................................................ 96 Overview ..................................................................................................................................... 96 Control Panel .............................................................................................................................. 98 Overview ..................................................................................................................................... 98 Input Using the Screen Keyboard ............................................................................................. 100 Configuring the Screen Keyboard............................................................................................. 101 Setting the Character Repeat for the Screen Keyboard ........................................................... 103 Setting the Double-click on the Touch Screen.......................................................................... 104 Backup and Restore Using a Memory Card ............................................................................. 105 Setting the Date and Time ........................................................................................................ 108 Saving Registry Information ...................................................................................................... 109 Changing Screen Contrast........................................................................................................ 111 Displaying Information about the HMI Device........................................................................... 112 Calibrating the Touch Screen ................................................................................................... 113 Changing the Password Settings.............................................................................................. 115 Changing Printer Settings ......................................................................................................... 116 Changing Regional Settings ..................................................................................................... 118 Changing MPI/PROFIBUS DP Settings.................................................................................... 119 Setting the Delay Time.............................................................................................................. 123 Setting the Screen Saver .......................................................................................................... 124 Displaying System Information ................................................................................................. 125 Configuring the Data Channel................................................................................................... 126 Overview of Network Operation ................................................................................................ 129 Setting the Device Name of the HMI Device............................................................................. 131 Activating a Direct Connection.................................................................................................. 132 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Table of contents 6.2.2.23 Changing Network Settings .......................................................................................................133 6.2.2.24 Changing the Logon Information................................................................................................135 6.2.2.25 Changing Internet Settings ........................................................................................................136 6.3 6.3.1 6.3.2 6.3.3 6.3.3.1 6.3.3.2 6.3.3.3 6.3.3.4 6.3.3.5 6.3.4 6.3.4.1 6.3.4.2 6.3.4.3 6.3.4.4 6.3.5 6.3.6 6.3.6.1 6.3.6.2 6.3.6.3 6.3.6.4 6.3.6.5 6.3.6.6 6.3.6.7 6.3.6.8 6.3.6.9 6.3.6.10 6.3.6.11 6.3.7 6.3.8 6.3.9 6.3.10 6.3.10.1 6.3.10.2 6.3.11 6.3.11.1 6.3.11.2 6.3.11.3 6.3.11.4 6.3.11.5 6.3.11.6 6.3.12 6.3.12.1 6.3.12.2 6.3.13 7 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4"................................................................138 Loader ........................................................................................................................................138 Setting up and disabling SecureMode .......................................................................................140 Control Panel .............................................................................................................................141 Overview ....................................................................................................................................141 Opening the Control Panel.........................................................................................................142 Reference for functions..............................................................................................................142 Operator control options for the Control Panel ..........................................................................144 Operating the Control Panel with the touch screen ...................................................................144 Changing settings for operation .................................................................................................146 Configuring the screen keyboard ...............................................................................................146 Setting the character repeat.......................................................................................................147 Setting the double-click..............................................................................................................148 Calibrating the touch screen ......................................................................................................150 Changing password protection ..................................................................................................151 Changing the HMI device settings .............................................................................................153 Setting the date and time ...........................................................................................................153 Changing regional settings ........................................................................................................155 Backup registry information .......................................................................................................156 Changing monitor settings .........................................................................................................157 Setting the screen saver ............................................................................................................158 Changing the printer properties .................................................................................................160 Restarting the HMI device..........................................................................................................162 Displaying information about the HMI device ............................................................................164 Displaying system properties .....................................................................................................165 Displaying memory distribution ..................................................................................................166 Activate memory management ..................................................................................................167 Setting storage location .............................................................................................................168 Setting the delay time ................................................................................................................169 Enabling PROFINET IO .............................................................................................................170 Changing transfer settings .........................................................................................................172 Configuring the data channel .....................................................................................................172 Changing MPI/PROFIBUS DP settings .....................................................................................175 Network operation......................................................................................................................178 Overview ....................................................................................................................................178 Setting the device name of the HMI device ...............................................................................180 Changing the network configuration ..........................................................................................181 Changing the logon data............................................................................................................183 Changing e-mail settings ...........................................................................................................184 Importing and deleting certificates .............................................................................................185 Backup and restore....................................................................................................................186 Saving to external storage device (backup)...............................................................................186 Restoring from external storage device .....................................................................................188 Setting the uninterruptible power supply....................................................................................190 Commissioning a project ....................................................................................................................... 193 7.1 7.1.1 7.1.2 7.1.3 Overview ....................................................................................................................................193 Setting the Operating Mode .......................................................................................................195 Reusing Existing Projects ..........................................................................................................196 Data Transmission Options........................................................................................................197 7.2 7.2.1 Transfer......................................................................................................................................198 Overview ....................................................................................................................................198 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 11 Table of contents 8 12 7.2.2 7.2.3 7.2.4 Starting Manual Transfer........................................................................................................... 199 Starting Automatic Transfer ...................................................................................................... 200 Testing a Project ....................................................................................................................... 202 7.3 7.3.1 7.3.2 7.3.3 Backup and Restore.................................................................................................................. 203 Overview ................................................................................................................................... 203 Backup and Restore using WinCC flexible ............................................................................... 204 Backup and Restore using ProSave ......................................................................................... 206 7.4 7.4.1 7.4.2 7.4.3 7.4.4 Updating operating systems on the TP 177A, TP 177B 6" and OP 177B ................................ 208 Overview ................................................................................................................................... 208 Resetting to factory settings...................................................................................................... 209 Updating the operating system with WinCC flexible ................................................................. 209 Updating the operating system with ProSave ........................................................................... 211 7.5 7.5.1 7.5.2 7.5.3 7.5.4 7.5.5 7.5.6 Updating the operating system on the TP 177B 4"................................................................... 212 Overview ................................................................................................................................... 212 Resetting factory settings.......................................................................................................... 213 Updating the operating system using WinCC flexible............................................................... 214 Updating the operating system using ProSave......................................................................... 215 Resetting to factory settings with WinCC flexible ..................................................................... 216 Resetting to factory settings with ProSave ............................................................................... 218 7.6 7.6.1 7.6.2 7.6.3 Installing and Removing Options .............................................................................................. 221 Overview ................................................................................................................................... 221 Installing and Removing Options using WinCC flexible............................................................ 221 Installing and removing options using ProSave........................................................................ 223 7.7 7.7.1 7.7.2 Transfering License Keys and Transfering Them Back............................................................ 224 Overview ................................................................................................................................... 224 Transferring and transferring back license keys ....................................................................... 225 Operating a Project................................................................................................................................ 227 8.1 8.1.1 8.1.2 8.1.3 8.1.3.1 8.1.3.2 8.1.3.3 8.1.3.4 8.1.3.5 8.1.3.6 8.1.4 8.1.4.1 8.1.4.2 8.1.4.3 8.1.4.4 8.1.4.5 8.1.4.6 8.1.5 8.1.6 8.1.6.1 8.1.6.2 Operating a Project on the TP 177A ......................................................................................... 227 Overview ................................................................................................................................... 227 Setting the Project Language.................................................................................................... 229 Entries and Help within a Project .............................................................................................. 230 Overview ................................................................................................................................... 230 Entering and Editing Numerical Values .................................................................................... 231 Entering and Editing Alphanumerical Values............................................................................ 233 Entering and Editing Symbolic Values ...................................................................................... 235 Entering and Modifying the Date and Time............................................................................... 236 Viewing infotext ......................................................................................................................... 236 Project security.......................................................................................................................... 237 Overview ................................................................................................................................... 237 User logon................................................................................................................................. 239 User logoff................................................................................................................................. 240 Create user ............................................................................................................................... 241 Changing user data................................................................................................................... 242 Deleting a user .......................................................................................................................... 243 Closing the project .................................................................................................................... 244 Operating the Trend View ......................................................................................................... 244 Overview ................................................................................................................................... 244 Operating the Trend View ......................................................................................................... 245 8.2 8.2.1 8.2.2 8.2.3 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B......................................................................... 246 Overview ................................................................................................................................... 246 Operating keys on the TP 177B 4" and OP 177B..................................................................... 248 Direct keys ................................................................................................................................ 249 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Table of contents 8.2.4 8.2.5 8.2.5.1 8.2.5.2 8.2.5.3 8.2.5.4 8.2.5.5 8.2.5.6 8.2.5.7 8.2.6 8.2.7 8.2.8 8.2.9 8.2.10 8.2.11 8.2.11.1 8.2.11.2 8.2.12 8.2.12.1 8.2.12.2 8.2.12.3 8.2.12.4 8.2.12.5 8.2.12.6 8.2.13 9 10 Setting the project language ......................................................................................................250 Entries and help within a project ................................................................................................250 Overview ....................................................................................................................................250 Entering numerical values on the TP 177A, TP 177B and OP 177B.........................................252 Entering alphanumerical values on the TP 177A, TP 177B 6" and OP 177B ...........................254 Entering alphanumerical values on the TP 177B 4" ..................................................................256 Entering and editing symbolic values ........................................................................................258 Entering the Date and Time .......................................................................................................258 Viewing Infotext..........................................................................................................................259 Operating a Gauge ....................................................................................................................260 Using Switches...........................................................................................................................261 Using a Slider.............................................................................................................................262 Using the Status Force Display..................................................................................................263 Operating the Sm@rtClient View...............................................................................................265 Operating Trends .......................................................................................................................267 Overview ....................................................................................................................................267 Operating the Trend View ..........................................................................................................268 Project Security ..........................................................................................................................269 Overview ....................................................................................................................................269 User Logon.................................................................................................................................271 User Logoff.................................................................................................................................272 Creating a User ..........................................................................................................................273 Changing User Data ..................................................................................................................274 Deleting a User ..........................................................................................................................276 Closing the Project.....................................................................................................................278 Operating Alarms................................................................................................................................... 279 9.1 9.1.1 9.1.2 9.1.3 9.1.4 Operating Alarms TP 177A ........................................................................................................279 Overview ....................................................................................................................................279 Displaying Alarms ......................................................................................................................280 Acknowledging Alarms...............................................................................................................282 Editing Alarms ............................................................................................................................283 9.2 9.2.1 9.2.2 9.2.3 9.2.4 Operating Alarms on TP 177B and OP 177B ............................................................................284 Overview ....................................................................................................................................284 Displaying Alarms ......................................................................................................................285 Acknowledging Alarms...............................................................................................................288 Editing Alarms ............................................................................................................................289 Operating Recipes ................................................................................................................................. 291 10.1 Overview ....................................................................................................................................291 10.2 Structure of a recipe...................................................................................................................292 10.3 Recipes in the Project ................................................................................................................294 10.4 Displaying a Recipe ...................................................................................................................296 10.5 Recipe Values in the HMI Device and the PLC .........................................................................299 10.6 10.6.1 10.6.2 10.6.3 10.6.4 10.6.5 10.6.6 10.6.7 Operating the Enhanced Recipe View.......................................................................................300 Overview ....................................................................................................................................300 Creating a recipe data record ....................................................................................................302 Editing a recipe data record .......................................................................................................303 Deleting a recipe data record.....................................................................................................304 Synchronizing Tags on the TP 177B and OP 177B...................................................................305 Reading a recipe data record from the PLC ..............................................................................306 Transferring a recipe data record to the PLC ............................................................................307 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 13 Table of contents 11 12 A B 10.7 10.7.1 10.7.2 10.7.3 10.7.4 10.7.5 10.7.6 Operating the Simple Recipe View ........................................................................................... 308 Overview ................................................................................................................................... 308 Creating a Recipe Data Record ................................................................................................ 310 Editing a Recipe Data Record................................................................................................... 311 Deleting a Recipe Data Record ................................................................................................ 312 Reading a Recipe Data Record from the PLC .......................................................................... 313 Transferring a Recipe Data Record to the PLC ........................................................................ 314 10.8 Exporting Recipe Data Records on the TP 177B and OP 177B............................................... 315 10.9 Importing Recipe Data Records on the TP 177B and OP 177B ............................................... 316 Maintenance and care ........................................................................................................................... 317 11.1 11.1.1 11.1.2 11.1.3 11.1.4 Maintenance and Service.......................................................................................................... 317 Maintenance and care............................................................................................................... 317 Clean screen on the TP 177A and TP 177B 6" ........................................................................ 318 Protective Membrane ................................................................................................................ 318 Protective covers on the TP 177A and TP 177B 6" .................................................................. 319 11.2 Service and spare parts ............................................................................................................ 323 Specifications ........................................................................................................................................ 325 12.1 Dimension drawings of the TP 177B 4" .................................................................................... 325 12.2 Dimension drawings of the TP 177A and TP 177B 6" .............................................................. 326 12.3 Dimension Drawings of the OP 177B ....................................................................................... 327 12.4 Specifications of the TP 177A................................................................................................... 328 12.5 Technical specifications of the TP 177B 4"............................................................................... 329 12.6 Technical specifications of the TP 177B 6"............................................................................... 330 12.7 Specifications of the OP 177B .................................................................................................. 331 12.8 12.8.1 12.8.2 12.8.3 12.8.4 Description of the Interfaces ..................................................................................................... 332 Power Supply ............................................................................................................................ 332 X10/IF 1B (RS 422/RS 485)...................................................................................................... 332 X20 (USB) ................................................................................................................................. 333 X1 (PROFINET) ........................................................................................................................ 333 Appendix................................................................................................................................................ 335 A.1 ESD Guidelines......................................................................................................................... 335 A.2 System Alarms .......................................................................................................................... 337 Abbreviations......................................................................................................................................... 363 Glossary ................................................................................................................................................ 365 Index...................................................................................................................................................... 371 14 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 1 Overview 1.1 Product Overview Advanced applications with the Touch Panels TP 177A, TP 177B and OP 177B The 177 series of panels represents a further advance in the development of the well-known 170 HMI devices. The new TP 177A, TP 177B and OP 177B panels make for more efficient use of text or graphic-based projects for simple to medium level HMI operating and monitoring tasks in machines and plants. Projects with Asian and Cyrillic character sets can be configured, as usual. The ability to vertically mount the TP 177A and the non-volatile alarm buffer of the TP 177B offer new application possibilities. In addition, the TP 177B and OP 177B - depending on the models - provide interfaces for connecting to PROFIBUS and PROFINET. The TP 177B 4" features a 4.3" TFT display with wide-screen format. This display extends the visible area on the HMI device by approximately 25 % compared to similar displays with 4:3 format. The HMI device also features four function keys with tactile feedback. In combination with the intuitive touch operation, it offers maximum operating efficiency. In addition to MMC cards, the TP 177B 4" supports SD cards and USB memory sticks. OP 177B offers an additional feature. It can now be operated using widely-available touch screens in addition to the membrane keyboard. The function keys can be configured to system keys for specific screens. The TP 177A, TP 177B and OP 177B panels offer quick commissioning times, large user memory and high performance, and they are optimized for projects based on WinCC flexible. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 15 Overview 1.2 Design of the TP 177A HMI Device 1.2 Design of the TP 177A HMI Device Front view and side view Opening caused by design - not a slot for a memory card Display / touch screen Mounting seal Mounting clamp recess Bottom view 16 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Overview 1.3 Design of the TP 177B 6" HMI device Rear view 1.3 Opening caused by design - not a slot for a memory card Rating label DIP switch Interface name Design of the TP 177B 6" HMI device Front view and side view Slot for a MultiMedia card Display / touch screen Mounting seal Mounting clamp recess TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 17 Overview 1.3 Design of the TP 177B 6" HMI device Bottom view of a TP 177B 6" DP Bottom view of a TP 177B 6" PN/DP Rear view 18 Slot for a MultiMedia card Rating label DIP switch Interface name TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Overview 1.4 Design of the TP 177B 4" HMI device 1.4 Design of the TP 177B 4" HMI device Front view and side view Display / touch screen Slot for a MultiMedia / Secure Digital card Recess for mounting clamps Mounting seal Bottom view Interfaces Recess for mounting clamps TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 19 Overview 1.5 Design of the OP 177B HMI Device Rear view 1.5 Slot for a MultiMedia / Secure Digital card Rating label DIP switch Interface name Design of the OP 177B HMI Device Front view and side view 20 Slot for a MultiMedia card Display / touch screen Recesses for mounting clamps Mounting seal TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Overview 1.5 Design of the OP 177B HMI Device Bottom view of an OP 177B DP Bottom view of an OP 177B PN/DP Rear view Slot for a MultiMedia card Rating label DIP switch Interface name TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 21 Overview 1.6 Accessories 1.6 Accessories Accessory kit The accessory kit contains the following: For the power supply: a plug-in terminal strip To install the TP 177A, TP 177B 6", and the OP 177B: Plastic mounting clamps For the installation of the TP 177B 4": Metal mounting clamps Additional documents may be enclosed with the accessory kit. 1.7 Miscellaneous RS 422 / RS 232 converter The converter is required to connect a SIMATIC S5 controller and controllers from other manufacturers. Connect the RS 422-RS 232 converter to the RS 422 / RS 485 interface. The converter converts the input signals to RS-232 signals. The converter is not part of the scope of delivery of the HMI device. The converter can be ordered separately using order number 6AV6 671-8XE00-0AX0. PC / PPI cable You need the PC / PPI cable for TP 177A, TP 177B 6" and OP 177B to update the operating system by resetting it to the factory settings. In addition, with TP 177B and OP 177B you can use the cable for transferring purposes. Connect the PC/PPI cable to the RS 422/RS 485 interface. The cable converts the input signals to RS-232 signals. The cable is not included the scope of delivery for the HMI device. The cable can be ordered separately under the order number 6ES7 901-3CB30-0XA0. Note If the connection fails during the operating system update, set the system to a lower bit rate. If you use a higher bit rate, you must use the PC / PPI cable release 3 or higher. The version code is printed on the cable (e.g., "E stand 3" corresponds to version 3). 90 elbow adapter If space is limited, e.g. to install the TP 177A in vertical format, you can use an elbow adapter at the RS 422 / RS 485 interface. The adapter is not part of the scope of delivery of the HMI device. The adapter can be ordered separately with order number 6AV6 671-8XD00-0XA0. 22 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Overview 1.8 Functional scope with WinCC flexible PROFIBUS bus connector We recommend using straight PROFIBUS bus connectors. The connectors are not included in the scope of supply for the HMI device. The connectors can be ordered separately with order number 6GK1 500-0FC10. Memory card Only use SD memory cards or MultiMediaCards tested and approved by Siemens AG for the respective HMI device. Protective foil Protective foil is available for the HMI devices. Suitable protective foil can be ordered separately under the following order numbers: TP 177A, TP 177B 6", OP 177B: Order number 6AV6 671-2XC00-0AX0 TP 177B 4": Order number 6AV6 671-2EC00-0AX0 Protective cover set A protective cover set can be ordered for the TP 177A and TP 177B 6" HMI devices with the order number 6AV6 574-1AE00-4AX0. 1.8 Functional scope with WinCC flexible General The following tables show the objects which can be integrated in a project for a TP 177A, TP 177B and OP 177B. Note The specified values are maximum values for the respective objects. It is not possible to use the maximum values for all objects because the available memory of the HMI device is limited. For additional information on calculation of the system limits see the WinCC flexible online help. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 23 Overview 1.8 Functional scope with WinCC flexible Alarms Object Specification TP 177A Alarm Number of discrete alarms 1000 2000 Number of analog alarms 15 50 Length of the alarm text Max. 8 Display Alarm view, Alarm window Acknowledge single error alarms Yes Yes Edit alarm Memory characteristics Yes Volatile Alarm buffer capacity Non-volatile 256 alarms Simultaneously queued alarm events Max. 64 View alarm Yes Delete alarm buffer Print alarm line by line 16 acknowledgment groups Yes Alarm indicator Alarm buffer OP 177B 80 characters Number of tags in an alarm Acknowledge several error alarms simultaneously (group acknowledgement) TP 177B Yes No Yes Tags, Values, Lists and Calculation Functions Object Specification Tag Number TP 177A TP 177B 500 OP 177B 1000 Limit monitoring Input/Output Yes Linear scaling Input/Output Yes Text List Number 300 Screens Object Specification Screen Number TP 177B 250 OP 177B 500 Fields per screen 30 50 Tags per screen 30 50 Complex objects per screen (e.g. bars) Template 24 TP 177A 5 Yes TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Overview 1.8 Functional scope with WinCC flexible Recipes Object Specification TP 177A TP 177B OP 177B Recipe Number 5 100 Data Records per Recipe 20 200 Entries per Recipe 20 200 Recipe screens No Yes Info texts Object Specification Infotext Length (no. of characters) TP 177A TP 177B 320 For alarms Yes For screens Yes For screen objects (e.g. IO fields) Yes OP 177B Additional functions Object Specification TP 177A Screen settings Touch screen calibration Yes Contrast setting Yes 1) TP 177B OP 177B Yes Brightness setting2) Screen saver - Language change Number of languages Yes Graphic object Vector and pixel graphics Trend views Number 25 50 Trends per view Number 4 8 5 16 Yes Task Planner Number of tasks - 10 Text object Number 1000 2500 Security Number of Users 100 50 1) not with TP 177B 4" 2) not with TP 177B 4" TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 25 Overview 1.9 Software options 1.9 Software options The following software options are available for the TP 177B and the OP 177B: WinCC Flexible/Sm@rtService The Sm@rtService option enables you to access a remote HMI device from the HMI device or PC via Ethernet. WinCC Flexible/Sm@rtAccess The Sm@rtAccess option enables you to set up communication between different HMI systems. The following software options are available for the TP 177B 4": Uninterruptable Power Supply (UPS) with USB support When interfacing an uninterruptible power supply, the HMI device is shut down in a controlled manner after a buffer time in the event of a power failure. The TP 177B 4" supports SITOP DC UPS modules connected via the USB port. 1.10 Communication Using the TP 177A Number of Connections Interconnection TP 177A Number with MPI/PROFIBUS DP 4 (on the same bus) Siemens Controllers The following table shows the Siemens controllers and protocols or profiles that can be used. Controller Protocol/Profile SIMATIC S7-200 PPI yes MPI 1) yes MPI yes PROFIBUS DP up to 1.5 Mbps yes PROFIBUS DP up to 12 Mbps no SIMATIC S7-300/400 1) 26 TP 177A If you require a baud rate of 9.6 Kbps, use the "DP" profile in WinCC flexible TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Overview 1.11 Communication Using the TP 177B and OP 177B 1.11 Communication Using the TP 177B and OP 177B Number of Connections Interconnection TP 177B Number using a point-to-point connection OP 177B 1 Number using a bus connection 4 on the same bus Siemens Controllers The following table shows the Siemens controllers and protocols or profiles that can be used. Controller Protocol/Profile TP 177B 4" PN/DP TP 177B 6" DP TP 177B 6" PN/DP OP 177B DP OP 177B PN/DP SIMATIC S7-300/400 MPI Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes PROFIBUS DP up to 12 Mbps Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes No Yes No Yes PROFINET SIMATIC S5 PROFIBUS DP up to 12 Mbps Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes SIMATIC S7-200 PPI Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes MPI Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes PROFIBUS DP CPU 215 Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes PROFIBUS DP standard Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes SIMATIC 500/505 NITP Yes PROFIBUS DP up to 12 Mbps 1) 1) Yes Yes 1) Yes Yes 1) Yes PROFINET IO must be locked. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 27 Overview 1.11 Communication Using the TP 177B and OP 177B Third-party controllers The following table shows controllers of other manufacturers and protocols or profiles that can be used. Controller Protocol Allen-Bradley PLC series SLC500, SLC501, SLC502, SLC503, SLC504, SLC505, MicroLogix * * * * DF1 1) 3) 4) 6) DH+ via DF1 gateway (KF2 module) 2) 3) 4) 6) DH485 via DF1 gateway (via KF3 module)3) 4) 6) DH485 Allen Bradley PLC series PLC 5/11, PLC5/20, PLC 5/30, PLC 5/40, PLC 5/40L, PLC 5/60, PLC 5/60L, PLC 5/80 * * DF1 4) 6) DH+ via DF1 gateway (KF2 module) 3) 4) 6) Allen Bradley * Ethernet/IP 5) PLC series ControlLogix 5500 (with 1756-ENBT) and CompactLogix 5300 (1769-L32E and 1769-L35E) GE Fanuc Automation PLC series 90-30, 90-70, 90-Micro SNP 4) 6) LG Industrial Systems (Lucky Goldstar)/IMO PLC series GLOFA-GM/G4, G6, G7M Dedicated communication 4) 6) Mitsubishi Electric PLC series MELSEC FX, MELSEC FX0 FX (Mitsubishi PG) 4) 6) Mitsubishi Melsec PLC series FX, A, Ans, Q, QnAS Protocol 4 4) 6) Modicon (Schneider Automation) * Modbus RTU 3) 4) 6) PLC series Compact and 984 via Ethernet bridge * Modbus TCP/IP (Ethernet) 5) OMRON PLC series SYSMAC C, SYSMAC CV, SYSMAC CS1, SYSMAC alpha, CP Hostlink/Multilink (SYSMAC Way) 4) 6) Telemecanique Uni-Telway 4) 6) PLC series Modicon 984, TSX Quantum and TSX Compact PLC series Quantum, Momentum, Premium und Micro PLC series: * TSX 7 with P47 411 * TSX 7 with P47/67/87/107 420 * TSX 7 with P47/67/87/107 425 * Module TSX SCM 21.6 with the aforementioned TSX 7 CPUs * TSX 17 with module SCG 1161 * TSX 37 (Micro) * TSX 57 (Premium) 28 1) Applies to controllers SLC503, SLC504, SLC505, MicroLogix 2) Applies to controllers SLC504, via DF1. 3) Only with converter RS 422-RS 232 6AV6 671-8XE00-0AX0 (Option) 4) PROFINET IO must be locked. 5) Not approved for TP 177B 6" DP or OP 177B DP 6) Deactivate the "Remote Control" check box under "Channel 1" in the "Transfer Settings". TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Safety Instructions and General Notes 2.1 Safety Information Safety Instructions and General Notes 2.1 2 Safety Information Working on the cabinet WARNING Open equipment The HMI device is an open equipment. This means that the HMI device may only be installed in cubicles or cabinets, whereby the device can be operated from the front panel. Access to the cubicle or cabinet in which the HMI device is installed should only be possible by means of a key or tool and for personnel who have received instruction or are authorized. Danger, high voltage Opening the cabinet will expose high voltage parts. Contact with these parts could be fatal. Switch off the power supply to the cabinet before opening it. Hazardous areas When operating the HMI device in hazardous areas the following warning applies. WARNING Explosion Hazard Do not disconnect while circuit is live unless area is known to be non-hazardous. Substitution of components may impair suitability for Class I, Division 2 or Zone 2. High frequency radiation NOTICE Unintentional operating situations High frequency radiation, from mobile phones for example, can cause unintentional operating situations. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 29 Safety Instructions and General Notes 2.2 Standards and Approvals 2.2 Standards and Approvals Valid certifications CAUTION Valid certifications The overview below provides information on available certifications. The HMI device itself is certified as shown on the label on its rear panel. CE Certification The automation system meets the general and safety-related requirements of the following EC directives and conforms to the harmonized European standards (EN) for programmable logic controllers published in the official gazettes of the European Union: 2004/108/EC "Electromagnetic Compatibility" (EMC Directive) 94/9/EC "Equipment and Protective Systems Intended for Use in Potentially Explosive Atmospheres" (Explosion Protection Directive) EC Declaration of Conformity The EC Declarations of Conformity are available to the relevant authorities at the following address: Siemens Aktiengesellschaft Industry Sector I IA AS RD ST PLC P.O. Box 1963 D-92209 Amberg 30 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Safety Instructions and General Notes 2.2 Standards and Approvals UL approval Underwriters Laboratories Inc. conforming to UL 508 (Industrial Control Equipment) CSA C22.2 No. 142, (Process Control Equipment) or Underwriters Laboratories Inc. conforming to UL 508 (Industrial Control Equipment) CSA C22.2 No. 142, (Process Control Equipment) UL 1604 (Hazardous Location) CSA-213 (Hazardous Location) Approved for use in Class I, Division 2, Group A, B, C, D or Class I, Zone 2, Group IIC or non-hazardous locations FM Approval FM APPROVED Factory Mutual Research (FM) conforming to Approval Standard Class Number 3611, 3600, 3810 Approved for use in Class I, Division 2, Group A, B, C, D T4 Class I, Zone 2, Group IIC T4 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 31 Safety Instructions and General Notes 2.2 Standards and Approvals Ex Certification The following certifications apply to the HMI device in accordance with EN 60079-0:2006 EN 60079-15:2005 EN 61241-1:2004 IEC 61241-0:2004+Cor.2005 valid: II 3 G Ex nA II Tx II 3 D Ex tD A22 IP6X T xx C x ... Temperature values, see EU design examination certificate The EU design examination certificates are available on the Internet at "http://support.automation.siemens.com". The table below describes the test numbers of the HMI device classes. Manufacturer site HMI device class Test number Siemens AG Industry Sector Werner-von-Siemens-Strasse 50 D92224 Amberg Germany 177 KEMA 04ATEX1297X Label for Australia N117 The HMI device fulfills the requirements of standard AS/NZS 2064 (Class A). IEC 61131 The HMI device fulfills the requirements and criteria conforming to IEC 61131-2, Programmable Logic PLCs, Part 2: Operating resource requirements and tests. 32 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Safety Instructions and General Notes 2.3 Notes about Usage 2.3 Notes about Usage Use in Industrial Environments The HMI device is designed for industrial use. It conforms to the following standards: Requirements for unintentional emissions EN 61000-6-4: 2007 Requirements for interference immunity DIN EN 61000-6-2:2005 Use in Residential Areas Note The HMI device is not suitable for use in residential areas. If you use the HMI device in residential areas, the radio/TV reception may be impeded. If the HMI device is used in residential areas, you must take measures to achieve limit class B conforming to EN 55011 for RF interference. A suitable measure for achieving the required RF interference level for limit class B includes for example: Use of filters in electrical supply lines Individual acceptance is required. Use in Potentially Explosive Atmosphere, Zones 2 and 22. CAUTION The following overview shows possible certifications. The HMI device itself is certified as shown on the label on its rear panel. DANGER Explosion hazard Operate the HMI device in a potentially explosive zone 2 atmosphere only if it has been approved and certified for such environments. WARNING Personal Injury and Property Damage Can Occur Personal injury and property damage can occur in potentially explosive atmospheres if an electric plug is disconnected from the HMI device while the system is in operation. In potentially explosive atmospheres, always turn off power to the HMI device before disconnecting any connectors. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 33 Safety Instructions and General Notes 2.3 Notes about Usage Potentially Explosive Atmospheres Zones 2 and 22 Potentially explosive atmospheres are classified by zones. The zones are classified according to the probability of the presence of an explosive atmosphere. Zone Explosion hazard Example 2 Explosive gas atmospheres occur Areas around flanged pipe joints with flat seldom and briefly gaskets in closed rooms 22 Explosive dust atmospheres occur seldom and briefly - Safe zone No * * * Outside zone 2 Outside zone 22 Standard applications for distributed IO Approval The following certifications apply to the HMI device in accordance with EN 60079-0:2006 EN 60079-15:2005 EN 61241-1:2004 IEC 61241-0:2004+Cor.2005 valid: II 3 G Ex nA II Tx II 3 D Ex tD A22 IP6X T xx C x ... Temperature values, see EU design examination certificate The EU design examination certificates are available on the Internet at "http://support.automation.siemens.com". The table below describes the test numbers of the HMI device classes. 34 Manufacturer site HMI device class Test number Siemens AG Industry Sector Werner-von-Siemens-Strasse 50 D92224 Amberg Germany 177 KEMA 04ATEX1297X TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Safety Instructions and General Notes 2.3 Notes about Usage Operating conditions for Zones 2 and 22 The HMI device must be installed in some form of enclosure. In accordance with EN 60529, the enclosure must guarantee the following: - Protection type IP54 or higher for zone 2 - Protection type IP5x or higher for zone 22 Installation must ensure that at least IP65 degree of protection is given (according to EN 60529). Make allowances for the ambient conditions under which you install the HMI device. A manufacturer declaration must be provided for the enclosure in accordance with EC directive 94/9, stating that it is fit for purpose. Follow the operating instructions to ensure that the protection type on the front panel is guaranteed. The ambient temperature range is 0 C T 50 C. Under these conditions, the HMI device will satisfy temperature class Tx for category 3G and support a maximum surface temperature of xx C for category 3D. (x ... temperature values, see design examination certificate). Refer to the operating instructions for details of limitations resulting from the ambient temperature range. In situations where the temperature on the cable at the cable inlet of this enclosure exceeds 70 C, or where the temperature on the wire branching point exceeds 80 C under operating conditions, the temperature specifications of the cables must match the actually measured temperatures. Put measures in place to ensure the rated voltage is not exceeded. Any transient interference voltages above the rated value must not exceed 40 %. The HMI device should be protected from mechanical loads > 4 J or > 2 J in the region of the display. Ensure that the atmosphere is not explosive during servicing. Measures that impair or remove the protection type of the HMI device are not permitted while the system is in operation. If the HMI device was dismantled, check the mounting seal for damage before reassembling the HMI device. A damaged, porous or used mounting seal no longer meets the requirements of the protection type. In this case, the mounting seal must be replaced. Turn the HMI device off if any cracks appear in the front coating, holes are damaged or the front coating starts to peel off. Exchange the HMI device. Restart the system again after the device has been exchanged. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 35 Safety Instructions and General Notes 2.4 Electromagnetic Compatibility Repairs The HMI device is maintenance-free. In case of repair, the HMI device must be shipped to the Return Center in Furth. The HMI device may only be repaired there. The address is: Siemens AG Industry Sector Returns Center Siemensstrasse 2 90766 Furth Germany Additional Information Please also observe the product information "Use in potentially explosive atmospheres, zones 2 and 22." The product information is located on the mini CD that is enclosed with the HMI device upon delivery. Approval Note HMI devices with approval to II 3G Ex nA II T4 may only be used on SIMATIC systems of device category 3. 2.4 Electromagnetic Compatibility Introduction The HMI device fulfills requirements of the EMC directive of the domestic European market and other requirements. EMC-compliant mounting of HMI devices EMC-compliant mounting of the HMI device and the use of interference-proof cables will ensure trouble-free operation. The "Directives for Interference-free installation of PLCs" and the "PROFIBUS Networks" manual also apply for the installation of the HMI device. 36 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Safety Instructions and General Notes 2.4 Electromagnetic Compatibility Pulse-shaped Interference The following table shows the EMC properties of the modules with respect to pulse-shaped interference. The HMI device must fulfill the specifications and directives relating to electrical installation as a basic prerequisite. Pulse-shaped interference Tested with Corresponds to test intensity Electrostatic discharge conforming to IEC 61000-4-2 Air discharge: 8 kV Contact discharge: 6 kV 3 Burst pulses (high-speed transient interference) conforming to IEC 61000-4-4 2 KV power cable 2 KV signal cable, > 30 m 1 KV signal cable, < 30 m 3 High-power surge pulses conforming to IEC 61000-4-5, external protective circuit required (refer to the manual, Programmable Controller S7-300, Installation, chapter "Lightning and Overvoltage Protection"). * Asymmetric coupling 2 kV power cable DC voltage with protective elements 3 2 KV signal/data cable, > 30 m, with protective elements as required * Asymmetric coupling 1 kV power cable DC voltage with protective elements 3 1 KV signal cable, > 30 m, with protective elements as required Sinusoidal Interferences The table below shows the EMC properties of the modules as they relate to sinusoidal interference. The HMI device must fulfill the specifications and directives relating to electrical installation as a basic prerequisite. Sinusoidal interference RF interference (electromagnetic fields) * Conforming to IEC 61000-4-3 * Conforming to IEC 61000-4-3 Test values Corresponds to test intensity 3 80% amplitude modulation at 1 kHz with 10 V/m in the range of 80 MHz to 1 GHz with 3 V/m in the range 1.4 GHz to 2 GHz with 1 V/m the range 2 GHz to 2.7 GHz 10 V/m with 50% pulse modulation at 900 MHz 10 V/m with 50% pulse modulation at 1.89 GHz RF interference current on cables and cable shielding conforming to IEC 61000-4-6 Test voltage 10 V, with 80% amplitude modulation of 1 kHz in the 10 MHz to 80 MHz range TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 3 37 Safety Instructions and General Notes 2.5 Transport and Storage Conditions Emission of Radio Interference Emission of electromagnetic interference conforming to 55011, Limit value class A, Group 1, measured at a distance of 10 m: From 30 to 230 MHz < 40 dB (V/m) quasi-peak From 230 to 1000 MHz < 47 dB (V/m) quasi-peak Additional Measures Before you connect an HMI device to the public electricity supply, ensure that it is compliant with Limit Class B conforming to 55022. 2.5 Transport and Storage Conditions Mechanical and Climatic Transport and Storage Conditions The transport and storage conditions of this HMI device exceed requirements conforming to IEC 61131-2. The following specifications apply to the transport and storage of an HMI device in its original packing. The climatic conditions comply to the following standards: IEC 60721-3-3, Class 3K7 for storage IEC 60721-3-2, Class 2K4 for transport The mechanical requirements are compliant with EC 60721-3-2, Class 2M2. Type of Condition Permissible range Drop test (in transport package) 1m Temperature from -20 to +60 C Air pressure from 1080 to 660 hPa, corresponds to an elevation of -1000 to 3500 m Relative humidity from 10 to 90% without condensation Sinusoidal vibration conforming to IEC 60068-2-6 5 to 8.4 Hz: 3.5 mm 8.4 Hz to 150 Hz: 9.8 m/s2 Shock conforming to IEC 60068-2-29 250 m/s2, 6 ms, 1000 shocks NOTICE Ensure that no condensation (dewing) develops on or inside the HMI device after transporting it at low temperatures or after it has been exposed to extreme temperature fluctuations. The HMI device must have acquired room temperature before it is put into operation. Do not expose the HMI device to direct radiation from a heater in order to warm it up. If dewing has developed, wait approximately four hours until the HMI device has dried completely before switching it on. Prerequisite for the trouble-free and safe operation of the HMI device is proper transport and storage, installation and assembly and careful operation and maintenance. Warranty for the HMI device is deemed void if these specifications are ignored. 38 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 3 Planning Use 3.1 Mounting Information Mechanical and Climatic Conditions of Use The HMI device is intended for installation in weatherproof permanent locations. The conditions of use are compliant with requirements to DIN IEC 60721-3-3: Class 3M3 (mechanical requirements) Class 3K3 (climatic requirements) Use with Additional Measures Examples of applications where the use of the HMI device requires additional measures: In locations with a high degree of ionizing radiation In locations with extreme operating conditions resulting from situations such as the following: - Corrosive vapors, gases, oils or chemicals - Electrical or magnetic fields of high intensity In plants requiring special monitoring features, for example: - Elevator systems - Systems in especially hazardous rooms Mechanical ambient conditions The mechanical ambient conditions for the HMI device are specified in the following table in terms of sinusoidal vibration. Frequency range in Hz Constant 10 f 58 Amplitude 0.0375 mm Amplitude 0.075 mm 58 f 150 Constant acceleration 0.5 g Constant acceleration 1 g TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Intermittent 39 Planning Use 3.1 Mounting Information Reduction of Vibration If the HMI device is subjected to greater shocks or vibrations, you must take appropriate measures to reduce acceleration or amplitudes. We recommend fitting the HMI device to vibration-absorbent material (on metal shock absorbers, for example). Testing for Mechanical Ambient Conditions The following table provides information on the type and scope of tests for mechanical ambient conditions. The check includes Test standard Comments Vibrations Vibration test conforming to IEC 60068, part 2-6 (sinusoidal) Type of vibration: Transitional rate of the frequency: 1 octave/minute. 10 f 58, Constant amplitude 0.075 mm 58 f 150, Constant acceleration 1 g Vibration duration: 10 frequency cycles per axis in each of the three axes vertical to each other Shock Shock testing in accordance with IEC 60068, Part 2 -29 Type of shock: half sine Shock intensity: Peak value 15 g, duration 11 ms Direction of impact: 3 shocks in direction of axis in each of the three axes vertical to each other Climatic ambient conditions The HMI device may be used under the following climatic ambient conditions: 40 Ambient conditions Permissible range Comments Temperature * Vertical installation * Inclined mounting 0 to 50 C See the "Mounting positions and type of fixation" section Relative humidity 10 to 90% Without condensation, corresponds to a relative humidity, stress class 2 conforming to IEC 61131, part 2 Air pressure 1080 to 795 hPa Corresponds to an elevation of -1000 to 2000 m Pollutant concentration SO2: < 0.5 vpm; Relative humidity < 60 %, no condensation Check: 10 vpm; 4 days H2S: < 0.1 vpm; relative humidity < 60 %, no condensation Check: 1 vpm; 4 days 0 to 40 C TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Planning Use 3.2 Mounting Positions and Fixation 3.2 Mounting Positions and Fixation Mounting position The HMI device is designed for mounting in racks, cabinets, control boards and consoles. In the following, all of these mounting options are referred to by the general term "cabinet". The HMI device is self-ventilated and approved for vertical and inclined mounting in stationary cabinets. - + Mounting position Deviation from the vertical Inclined -35 Vertical 0 Inclined 35 CAUTION Impermissible ambient temperatures Do not operate the HMI device without auxiliary ventilation if the maximum permissible ambient temperature is exceeded. The HMI device may otherwise get damaged and its certifications and warranty will be void. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 41 Planning Use 3.2 Mounting Positions and Fixation Horizontal mounting for TP 177A, TP 177B and OP 177B When mounted horizontally, the cable inlets are located at the bottom. Vertical mounting for TP 177A When mounted vertically, the cable inlets are located on the right. Securing the TP 177A, TP 177B 6" and OP 177B Plastic mounting clamps are provided for mounting the device. The mounting clamps hook into recesses on the HMI device. The overall HMI device dimensions are not exceeded by this. 42 Hook Cross-tip screw TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Planning Use 3.3 Preparing for Mounting Securing the TP 177B 4" Metal mounting clamps are provided for mounting. The mounting clamps hook into recesses on the HMI device. The overall HMI device dimensions are not exceeded by this. 3.3 Threaded stud Hook Preparing for Mounting Select the mounting location of the HMI device Points to observe when selecting the mounting location: Position the HMI device so that it is not subjected to direct sunlight. Position the HMI device such that it is ergonomically accessible for the user. Choose a suitable mounting height. Ensure that the air vents of the HMI device are not covered as a result of the mounting. Observe the permissible mounting positions for the HMI device. Degrees of protection The degrees of protection are only guaranteed when the following is observed for the mounting cut-out: Material thickness at the mounting cut-out for IP65 degree of protection: 2 to 6 mm Material thickness at the mounting cut-out for NEMA 4X/NEMA 12 degree of protection (indoor use only): 3 mm to 6 mm Permitted deviation from plane at the mounting cut-out: 0.5 mm This condition must be fulfilled for the mounted HMI device. Permissible surface roughness in the area of the seal: 120 m (Rz 120) TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 43 Planning Use 3.3 Preparing for Mounting Dimensions of the mounting cut-out The following table shows the dimensions of the mounting cut-out required. Mounting cut-out TP 177A horizontal mounting TP 177A vertical mounting TP 177B 6" Horizontal TP 177B 4" horizontal mounting OP 177B Horizontal Width 198+1 mm 142+1 mm 198+1 mm 123+1 mm 228+1 mm Height 142+1 198+1 142+1 99+1 196+1 mm Depth 50 mm mm mm 50 mm mm 50 mm mm 50 mm 55 mm Maintaining clearances The HMI device must be installed with the following clearances: 50 mm above and below the mounting cut-out for ventilation 15 mm to the right and left of the mounting cut-out for inserting the mounting clamps for installation At least 10 mm clearance in addition to the depth of the HMI device is required at the rear NOTICE Ensure that the maximum ambient temperature is not exceeded when mounting the device in a cabinet and especially in a closed enclosure. 44 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Planning Use 3.4 Specifications for Insulation Tests, Protection Class and Degree of Protection 3.4 Specifications for Insulation Tests, Protection Class and Degree of Protection Test Coltages Insulation resistance is demonstrated in the type test with the following test voltages conforming to IEC 61131-2: Circuits with a nominal voltage of Ue to other circuits or ground Test voltage < 50 V 500 V DC Protection Class Protection Class I conforming to IEC 60536, i.e. equipotential bonding conductor to profile rail required! Protection from foreign objects and water Degree of protection conforming to IEC 60529 Explanation Front When mounted: * IP65 * NEMA 4X/NEMA 12 (indoor use only) Rear IP20 Protection against touch with standard test fingers. There is no protection against ingress by water. The degree of protection provided by the front side can only be guaranteed when the mounting seal lies completely against the mounting cut-out. 3.5 Nominal Voltages The following table details the allowed rated line voltages and associated tolerance ranges. HMI device Rated voltage Tolerance range TP 177A, TP 177B 6", OP 177B +24 VDC 20.4 to 28.8 V (-15%, +20%) TP 177B 4" +24 VDC 19.2 to 28.8 V (-20 %, +20 %) TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 45 Planning Use 3.5 Nominal Voltages 46 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Installation and connection 4.1 4 Checking the package contents Check the package contents for visible signs of transport damage and for completeness. NOTICE Damaged parts Do not install parts damaged during shipment. In the case of damaged parts, contact your Siemens representative. The following is contained in the delivery: HMI device Accessory kit The accessory kit contains the following: - 1 terminal block for the power supply - Mounting clamps for mounting the HMI device Additional documents may be enclosed with the accessory kit. Keep the supplied documentation in a safe place. The documentation belongs to the HMI device and is required for subsequent commissioning. 4.2 Mounting the HMI Device Requirement All packaging components and protective foils should be removed from the HMI device. You need the mounting clamps from the accessories kit for the installation. The mounting seal must be available on the HMI device. If the mounting seal is damaged, order a replacement seal. The mounting seal is part of the associated service pack. Note Plastic mounting clamps are enclosed in the TP 177A, TP 177B 6" and the OP177B. Metal mounting clamps are included with the TP 177B 4". TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 47 Installation and connection 4.2 Mounting the HMI Device Mounting clamps on the TP 177A and TP 177B 6" Use a plastic mounting clamp on each side of the HMI device to secure it in the mounting cut-out. Mounting clamps TP 177B 4" The recesses required to suspend the metal mounting clamps are marked with an arrow on the back of the HMI device. Marking for position of a mounting clamp To ensure one of the degrees of protection IP65 or NEMA 4, suspend the metal mounting clamps in the marked recesses. In each case use one metal mounting for the right, left and bottom, and two at the top. Mounting clamps on the OP 177B If IP65 or NEMA 4 degrees of protection are required for the OP 177B, the mounting clamps must be installed as follows. 48 Additionally required plastic mounting clamps for IP65 and NEMA 4 degrees of protection TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Installation and connection 4.2 Mounting the HMI Device Mounting NOTICE Always mount the HMI device according to the instructions in this manual. Risk of guaranteed level of protection not being met If the mounting seal is damaged or protrudes beyond the HMI device, the level of protection is not ensured. Check the fit of the mounting seal. Note Tighten the set screw or the cross-tip screw of the mounting clamps until the HMI device is flush with the surface of the control cabinet. As an alternative, you can tighten the mounting clamps using the following torque: * Plastic mounting clamps: max. 0.15 Nm * Metal mounting clamps: max. 0.2 Nm Proceed as follows: 1. Check that the mounting seal is fitted on the HMI device. Do not install the mounting seal turned inside out. This may cause leaks in the mounting cut-out. 2. Insert the HMI device into the mounting cut-out from the front. 3. Insert a mounting clamp into the intended recesses on the HMI device. Example: Inserting plastic mounting clamps Example: Inserting metal mounting clamps on the TP 177A on the TP 177 4" 4. Tighten the mounting clamp using a threaded stud or a cross-tip screwdriver. 5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 for all mounting clamps. 6. Check the fit of the mounting seal. If necessary, repeat steps 1 to 6. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 49 Installation and connection 4.3 Connecting the HMI Device Result The HMI device is mounted and the relevant level of protection is ensured at the front. See also Accessories (Page 22) 4.3 Connecting the HMI Device Requirement The HMI device must be mounted according to the specifications of these operating instructions. Always use standard shielded cables. Note Connector on the TP 177B 4" Use only straight connectors on the TP 177B 4". Angled connectors could conceal neighboring ports. You can find more information about this on the Internet at "http://mall.automation.siemens.com". Connection sequence Connect the HMI device in the following sequence: 1. Equipotential bonding 2. Power supply Perform a power-up test to ensure the power supply is connected with the correct polarity. 3. PLC / configuring PC if needed NOTICE Connection sequence Always follow the correct sequence for connecting the HMI device. Failure to do so may result in damage to the HMI device. Connecting the cables When connecting the cables, ensure that the contact pins are not bent. Secure the connectors with screws. The pin assignment of the ports is described in the technical specifications. See also Safety Information (Page 29) 50 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Installation and connection 4.3 Connecting the HMI Device 4.3.1 Interfaces on the TP 177A The figure below shows the interfaces of the TP 177A HMI device. Chassis terminal for equipotential bonding Power supply connector RS 422 / 485 interface (IF 1B) See also Power Supply (Page 332) X10/IF 1B (RS 422/RS 485) (Page 332) 4.3.2 Interfaces on the TP 177B 4" The figure below shows the interfaces of the TP 177B 4" HMI device. RS 422 / RS 485 port X10 / IF 1B Chassis terminal for equipotential bonding PROFINET interface X1 P1 USB port X20 Power supply connector You connect the PROFIBUS DP or MPI to the X10 / IF 1B port. See also Connecting the Power Supply (Page 55) Connecting the Controller (Page 58) X20 (USB) (Page 333) X1 (PROFINET) (Page 333) TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 51 Installation and connection 4.3 Connecting the HMI Device 4.3.3 Interfaces on the TP 177B 6" The figure below shows the interfaces of the TP 177B 6" HMI device. Chassis terminal for equipotential bonding Power supply connector RS 422 / 485 interface (IF 1B) PROFINET connection (applies to TP 177B 6" PN/DP) USB connection See also Power Supply (Page 332) X10/IF 1B (RS 422/RS 485) (Page 332) X20 (USB) (Page 333) X1 (PROFINET) (Page 333) 4.3.4 Interfaces on the OP 177B The figure below shows the interfaces of the OP 177B HMI device. Chassis terminal for equipotential bonding Power supply connector RS -485/RS -422 interface (IF 1B) PROFINET connection (applies to OP 177B PN/DP) USB connection See also Power Supply (Page 332) X10/IF 1B (RS 422/RS 485) (Page 332) X20 (USB) (Page 333) X1 (PROFINET) (Page 333) 52 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Installation and connection 4.3 Connecting the HMI Device 4.3.5 Connecting the Equipotential Bonding Circuit Potential Differences Differences in potential between spatially separated system parts can lead to high equalizing currents over the data cables and therefore to the destruction of their interfaces. This situation may arise if the cable shielding is terminated at both ends and grounded at different system parts. Potential differences may develop when a system is connected to different mains. General Requirements for Equipotential Bonding Potential differences must be reduced by means of equipotential bonding in order to ensure trouble-free operation of the relevant components of the electronic system. The following must therefore be observed when installing the equipotential bonding circuit: The effectiveness of equipotential bonding increases as the impedance of the equipotential bonding conductor decreases or as its cross-section increases. If two system parts are connected to each other via shielded data lines with shielding connected to the grounding/protective conductor on both sides, the impedance of the additionally installed equipotential bonding cables may not exceed 10% of the shielding impedance. The cross-section of a selected equipotential bonding conductor must be capable of handling the maximum equalizing current. The best results for equipotential bonding between two cabinets were achieved with a minimum conductor cross-section of 16 mm2. Use equipotential bonding conductors made of copper or galvanized steel. Establish a large-surface contact between the equipotential bonding conductors and the grounding/protective conductor and protect these from corrosion. Terminate the shielding of the data cable on the HMI device flush and near the equipotential busbar using suitable cable clamps. Route the equipotential bonding conductor and data cables in parallel with minimum clearance between these. See following wiring diagram. NOTICE Equipotential Bonding Conductor Cable shielding is not suitable for equipotential bonding. Always use the prescribed equipotential bonding conductors. The minimum cross-section of a conductor used for equipotential bonding is 16 mm. When you install MPI and PROFIBUS DP networks, always use cables with a sufficient crosssection since otherwise the interface modules may be damaged or destroyed. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 53 Installation and connection 4.3 Connecting the HMI Device Wiring diagram Chassis terminal on the HMI device (example) Equipotential bonding conductor cross-section: 4 mm2 Cabinet Equipotential bonding conductor cross-section: min. 16 mm2 Ground connection Cable clip Voltage bus Parallel routing of the equipotential bonding conductor and data cable See also Electromagnetic Compatibility (Page 36) 54 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Installation and connection 4.3 Connecting the HMI Device 4.3.6 Connecting the Power Supply Wiring diagram The figure below illustrates the connection between the power supply and the HMI device. 23% 73$ 73% 73% Note when connecting The power terminal block is included in the assembly kit and is designed for conductors with a maximum cross-section of 1.5 mm2. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 55 Installation and connection 4.3 Connecting the HMI Device Connecting the terminal block NOTICE Damage The pressure of the screwdriver may damage the socket if the terminal strip is plugged into the HMI device when you tighten the screws. Only connect the wires when the plug-in terminal strip is withdrawn. There are two types of plug-in terminal strips that can be used for the TP 177A, TP 177B and OP 177B. *1' *1' 9'& 9'& Plug-in terminal strip, version 1 Plug-in terminal strip, version 2 Connect the power supply cables to the terminal strip as shown in the figure above. Ensure that the lines are connected properly to the correct terminals. Refer to the label for the contact pins on the rear of the HMI device. Reverse polarity protection The HMI device is equipped with a reverse polarity protection. 56 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Installation and connection 4.3 Connecting the HMI Device Connecting the power supply CAUTION Supply voltage With the supply voltage, pay attention to a secure electrical separation. Always use power supply modules that conform to IEC 364-4-41 or HD 384.04.41 (VDE 0100, Part 410). Always use power supply modules that comply to SELV (Safety Extra-Low Voltage) and PELV (Protective Extra Low Voltage) standards. The power supply voltage must always be within the specified range to prevent malfunctions on the HMI device. Equipotential bonding Connect the 24 V DC voltage to the GND conductor at a central connection point for equipotential bonding. This ensures the GND supply for the HMI device. See also Interfaces on the TP 177A (Page 51) Interfaces on the TP 177B 4" (Page 51) Interfaces on the TP 177B 6" (Page 52) Interfaces on the OP 177B (Page 52) TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 57 Installation and connection 4.3 Connecting the HMI Device 4.3.7 Connecting uninterruptible power supply on the TP 177B 4" Wiring diagram The following figure shows the connection between the uninterruptible power supply and HMI device. The uninterruptible power supply is connected to the 24-V input and one of USB ports of the HMI device. When connected to the USB port of the HMI device, the following uninterruptible power supplies are supported: SITOP DC UPS modules as of a rated power value of 6 A, e.g. 6EP1931-2DC42. 8QLQWHUUXSWLEOHSRZHUVXSSO\ 836 73% Note Observe all the notes relating to connecting a power supply. See also Interfaces on the TP 177B 4" (Page 51) 4.3.8 Connecting the Controller Wiring diagram The figure below illustrates the connection between the HMI device and controller. 6,0$7,&6 56 73$ 58 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Installation and connection 4.3 Connecting the HMI Device 6,0$7,&6 352),1(7 7KLUGSDUW\ FRQWUROOHUV 5- 6,0$7,&6 56 6,0$7,& 56 7KLUGSDUW\ FRQWUROOHUV 7KLUGSDUW\ FRQWUROOHUV 5656 56 56 23% 73% 73% NOTICE Cables Always use the approved cables to connect a SIMATIC S7 PLC. Standard cables are available for the connection. You can find more information about this on the Internet at "http://mall.automation.siemens.com". TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 59 Installation and connection 4.3 Connecting the HMI Device Connecting PROFINET NOTICE Use a cross-cable for the PROFINET connection of the TP 177B 6" and the OP 177B when using a point-to-point connection. NOTICE PROFINET IO is not capable of function If you connect the HMI device directly to the controller, it could cause PROFINET IO direct keys not to function properly. Connect the switch with a PROFINET cable to the HMI device. For detailed instructions regarding the installation of PROFINET networks, please refer to the PROFINET system description manual. Only connect the HMI device to public Ethernet networks using a switch or comparable device. Configuring the RS-485 Interface A DIP switch for the configuration of the RS -485 interface is located on the back side of the HMI device. In the factory state, the DIP switch is set for communication with the SIMATIC S7 controller. Note Note the diagrams of the DIP switch settings on the back of the HMI device. The following table shows the settings of the DIP switch. The transmitting and receiving directions will be switched over internally with the RTS signal. Communication RS 485 Switch setting 21 21 21 RS 422 Meaning No RTS on plug, for data transfer between PLC and HMI device (factory state) RTS on pin 4, same as PLC, for example, for commissioning RTS on pin 9, same as programming device, for example, for commissioning RS-422 port is active. 21 60 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Installation and connection 4.3 Connecting the HMI Device See also Interfaces on the TP 177A (Page 51) Interfaces on the TP 177B 4" (Page 51) Interfaces on the TP 177B 6" (Page 52) Interfaces on the OP 177B (Page 52) 4.3.9 Connecting a configuration PC Wiring diagram The figure below illustrates the connection between the HMI device and the configuration PC. You can use this connection to transfer the image, the project and further project data. 3& 56 56 56 56 3& 56 73$ TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 61 Installation and connection 4.3 Connecting the HMI Device 3& 86% 3& 5- 3& 56 56 56 3& 56 56 23% 73% 73% Use a cross-cable for the Ethernet connection of the TP 177B 6" and the OP 177B when using a point-to-point connection. You can use a standard cable for the Ethernet connection of the TP 177B 4", as this HMI device has an automatic cross-over function. The interfaces are described in the technical specifications. For RS-485-RS-232 conversion, you can order the PC / PPI cable from Siemens AG using order number 6ES7 901-3CB30-0XA0. 62 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Installation and connection 4.3 Connecting the HMI Device Configuring a PC / PPI cable Use the DIP switches to configure the transfer rate of the PC / PPI cable. Note If the connection fails during the operating system update, set the system to a lower bit rate. If you use a higher bit rate, you must use the PC / PPI cable release 3 or higher. The version code is printed on the cable (e.g., "E stand 3" corresponds to version 3). DIP switch LEDs Set the DIP switches 1 to 3 to the same bit rate as in WinCC flexible. DIP switches 4 to 8 must be set to "0". DIP switch The following bit rates can be set: Bit rate in kbit/s DIP switch 1 DIP switch 2 DIP switch 3 115.2 1 1 0 57.6 1 1 1 38.4 0 0 0 19.2 0 0 1 9.6 0 1 0 4.8 0 1 1 2.4 1 0 0 1.2 1 0 1 In the figure, the bit rate is set to 115.2 kbit/s. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 63 Installation and connection 4.3 Connecting the HMI Device Note when connecting NOTICE USB connection sequence Observe the following sequence when connecting by USB: 1. HMI device 2. PC USB host-to-host cable Use only the driver for the USB host-to-host cable that is included in the WinCC flexible package. Never use the driver supplied with the USB host-to-host cable. Updating the operating system If there is no HMI device image on the HMI device or the HMI device image is corrupt, the operating system can only be updated via the HMI device's RS 485 interface or the PC / PPI cable. See also Interfaces on the TP 177A (Page 51) Interfaces on the TP 177B 4" (Page 51) Interfaces on the TP 177B 6" (Page 52) Interfaces on the OP 177B (Page 52) 64 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Installation and connection 4.3 Connecting the HMI Device 4.3.10 Connecting USB devices to TP 177B and OP 177B You can connect the following devices to the USB port of the HMI device: External mouse External keyboard Printer USB memory stick Industrial USB Hub 4 Industrial USB hub 4 can be obtained using order number 6AV6671-3AH00-0AX0. Note when connecting NOTICE Functional problem with USB port If you connect an external device with an independent power supply without equipotential bonding to the USB port, you may experience functional problems. Ensure a non-insulated installation. Excessive rated load on port A USB device with too high a power load may possibly cause functional problems. Observe the values for the maximum load of the USB port. You will find the values in the technical specifications. See also Specifications (Page 325) Interfaces on the TP 177B 4" (Page 51) Interfaces on the TP 177B 6" (Page 52) Interfaces on the OP 177B (Page 52) TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 65 Installation and connection 4.3 Connecting the HMI Device 4.3.11 Connecting printers to TP 177B and OP 177B Wiring diagram You can connect a printer as a peripheral. 86% 5- 23% 73% 73% 66 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Installation and connection 4.3 Connecting the HMI Device Note when connecting NOTICE Only use cables with two-ended grounded metal braided shielding between the HMI device and printer. Use a cross-cable for the Ethernet connection of the TP 177B 6" and the OP 177B when using a point-to-point connection. The list of current printers and required settings for HMI devices can be found on the Internet under "http://support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/11376409". NOTICE Rated load of the USB port Observe the values given in the specifications for the load on the USB port. Loads greater than those specified may result in malfunctions in connected devices. Note Documentation for peripherals Also, read the documentation provided with the printer before connecting it. See also Interfaces on the TP 177B 4" (Page 51) Interfaces on the TP 177B 6" (Page 52) Interfaces on the OP 177B (Page 52) Specifications (Page 325) TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 67 Installation and connection 4.4 Switching on and Testing the HMI Device 4.4 Switching on and Testing the HMI Device Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Connect the plug-in terminal strip on the HMI device. 2. Restart the power supply. The display lights up after power on. A progress bar is displayed during startup. If the HMI device does not start, it is possible the wires on the terminal block have been crossed. Check the connected wires and change the connections if necessary. The Loader opens once the operating system has started. The HMI device automatically switches to "Transfer" mode during initial startup under the following conditions: - No project is loaded on the device. - At least one data channel has been configured. The following dialog appears: 3. Press "Cancel" to stop the transfer. 68 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Installation and connection 4.4 Switching on and Testing the HMI Device Result The Loader appears again. Note When restarting the system, a project may already be loaded on the HMI device. In this case, the project will then start after an adjustable delay or when you press the "Start" button. Use the relevant operator control object to close the project. Refer to your plant documentation to find any additional information on this topic. Function test Perform a function test following commissioning. The HMI device is fully functional when one of the following states is indicated: The "Transfer" dialog is displayed. The Loader opens. A project is started. Switching off the HMI Device You have the following options for switching off the HMI device: Shut down the power supply. Disconnect the plug-in terminal strip on the HMI device. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 69 Installation and connection 4.4 Switching on and Testing the HMI Device 70 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 5 Operator Controls and Displays 5.1 Front-side Operator Controls Operating elements on the TP 177A and TP 177B 6" Display with touch screen TP 177B 4" operating elements Display with touch screen Function keys without LED TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 71 Operator Controls and Displays 5.1 Front-side Operator Controls Operating elements on the OP 177B Display with touch screen Function keys with LED Function keys without LED Touch screen The standard input unit on the HMI device is the touch screen. All operator controls required for operation are displayed on the touch screen once the HMI device has started. CAUTION Damage to the touch screen Pointed or sharp objects can damage the plastic surface of the touch screen. Always operate the touch screen with your fingers or with a touch pen only. Triggering unintended actions Touching several operator controls at the same time can trigger unintended actions. Always touch only one operator control on the screen. 72 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operator Controls and Displays 5.2 Connecting a memory card to the TP 177B 6" and OP 177B Function keys On the TP 177B 4" you can also use the function keys F1 to F4 for inputs. Information can be also entered on the OP 177B using the function keys F1 to F14 and K1 to K18. The function assigned to a specific function key is defined during configuration. The function keys have no function before a project has been opened. NOTICE Damage to the keyboard possible Always use your fingers to operate the keys of your HMI device. Using hard instruments to press the keys considerably reduces the service life of the key mechanism. See also Design of the TP 177A HMI Device (Page 16) Design of the TP 177B 4" HMI device (Page 19) Design of the TP 177B 6" HMI device (Page 17) Design of the OP 177B HMI Device (Page 20) 5.2 Connecting a memory card to the TP 177B 6" and OP 177B Approved memory cards Only use MultiMediaCards tested and approved by Siemens AG for the respective HMI device. NOTICE The SIMATIC S7 MultiMedia card can no longer be used If you format a MultiMedia card for the SIMATIC S7 in the HMI device, this MultiMedia card can no longer be used in the SIMATIC S7. Only use MultiMedia cards that are approved for the HMI device. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 73 Operator Controls and Displays 5.2 Connecting a memory card to the TP 177B 6" and OP 177B Procedure - Inserting a memory card Proceed as follows: 1. Insert the memory card into the relevant slot. When inserting the memory card, please note that it can only be inserted in the slot when the front side of the memory card is visible. The following figure shows you how to insert the memory card, for example, in the TP 177B 6". 1 Memory card interlock 2 Memory card 3 Memory card slot 2. Check that the memory card is properly seated. If the memory card is inserted correctly in the memory card slot, the memory card lock engages behind the memory card. Using a memory card for the first time NOTICE Data loss When requested by the HMI device to format a memory card for first time use, you should save a backup copy of memory card data to a PC. Proceed as follows to prevent data loss: 1. Cancel the formatting procedure by pressing "ESC". 2. Save a backup copy of vital data to a PC. 3. Format the memory card on the HMI device. 4. If you require on the HMI device data that has been saved on the PC, transfer the data back to the memory card. You can now transfer the backup data from the memory card to the HMI device. 74 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operator Controls and Displays 5.2 Connecting a memory card to the TP 177B 6" and OP 177B Procedure - Ejecting a Memory Card NOTICE Loss of data possible The data on the memory card is lost if you attempt to remove it while the HMI device is accessing its data. Do not remove the memory card while data is being accessed. Observe the corresponding alarms on the screen. The following figure shows you how to eject the memory card on the example of the TP 177B. Eject button Proceed as follows: 1. Press the ejection button. This ejects the memory card out of the slot. NOTICE Do not force the ejector. This could damage its mechanism. 2. Unplug the memory card from the memory card slot. 3. Store the memory card in a safe place. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 75 Operator Controls and Displays 5.3 Insert a memory card in the TP 177B 4" 5.3 Insert a memory card in the TP 177B 4" Approved memory cards Only use SD memory cards or MultiMediaCards tested and approved by Siemens AG for the respective HMI device. NOTICE The SIMATIC S7 MultiMedia card can no longer be used If you format a MultiMedia card for the SIMATIC S7 in the HMI device, this MultiMedia card can no longer be used in the SIMATIC S7. Only use MultiMedia cards that are approved for the HMI device. Procedure - Inserting a memory card The memory card can be inserted during operation. Proceed as follows: 1. Insert the memory card in the slot until it stops. When inserting the memory card, please note that it can only be inserted in the slot when the front side of the memory card is visible. 2. Check that the memory card is properly seated. 76 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operator Controls and Displays 5.3 Insert a memory card in the TP 177B 4" Using a memory card for the first time NOTICE Data loss When requested by the HMI device to format a memory card for first time use, you should save a backup copy of memory card data to a PC. Proceed as follows to prevent data loss: 1. Cancel the formatting procedure by pressing "ESC". 2. Save a backup copy of vital data to a PC. 3. Format the memory card on the HMI device. 4. If you require on the HMI device data that has been saved on the PC, transfer the data back to the memory card. You can now transfer the backup data from the memory card to the HMI device. Procedure - removing a memory card NOTICE Loss of data possible The data on the memory card is lost if you attempt to remove it while the HMI device is accessing its data. Do not remove the memory card while data is being accessed. Observe the corresponding alarms on the screen. Proceed as follows: 1. Unplug the memory card from the memory card slot. 2. Store the memory card in a safe place. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 77 Operator Controls and Displays 5.4 Labeling function keys on the TP 177B 4" and OP 177B 5.4 Labeling function keys on the TP 177B 4" and OP 177B Introduction You can label the function keys as required for your project. Use labeling strips to do so. NOTICE Do not write on the keyboard to label the function keys. Printing Labeling Strips WinCC flexible comes with a range of labeling strip templates. You will find further information regarding the location of the templates in the WinCC flexible online help. Any printable and writable foil can be used as labeling strips. You can use transparency film, the keyboard membrane of the HMI device is printed on the reverse side. Use transparent foil so that the LEDs of the function keys can be seen. The permitted thickness of the labeling strip is 0.15 mm. Paper should not be used as labeling strips. Dimensions for the labeling strips of the the TP 177B 4" [r Dimensions for the labeling strips of the OP 177B [r [r 78 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operator Controls and Displays 5.4 Labeling function keys on the TP 177B 4" and OP 177B Procedure Note With TP 177B 4" the slots are located at the sides of the HMI device. With OP 177B, the slots for the labeling strips are located on the bottom of the HMI device. Proceed as follows: 1. Edit and then print the template. You can also print out an empty template and later write on it by hand. 2. Spray the labeling strips with fixing spray. The fixing spray ensures that the text is water resistant and does not smear, and that the printer ink on the keyboard membrane does not run. 3. Cut out the labeling strip. Ensure that the corners are cut according to the diagram shown above as this makes it easier to slide them into the slot. 4. Remove any existing labeling strips. Note Wait for the printed labeling strips to dry before you insert them. 5. Slide the labeling strips into the slot . Labeling strips on the OP 177B Labeling strips on the TP 177B 4" 6. Slide the labeling strips into the slot up to the stop. The labeling strips will protrude approximately 3 cm out of the slot. The template dimensions for the labeling strips are designed so that the labeling is correctly placed for the function keys. It is not necessary to secure the labeling strip. When mounting the HMI device, ensure that the labeling strips do not become jammed between the mounting cut-out and the HMI device. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 79 Operator Controls and Displays 5.4 Labeling function keys on the TP 177B 4" and OP 177B 80 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.1 Configuring the Operating System on the TP 177A 6.1.1 Overview 6 Loader The figure below shows the Loader. It appears briefly when the HMI device starts up. The Loader buttons have the following functions: Use the "Transfer" button to set "Transfer" mode on the HMI device. Press the "Start" button to open the project stored on the HMI device Press "Control Panel" to open the HMI device Control Panel The Control Panel is used to configure various settings such as the transfer settings. The loader also appears every time you close the project. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 81 Configuring the Operating System 6.1 Configuring the Operating System on the TP 177A Protecting the Control Panel with a password You can protect the Control Panel and taskbar from unauthorized access. Without a password, you can still read the settings in the Control Panel, but you cannot change all the settings. This prevents inadvertent operations and increases security for the plant or machine because the settings cannot be changed when a project is not open. NOTICE If the password is no longer available, you cannot change settings in the Control Panel and taskbar unless you update the operating system. All data on the HMI device will be overwritten when you update the operating system! See also Switching on and Testing the HMI Device (Page 68) Changing the Password Settings (Page 89) Configuring the Data Channel (Page 93) 6.1.2 Control Panel 6.1.2.1 Overview Control Panel of the HMI Device The HMI device Control Panel can be used to modify the following HMI device settings: Screen settings Transfer settings Opening the Control Panel Open the Control Panel using the HMI device Loader. The following options are available to open the Loader: The Loader appears briefly after starting the HMI device. During runtime: If configured, touch the relevant operator control object to stop the project. The Loader opens. Refer to your plant documentation to find any additional information on this topic. 82 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.1 Configuring the Operating System on the TP 177A Touch the "Control Panel" button in the Loader to open the HMI device Control Panel. OP Changing screen settings, displaying information about HMI device, calibrating the touch screen Password Setting password protection for the Control Panel MPI/DP settings Changing MPI/DP Settings Screen saver Configuring the screen saver Transfer Change transfer settings, configure the data channel Procedure Proceed as follows to change settings in the Control Panel: 1. You must exit the project before changing settings in the Control Panel. Use the relevant operator control object provided in the project. 2. Open the Control Panel as described above. 3. Open the desired dialog by double-clicking on the corresponding icon in the Control Panel. 4. To change settings, touch the respective input field or check box and use the displayed screen keyboard if necessary. Enter the required password if the Control Panel is protected against unauthorized access. Change the HMI device settings in the dialog. 5. Press or to close the dialog. 6. Press or to close the dialog. 7. Start the project using the Loader. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 83 Configuring the Operating System 6.1 Configuring the Operating System on the TP 177A 6.1.2.2 Changing Screen Settings Requirement The "OP Properties" dialog has been opened with the "OP" icon. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. From the "OP Properties" dialog, select the "Display" tab. Button for increasing the contrast Button for reducing the contrast Setting the orientation of the screen Input field for the startup delay on the HMI device 2. The buttons "UP" and "DOWN" are located in the "Contrast" group. Proceed as follows to change contrast of the screen: - Touch the "UP" button to increase the contrast of the screen - Touch the "DOWN" button to decrease the contrast of the screen 3. The radio buttons "Landscape" and "Portrait" are located in the "Orientation" group. Proceed as follows to change the orientation of the screen: - Enable the "Landscape" radio button to orientate the screen of the HMI device diagonally - Enable the "Portrait" radio button to orientate the screen of the HMI device vertically 4. In the input field "Delay time", which is located in the "Startup Delay" group, set the delay time for the startup of the HMI device. The delay time is the time in seconds that is waited from the appearance of the loader until the start of the project. With the value "0", the project starts immediately. It is then no longer possible to call the loader after switching on the HMI device. In this case, an HMI device with the function "End project" would have to be configured. Valid value range is 0 s to 60 s. 5. Close the dialog and save your entries with 84 . Touch to discard the entries TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.1 Configuring the Operating System on the TP 177A Result The regional settings for the HMI device screen have now been changed Screen orientation The orientation of the screen has already been configured by the configuration engineer when setting up the project. When transferring the project to the HMI device, a suitable orientation of the screen is set automatically. NOTICE When a project is available on the HMI device, do not change the screen orientation afterwards. You can, for example, change the orientation of the screen in the Control Panel if you need to operate the loader on a vertically mounted HMI device without a project. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 85 Configuring the Operating System 6.1 Configuring the Operating System on the TP 177A 6.1.2.3 Displaying Information about the HMI Device Requirement The "OP Properties" dialog has been opened with the "OP" icon. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Open the "OP Properties" dialog and select the "Device" tab. HMI device name Size of the internal flash memory in which the HMI device image and project are stored Version of the boot loader Boot loader release date Version of the HMI device image 2. The "Device" tab displays the HMI-device-specific information and is read-only. You will need this information if you contact A&D Technical Support. 3. Use or to close the dialog when the information is no longer required. Note The size of the internal flash memory does not correspond to the available working memory for a project. 86 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.1 Configuring the Operating System on the TP 177A 6.1.2.4 Calibrating the Touch Screen Introduction Depending on the mounting position and viewing angle, it is possible that parallax may occur when operating the HMI device. In order to prevent any operating errors as a result, calibrate the touch screen again in the startup phase or during runtime. Requirement The "OP Properties" dialog has been opened with the "OP" icon. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Open the "OP Properties" dialog, then select the "Touch" tab. If the HMI device does not react precisely to a touch, the touch screen may require calibration. Button for calibrating the touch screen 2. Touch the "Recalibrate" button. The following dialog appears. &DUHIXOO\SUHVVDQGEULHIO\KROGVW\OXVRQWKHFHQWHURI WKHWDUJHW5HSHDWDVWKHWDUJHWPRYHVDURXQGWKHVFUHHQ Carefully press the center of the calibration crosshairs. Repeat the process as long as the calibration crosshairs move on the touch screen. Calibration crosshair TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 87 Configuring the Operating System 6.1 Configuring the Operating System on the TP 177A 3. Briefly touch the calibration crosshairs. The calibration crosshairs then goes to four more positions. Touch the center of the calibration crosshairs for each position. If you do not touch the center of the calibration crosshair, the procedure is repeated. Once you have touched the calibration crosshairs for all positions, the following dialog appears: New calibration settings have been measured. Tap the screen to register saved data. Wait for 30 seconds to cancel saved data and keep the current setting. Time limit: 30 sec The new calibration values are measured. Touch the touch screen to save the calibration values. If you do not touch the screen within 30 seconds, the new calibration values will be discarded. Time remaining until the calibration values are discarded 4. Touch the screen within 30 seconds The new calibration is saved. If you wait longer than 30 seconds, the new calibration is discarded and the original calibration remains in effect. 5. Close the dialog with The Control Panel is displayed. Result The HMI device touch screen is now recalibrated. 88 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.1 Configuring the Operating System on the TP 177A 6.1.2.5 Display License Information Requirement The "OP Properties" dialog has been opened with the "OP" icon. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. From the "OP Properties" dialog, select the "License" tab. The "License" tab displays the license information for the software of the HMI device. 2. Use 6.1.2.6 or to close the dialog when the information is no longer required. Changing the Password Settings Requirement The "Password Properties" dialog has been opened with the "Password" icon. Input field for the password Input field for repeating the password TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 89 Configuring the Operating System 6.1 Configuring the Operating System on the TP 177A Procedure - entering a password Proceed as follows: 1. Enter a password in the "Password" input field. Touch the input field. The alphanumerical screen keyboard is displayed. 2. Repeat the password entry in the "Confirm Password" input field. 3. Close the dialog with . NOTICE Your password must not contain blank spaces or special characters * ? . % / \ ' ". Result The Control Panel is now protected against unauthorized access. Without entering a password, you can read some settings but you cannot change them. NOTICE If the password is no longer available, you cannot change settings in the Control Panel and taskbar unless you update the operating system. All data on the HMI device will be overwritten when you update the operating system! Procedure - deleting a password Proceed as follows: 1. Delete the entries in the "Password" and "Confirm password" input fields. 2. Close the dialog with . Result The password protection for the Control Panel has been removed. 90 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.1 Configuring the Operating System on the TP 177A 6.1.2.7 Changing MPI/DP Settings Requirement The "MPI/DP - Transfer Settings" dialog has been opened with the "MPI/DP Settings" icon. Bus address of the HMI device Data transmission rate Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Enter the bus address for the HMI device in the "Address" input field Touch the input field. The numerical screen keyboard is displayed. 2. Select the data transfer rate for communication in the "Baud rate" input field. Touch the input field. The symbolic screen keyboard is displayed. 3. Close the dialog with . NOTICE Address in the MPI / PROFIBUS DP network The value specified in the "Address" input field should be used in an MPI / PROFIBUS DP network just once. Note During the transfer of a project to the HMI device, the MPI / DP settings will be overwritten with the values from the transferred project. Result The MPI / DP settings of the HMI device have been changed. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 91 Configuring the Operating System 6.1 Configuring the Operating System on the TP 177A General information NOTICE Transfer mode using MPI / PROFIBUS DP The bus parameters for MPI / PROFIBUS DP transfer, e.g. the MPI / PROFIBUS DP address of the HMI device, will be read from the project currently loaded on the HMI device. You can change the settings for MPI / PROFIBUS DP transfer. To do this, you must first end the project and then change the settings on the HMI device. Then return to transfer mode. The HMI device uses the new MPI / PROFIBUS DP settings until you transfer another project to it. During the transfer of a project to the HMI device, the MPI / PROFIBUS DP settings will be overwritten with the values from the transferred project. You can thus edit the MPI / DP settings for the TP 177A irrespective of the project settings. Transfer settings A project can only be transferred from the configuration PC to the HMI device when at least one of the data channels is enabled on the HMI device. Do not change the transfer settings if a project is running or the HMI device is in transfer mode. 6.1.2.8 Setting the Screen Saver Introduction You can set a period of time for automatic activation of the screen saver on the HMI device. The screen saver is automatically activated if the HMI device is not operated within the specified period of time. The screen saver switches off in the following cases: When you touch the touch screen. A message is displayed. Requirement The "Screen Saver Settings" dialog has been opened with the "Screen Saver" 92 icon. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.1 Configuring the Operating System on the TP 177A Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Enter the number of minutes before the screen saver is to be activated. Touch the input field. You can enter a value between 5 and 360 minutes. Entering "0" deactivates the screen saver. 2. Close the dialog and save your entries with . Touch to discard the entries. NOTICE Activating the screen saver You should always activate the screen saver. Otherwise, the screen contents may leave a burn-in effect in the background if they appear too long. This effect is reversible, however. Result The screen saver for the HMI device has now been set. 6.1.2.9 Configuring the Data Channel Introduction If you block all data channels, the HMI device is protected against unintentional overwriting of the project data and HMI device image. Requirement The "Transfer Settings" dialog has been opened with the "Transfer" icon. Group for the data channel 1 (channel 1) Group for the data channel 2 (channel 2) Button for the "MPI / DP Transfer Settings" dialog TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 93 Configuring the Operating System 6.1 Configuring the Operating System on the TP 177A Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Configure the data channel that you want to use. You can clear the required data channel by activating the associated "Enable Channel" check box in the "Channel 1" or "Channel 2" group. In the "Channel 1" group, the RS 485 port is configured for the serial data transfer. - Activate the "Enable Channel" check box to enable the data channel. - Deactivate the "Enable Channel" check box to lock the data channel. 2. Automatically configure the transfer for the data channel 2. - Deactivate the "Remote Control" check box to disable automatic transfer. - Activate the "Remote Control" check box to enable automatic transfer. WARNING Unintentional transfer mode Ensure that the configuration PC does not inadvertently switch the HMI device to transfer mode during the open project. This could cause unintentional actions to be triggered in the plant. 3. Using the "Advanced" button, go to the "MPI / DP - Transfer Settings" dialog where you can change the MPI / DP settings Close the "MPI / DP - Transfer Settings" dialog after changing the MPI / DP settings with . 4. Close the "Transfer Settings" dialog and save your entries with Touch to accept the entries. to discard the entries Result The data channel is configured. 94 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.1 Configuring the Operating System on the TP 177A General information NOTICE Transfer mode using MPI / PROFIBUS DP The bus parameters for MPI / PROFIBUS DP transfer, e.g. the MPI / PROFIBUS DP address of the HMI device, will be read from the project currently loaded on the HMI device. You can change the settings for MPI / PROFIBUS DP transfer. To do this, you must first end the project and then change the settings on the HMI device. Then return to "Transfer" mode. During the transfer of a project to the HMI device, the MPI / DP settings will be overwritten with the values from the transferred project. Transfer settings A project can only be transferred from the configuration PC to the HMI device when at least one of the data channels is enabled on the HMI device. See also Changing MPI/DP Settings (Page 91) TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 95 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 6.2.1 Overview Loader The figure below shows the Loader. The Loader buttons have the following functions: Use the "Transfer" button to set "Transfer" mode on the HMI device. The transfer mode can only be activated when at least one data channel has been enabled for the transfer. Press the "Start" button to open the project stored on the HMI device. Press "Control Panel" to open the HMI device Control Panel The Control Panel is used to configure various settings such as the transfer settings. Press the "Taskbar" button to activate the taskbar containing the open Windows CE Start menu. 96 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B Password protection You can protect the Control Panel and taskbar from unauthorized access. When password protection is enabled, the message "password protect" is displayed in the Loader. If the password is not entered, only the "Transfer" and "Start" buttons are operable. This prevents inadvertent operations and increases security for the plant or machine because the settings cannot be changed when a project is not open. NOTICE If the password is no longer available, you cannot change settings in the Control Panel and taskbar unless you update the operating system. All data on the HMI device will be overwritten when you update the operating system! See also Changing the Password Settings (Page 115) Switching on and Testing the HMI Device (Page 68) Configuring the Data Channel (Page 126) TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 97 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 6.2.2 Control Panel 6.2.2.1 Overview Control Panel of the HMI Device The settings you can make in the Control Panel of the HMI device include: Communication Date/time Screen saver Backup and restore Regional settings Transfer settings Delay time Password Opening the Control Panel Touch the "Control Panel" button in the Loader to open the HMI device Control Panel. The following options are available to open the Loader: The Loader appears briefly after starting the HMI device. Closing a Project If configured, touch the relevant operator control object to stop the project. The Loader opens. Refer to your plant documentation to find any additional information on this topic. 98 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B "Backup / Restore" Backing up and restoring the HMI device image and the project on memory cards "Communication Properties" Setting device names for network operation "Date / Time" Setting the date and time of day on the HMI device "InputPanel" Configuring the screen keyboard "Keyboard" Setting the character repeat for the screen keyboard "Mouse" Setting the double-click on the touch screen "Network" Setting network parameters "OP" Changing screen settings, displaying information about HMI device, calibrating the touch screen "Password" Setting password protection for the Control Panel "Printer" Configuring printers "Regional Settings" Making local region settings "S7 Transfer Settings" Setting the transfer parameters for MPI / DP "Screen Saver" Configuring the screen saver "System" Displaying information about the operating system, processor and memory "Transfer" Configuring a data channel for the transfer "WinCC Internet Settings" Parameters for using the Internet - for PN HMI devices only Procedure Proceed as follows to change settings in the Control Panel: 1. You must exit the project before changing settings in the Control Panel. Use the provided operating element. 2. Open the Control Panel as described above. 3. Open the desired dialog by double-clicking on the corresponding icon in the Control Panel. Enter the required password if the Control Panel is protected against unauthorized access. 4. Change settings for your HMI device in the Control Panel To change settings, touch the respective input field or check box and use the displayed screen keyboard if necessary. 5. Press or use the button to close the dialog. 6. Press the button or to close the Control Panel. 7. Start the project in the loader. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 99 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 6.2.2.2 Input Using the Screen Keyboard Introduction A variety of screen keyboards are available to input information outside an open project, for example in the Control Panel. A screen keyboard appears as soon as you touch an input field. You can switch the screen keyboard and change its position on screen. Confirm your entries with or discard your entries with . Either action closes the screen keyboard. Screen Keyboard Outside an Open Project Numerical screen keyboard Alphanumerical screen keyboard The alphanumerical keyboard has multiple levels. 1. Normal level 2. Shift level 3. Level on which the control keys are activated The figure shows the normal level of the alphanumeric screen keyboard. You can also reduce both screen keyboards: 100 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B Switching between Screen Keyboards switches between the alphanumerical and numerical screen keyboards switches between the normal level and Shift level of the alphanumerical screen keyboard activates and deactivates the numerical and alphanumerical keys of the alphanumerical screen keyboard switches from full display to reduced display switches from reduced display to full display closes the reduced display of the screen keyboard Moving the Screen Keyboard on the Touch Screen You can move the screen keyboard if it blocks you from operating a dialog in any way. 1. Touch . Keep touch contact to move the screen keyboard on the touch screen. Release touch contact on the icon when the required position is reached. 6.2.2.3 Configuring the Screen Keyboard Introduction In the Control Panel you can configure the screen keyboard that is used to make entries outside an open project. Requirement The "Siemens HMI Input Panel - Options" dialog has been opened with the "Input Panel" icon. Button for displaying the screen keyboard Button for saving the screen keyboard TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 101 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B Procedure 1. Touch the "Open Input Panel" button. The screen keyboard is displayed. The "Siemens HMI Input Panel - Options" dialog changes its appearance. Button for closing the screen keyboard Button for saving the screen keyboard 2. Touch the button of the screen keyboard two toggle between the numerical and alphanumerical screen keyboard. Set the position of the screen keyboard. 3. Touch the "Save" button to save the settings. 4. Touch the "Close Input Panel" button to close the screen keyboard. 5. Close the dialog with or . Result The screen keyboard settings have been modified. See also Input Using the Screen Keyboard (Page 100) 102 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 6.2.2.4 Setting the Character Repeat for the Screen Keyboard Introduction In the Control Panel you can set the character repeat for the screen keyboard that is used to make entries outside an open project. Requirement The "Keyboard Properties" dialog has been opened with the "Keyboard" icon. Check box for activating the character repeat Slider control and buttons for the delay time before character repeat Slider control and buttons for the rate of the character repeat Test field You can change the settings in the "Keyboard Properties" dialog with the buttons or the slide bar. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Specify whether or not the character repeat of the keyboard should be activated - Activate the "Enable character repeat" check box to enable the character repeat - Deactivate the "Enable character repeat" check box to disable the character repeat 2. Use the buttons or slide bar to set the use and rate of the character repeat 3. Verify your settings - Touch the test field. The screen keyboard opens. - Move the screen keyboard as needed. - Touch any character and keep it pressed - Check the activation of the character repeat and its rate in the test field - Correct your setting if necessary 4. Close the dialog and save your entries with . Touch to discard the entries. Result The character repeat for the keyboard is now set. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 103 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 6.2.2.5 Setting the Double-click on the Touch Screen Introduction You can start application in the Control Panel and in Windows CE with a double-click, two brief touches is sequence. Set the time between two touches in the Control Panel. Requirement The "Mouse Properties" dialog has been opened with the "Mouse" icon. Touch the pattern twice in sequence to set the time and spatial distance between the touches on the screen. Specimen Icon Touch the icon twice in sequence to check the settings of your double-click. If the icon does not change, adjust your settings using the pattern again. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Touch the pattern twice - The pattern is displayed in inverse colors at the second touch 2. Touch the icon twice If the double-click is detected, the icon is displayed as follows at the second touch. 3. If the icon remains unchanged, double-click on the pattern again. . Touch 4. Close the dialog and save your entries with to discard the entries. Result The double-click on the touch screen is now set. 104 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 6.2.2.6 Backup and Restore Using a Memory Card Introduction A backup involves copying the operating system, applications and data in flash memory of the HMI device to a memory card. A restore operation deletes all old data from flash memory of the HMI device on confirmation. The data stored on the memory card is then copied to the internal flash memory. Requirement A memory card with 16 MB capacity is inserted in the HMI device. The "Backup/Restore" dialog has been opened with the "Backup/Restore" icon. Button for data backup Button for data restore Procedure for backup Proceed as follows: 1. Touch the "BACKUP" button. The message "Starting backup" is displayed. The following message appears if no memory card is inserted in the card slot or if the memory card is damaged: Then perform steps 2 and 3. 2. Touch . This message is displayed: "Backup aborted". 3. Confirm with "OK." The Control Panel is displayed again. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 105 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B Repeat the procedure with a suitable memory card. 1. Using the memory card 2. Touch the "BACKUP" button. The message "Storage card detected" is displayed. - A warning is displayed if the available space is insufficient. The backup is aborted. Delete any unneeded data on the memory card using the Windows CE Explorer. - If the memory card contains data, the following message is displayed: "You have an old backup on the storage card. Do you want to delete it?". 3. Press "Yes" if you want to delete the data. Press "No" if you want to retain the data. The messages "Checking the registry settings" and "Saving CE image" are displayed in sequence when the backup begins. A progress bar shows the status of the process. The backup ends with the following message: "Backup successfully completed. Touch OK and remove memory card." 4. Touch the "OK" button. The Control Panel is displayed. Result The HMI device data is now saved on the memory card. Procedure for restoring Proceed as follows: 1. Touch the "RESTORE" button. The message "Restore started" is displayed. The following message appears if no memory card is inserted in the card slot or if the memory card is damaged: Then perform steps 2 and 4. 2. Touch . This message is displayed: "Restore aborted". Remove the memory card". 3. Remove the memory card. 4. Confirm with "OK." The Control Panel is displayed again. 106 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B Repeat the procedure with a suitable memory card. 1. Using the memory card 2. Touch the "RESTORE" button. This message is displayed: "Restore started". The following message appears: "Checking data". When the data has been checked, the following message appears: "You are starting a restore. All files except those on the memory card and the registry files will be deleted. Are you sure?" 3. Press "Yes" if you want to restore the data. Press "No" if you want to cancel the restore. The messages "Deleting files in the internal Flash memory" and "Restoring CE image" are displayed in sequence once the restore process begins. A progress bar shows the status of the process. The restore ends with the message "The restore of the CE images is completed. The HMI device will now be restarted. Do not remove the memory card." 4. Touch the "OK" button. The operating system boots, opening the Loader and Control Panel in sequence. Two messages appear. Then the final message appears: "Restore successfully completed. Touch OK and remove memory card." 5. Touch the "OK" button. The HMI device boots. The Control Panel is displayed. 6. Remove the memory card, if necessary. Store the memory card in a safe place. Result The data from the memory card is now on the HMI device. The existing licenses are retained on the HMI device, all other files have been deleted. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 107 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 6.2.2.7 Setting the Date and Time Requirement The "Date/Time Properties" dialog has been opened with the "Date/Time Properties" icon. Time zone Time Date "Daylight savings" check box Button for applying changes Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Select the appropriate time zone for the HMI device from the "Time Zone" selection list. 2. Touch the "Apply" button to confirm your entry. The time of day shown in the "Current Time" box is adjusted correspondingly to the selected time zone. 3. Set the date in the selection field. 4. Set the current time of day in the "Current Time" text box. 5. Touch the "Apply" button to confirm your input. The values you have set are now in effect. Note The system does not automatically switch between winter and summer time! 108 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 6. If you want to switch from winter to summer time, select the "Daylight savings time currently in effect" check box. When you press the "Apply" button, the time is brought forward by one hour. 7. If you want to switch from summer to winter time, deactivate the "Daylight savings time currently in effect" check box. When you press the "Apply" button, the time is moved backwards by one hour. 8. Close the dialog and save your entries with Touch . to discard the entries. NOTICE Reboot the HMI device if you have made changes to the time zone. Result The settings for the date and time of day have now been changed. Synchronizing the date and time with the PLC The date and time of the HMI device can be synchronized with the controller, if this has been configured in the project and the controller program. Additional information on this subject is available in the "WinCC flexible" system manual. NOTICE Synchronize the date and time if time-based reactions are to be triggered in the PLC. 6.2.2.8 Saving Registry Information Introduction If you are running your own programs on the HMI device under MS Windows CE, you should back up the registry information after installing the programs. There are several ways to save files: Save the registry information to the Flash memory. Save files in a temporary folder to the Flash memory. Saving to the Flash memory allows you to automatically restore the file system on the HMI device. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 109 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B Requirement The "OP Properties" dialog has been opened with the "OP" icon. Saves the current registry information to the flash memory. The HMI device loads the saved registry information the next time it boots. Button for saving registry information Button for saving temporary files Saves all the files in temporary storage to the flash memory (for example, from the "Program Files" directory). These files are written back the next time the HMI device starts. The "\Temp" directory is not saved. Check box for automatically restoring the file system on the memory card when the HMI device starts up and when a memory card is inserted. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Touch the "Save Registry" button to save the current registry settings 2. Touch the "Save Files" button to save temporary files 3. Specify whether or not the file system on the memory card should be restored when the HMI device starts up or when a memory card is inserted. - Activate the check box "Automatically Repair ...", if you wish to have the files system restored automatically. - Deactivate the check box "Automatically Repair ...", if you wish to have the files system restored only upon prompting. 4. Close the dialog and save your entries with . Touch to discard the entries. Result The HMI device uses the saved registry information the next time it starts. The temporary files are copied back. 110 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 6.2.2.9 Changing Screen Contrast Requirement The "OP Properties" dialog has been opened with the "OP" icon. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. From the "OP Properties" dialog, select the "Display" tab. Button for increasing the contrast Button for reducing the contrast 2. Proceed as follows to change contrast of the screen: - Touch the "UP" button to increase the contrast of the screen - Touch the "DOWN" button to decrease the contrast of the screen 3. Close the dialog and save your entries with . Touch to discard the entries Result The HMI device screen contrast has now been changed. Note You can also adjust the contrast within an open project. Refer to the corresponding system documentation for more information in this regard. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 111 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 6.2.2.10 Displaying Information about the HMI Device Requirement The "OP Properties" dialog has been opened with the "OP" icon. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Open the "OP Properties" dialog, then select the "Device" tab. HMI device name Version of the HMI device image Version of the boot loader Boot loader release date Size of the internal flash memory in which the HMI device image and project are stored MAC address of the HMI device Button for restarting the HMI device 2. The device-specific information is displayed in the "Device" tab. You will need this information if you contact A&D Technical Support. 3. Activate the "Reboot" button if you want to reboot the HMI device After you have activated the "Reboot" button, a warning is displayed on the screen. If you acknowledge this with "OK", the HMI device is rebooted immediately. 4. Use or to close the dialog when the information is no longer required. CAUTION Data loss when the HMI device is restarted All volatile data is lost when the HMI device is rebooted. No check is carried out as to whether or not the project on the HMI device is running, the communication is active whether or not data are currently being written into the flash memory. Note The size of the internal flash memory does not correspond to the available working memory for a project. 112 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 6.2.2.11 Calibrating the Touch Screen Introduction Depending on the mounting position and viewing angle, it is possible that parallax may occur when operating the HMI device. In order to prevent any operating errors as a result, calibrate the touch screen again in the startup phase or during runtime. Requirement The "OP Properties" dialog has been opened with the "OP" icon. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Open the "OP Properties" dialog, then select the "Touch" tab. If the HMI device does not react precisely to a touch, the touch screen may require calibration. Button for calibrating the touch screen 2. Touch the "Recalibrate" button. The following dialog appears. &DUHIXOO\SUHVVDQGEULHIO\KROGVW\OXVRQWKHFHQWHURI WKHWDUJHW5HSHDWDVWKHWDUJHWPRYHVDURXQGWKHVFUHHQ Carefully press the middle of the calibration crosshairs. Repeat the process as long as the calibration crosshairs move on the touch screen. Calibration crosshair TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 113 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 3. Briefly touch the calibration crosshairs. The calibration crosshairs then goes to four more positions. Touch the middle of the calibration crosshairs for each position. If you do not touch the middle of the calibration crosshairs, the procedure is repeated. Once you have touched the calibration crosshairs for all positions, the following dialog appears: New calibration settings have been measured. Tap the screen to register saved data. Wait for 30 seconds to cancel saved data and keep the current setting. Time limit: 30 sec The new calibration values are measured. Touch the touch screen to save the calibration values. If you do not touch the screen within 30 seconds, the new calibration values will be discarded. Time remaining until the calibration values are discarded 4. Touch the screen within 30 seconds The new calibration is saved. If you wait longer than 30 seconds, the new calibration is discarded and the original calibration remains in effect. 5. Close the dialog with . The Control Panel is displayed. Result The HMI device touch screen is now recalibrated. 114 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 6.2.2.12 Changing the Password Settings Introduction You can protect the Control Panel and Windows CE taskbar with a password. Requirement The "Password Properties" dialog has been opened with the "Password" icon. Input field for the password Input field for repeating the password Procedure - entering a password Proceed as follows: 1. Enter a password in the "Password" input field. Touch the input field. The alphanumerical screen keyboard is displayed. 2. Repeat the password entry in the "Confirm Password" input field. 3. Close the dialog with NOTICE Your password must not contain blank spaces or special characters * ? . % / \ ' ". Result You cannot open the Control Panel or Windows CE taskbar without entering a password. NOTICE If the password is no longer available, you cannot make changes in the Control Panel or use the Windows CE taskbar unless you update the operating system. All data on the HMI device will be overwritten when you update the operating system! TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 115 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B Procedure - deleting a password Proceed as follows: 1. Delete the entries in the "Password" and "Confirm password" input fields 2. Close the dialog with Result Password protection for the Control Panel and Windows CE taskbar has been removed. 6.2.2.13 Changing Printer Settings Printing on Network Printers HMI devices with a PROFINET interface can also print on network printers. Hardcopies and logs can be printed on network printers. Individual new incoming or outgoing alarms cannot be printed. Requirement The "Printer Properties" dialog has been opened with the "Printer" icon. 116 Printer selection list Interface Network address of the printer (applies to TP 177B 6" PN/DP and OP 177B PN/DP) Paper size selection list Orientation setting Print quality setting TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Touch the "Printer Language" selection list and select a printer 2. Touch the "Port" selection list and set the port for the printer 3. Applies to TP 177B 6" PN/DP and OP 177B PN/DP with a "Network" interface: Touch the "Network" selection field to enter the network address of the printer. The alphanumerical screen keyboard is displayed. 4. Touch the "Paper Size" selection field and select the format of the paper. 5. Touch the desired check box in the "Orientation" field: - "Portrait" - "Landscape" 6. Select the print quality. - Activate the check box "Draft Mode", if you wish to print a draft. - Deactivate the check box "Draft Mode", if you wish to print with higher quality. 7. Set the color mode. - Activate the check box "Color", if you wish to print in color. Deactivate it to print in monochrome. 8. Close the dialog and save your entries with . Touch to discard the entries. Result The settings for the printer have now been changed. Note The list of current printers and required settings for HMI devices can be found on the Internet under "http://support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/11376409". TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 117 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 6.2.2.14 Changing Regional Settings Introduction The display format of the date, time and decimal point etc. differ from region to region. You can adjust the regional settings on the HMI device to meet local requirements. Requirement The "Regional Settings Properties" dialog has been opened with the "Regional Settings" icon. Region selection list Procedure - Changing Regional Settings Proceed as follows: 1. Touch the "Regional" selection list for the language in the "Regional Settings" tab 2. Select the desired language. To do this, touch the input field. The symbolic screen keyboard is displayed. Procedure - Changing the Number Format Proceed as follows: 1. Open the "Number" tab. 2. Set the following in the selection lists: - The character for the decimal separator - The character for the thousand separator - The separator character for number sequences 3. Touch the respective selection list and set the desired value using the screen keyboard 118 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B Procedure - Changing the Time Format 1. Open the "Time" tab. 2. Set the following in the selection lists: - Time of day format - Define the separator between hours, minutes and seconds. - The format for the time before 12:00 noon. - The format for the time after 12:00 noon. 3. Touch the respective selection list and set the desired value using the screen keyboard Procedure - Changing the Date Format 1. Open the "Date" tab. 2. Set the following in the selection lists: - Define the separator between year, month and day. - The abbreviated format of the date - The full format of the date 3. Touch the respective selection list and set the desired value using the screen keyboard Procedure - Closing the Dialog 1. Close the dialog and save your entries with Touch . to discard the entries. Result The regional settings for the HMI device screen have now been changed. 6.2.2.15 Changing MPI/PROFIBUS DP Settings Requirement The "S7 Transfer Settings" dialog has been opened with the "S7 Transfer" icon. Network selection Button for opening the properties dialog TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 119 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Select a network and then touch the "Properties" button One of the two following dialogs is displayed. The HMI device is the only master on the bus. Bus address of the HMI device Time-out Data transmission rate in total network Highest station address in the network Profile Button for displaying the bus parameters 2. If more masters are connected to the bus, deactivate the check box "Panel is the only master on the bus" 3. Enter the bus address for the HMI device in the "Address" input field Touch the input field. A selection list is displayed. 4. Select the highest transmission rate from the "Transmission rate" input field Touch the input field. The symbolic screen keyboard is displayed. 120 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 5. Select the highest station address on the bus in the "Highest Station Address" input field. Touch the input field. The symbolic screen keyboard is displayed. 6. Select the desired profile from the "Profile" selection field. Touch the input field. The symbolic screen keyboard is displayed. 7. The profile data is displayed when you press the "Bus Parameters" button in the PROFIBUS dialog. This dialog is read-only. Press the button or to close the dialog. 8. Close the dialog and save your entries with . Touch to discard the entries. NOTICE Address in the MPI / PROFIBUS DP network The value specified in the "Address" input field should be used in an MPI / PROFIBUS DP network just once. Bus parameters in the MPI / PROFIBUS DP network The bus parameters must be the same for all stations in the MPI / PROFIBUS DP network. Note When a project is opened, the MPI / DP settings are overwritten with the values from the project. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 121 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B General information NOTICE Transfer mode using MPI / PROFIBUS DP The bus parameters for MPI / PROFIBUS DP transfer, e.g. the MPI / PROFIBUS DP address of the HMI device, will be read from the project currently loaded on the HMI device. You can change the settings for MPI / PROFIBUS DP transfer. To do this, you must first end the project and then change the settings on the HMI device. Then return to transfer mode. The HMI device uses the new MPI / PROFIBUS DP settings until you start a project or transfer a project to it. The MPI / PROFIBUS DP settings are then overwritten by the values from this project. Transfer settings A project can only be transferred from the configuration PC to the HMI device when at least one of the data channels is enabled on the HMI device. Do not change the transfer settings if a project is running or the HMI device is in transfer mode. Result The MPI / DP settings of the HMI device have been changed. 122 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 6.2.2.16 Setting the Delay Time Introduction The project is opened following a delay time when the HMI device is switched on. The Loader is displayed during the delay time. Requirements The "Transfer Settings" dialog has been opened with the "Transfer" icon. You have opened the "Directories" tab. Memory location for the project file Memory location for the compressed source file of your project for backtransfer. The external memory card or the network connections can be defined as the memory location. During the next backup process, the project's source file is stored in the specified location. Storage location and initialization file of the HMI device for process operation Selection list for the delay time NOTICE Settings in "Project File" and "Path" Do not change the setting in the "Project File" and "Path" fields if you are working on a project. The project may not open at the next start of the HMI if changes are made here. Procedure for setting the delay time 1. Touch the "Wait [sec]" section list. A selection list is displayed. Select the desired delay time. With the value "0", the project starts immediately. It is then no longer possible to call the loader after switching on the HMI device. If you still wish to access the loader, an operating element must be configured to close the project. 2. Close the dialog and save your entries with . Touch to discard the entries. Result The delay time for the HMI device is now set. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 123 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 6.2.2.17 Setting the Screen Saver Introduction You can set a period of time for automatic activation of the screen saver on the HMI device. The screen saver is automatically activated if the HMI device is not operated within the specified period of time. The screen saver is deactivated when any key is pressed or the touch screen is touched. The function assigned to that key is not triggered. Requirement The "Screen Saver" dialog has been opened with the "Screen Saver" icon. Period of time in minutes before the screen saver is activated Screen saver setting Enter '0' to disable the screen saver. The minimum value is 5 and the maximum value is 71582 minutes. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Enter the number of minutes before the screen saver is to be activated. Touch the input field. A selection list is displayed. Entering "0" disables the screen saver. 2. Select either the standard screen saver or an empty screen. - Activate the "Standard" radio button to enable the screen saver - Activate the "Blank Screen" radio button to enable a blank screen as the screen saver 3. Close the dialog and save your entries with . Touch to discard the entries. NOTICE Activating the screen saver Generally, you should always activate the screen saver. Otherwise, the screen contents may leave a burn-in effect in the background if they appear for too long. This effect is reversible, however. Result The screen saver for the HMI device has now been set. 124 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 6.2.2.18 Displaying System Information Requirement The "System Properties" dialog has been opened with the "System" icon. Procedure - Displaying System Information Proceed as follows: 1. Open the "General" tab. The system information is displayed. This dialog is read-only. Copyright to Microsoft Windows CE Information about the processor, amount of the internal Flash memory, and capacity of a memory card when inserted 2. Close the dialog with TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 or . 125 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B Procedure - Displaying Memory Information Proceed as follows: 1. Open the "Memory" tab. The memory information is displayed. 2. Close the dialog with or . NOTICE "Memory" Tab Do not change the amount of memory in the "Memory" tab. 6.2.2.19 Configuring the Data Channel Introduction If you block all data channels, the HMI device is protected against unintentional overwriting of the project data and HMI device image. Requirement The "Transfer Settings" dialog has been opened with the "Transfer" icon. 126 Group for the data channel 1 (channel 1) Group for the data channel 2 (channel 2) Button for the "MPI / DP Transfer Settings" or "Network Configuration" dialog TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Configure the data channel that you want to use You can clear the required data channel by activating the associated "Enable Channel" check box in the "Channel 1" or "Channel 2" group. In the "Channel 1" group, the RS -485 port is configured for the serial data transfer. - Activate the "Enable Channel" check box to enable the data channel - Deactivate the "Enable Channel" check box to lock the data channel 2. Configure the automatic transfer - Deactivate the "Remote Control" check box to disable automatic transfer - Activate the "Remote Control" check box to enable automatic transfer WARNING Unintentional transfer mode Ensure that the configuration PC does not inadvertently switch the HMI device to transfer mode during the open project. This could cause unintentional actions to be triggered in the plant. 3. Enter the required protocol for "Channel 2". Touch the input field. A selection list is displayed. 4. Touch the "Advanced" button - Applies to the "MPI / PROFIBUS DP" protocol: Touch the "Advanced" button if you wish to switch to the "S7 Transfer Settings" dialog. You can change the settings for MPI / PROFIBUS DP there. Close the "S7 Transfer Settings" dialog with . - Applies to the "ETHERNET" protocol: Touch the "Advanced" button if you wish to switch to the "Network Configuration" dialog. You can change the settings for TCP / IP there. Close the "Network Configuration" dialog with after making the changes. 5. Close the "Transfer Settings" dialog and save your entries with Touch to accept the entries. to discard the entries Result The data channel is configured. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 127 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B General information Note Changes during the "Transfer" mode If the HMI device is in "Transfer" mode while changes are made to the transfer settings, the settings only go into effect after the transfer function is restarted. This may occur if the Control Panel is opened to change the transfer properties in an active project. NOTICE Transfer mode via channel 2 The bus parameters, such as the address of the HMI device, are read from the project currently loaded on the HMI device. You can change the settings for the transfer via channel 2. To do this, you must first end the project and then change the settings on the HMI device. Then return to "Transfer" mode. The next time the project is started on the HMI device, the settings will be overwritten by the values from the project. Transfer settings A project can only be transferred from the configuration PC to the HMI device when at least one of the data channels is enabled on the HMI device. See also Changing Network Settings (Page 133) Changing MPI/PROFIBUS DP Settings (Page 119) 128 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 6.2.2.20 Overview of Network Operation Introduction The HMI device with a PROFINET interface can be connected to a TCP/IP network. Connection to a TCP/IP network can offer the following advantages: Printing via a network printer Saving recipe records to a server Exporting recipe records Importing recipe records Transferring a project Backing up data These advantages are not available with a direct PC connection. However, peripherals connected to the PC can be used. For example, you can use a local printer for printing. NOTICE The HMI device can only be used in TCP/IP and PROFINET networks. The HMI device only has client functionality in the PC network. This means that users can access files of a subscriber with TCP/IP server functionality from the HMI device via the network. However, it is not possible to access files on the HMI device via the network from a PC. Note Information on communication using SIMATIC S7 via PROFINET is provided in the "WinCC flexible Communication" user manual. Requirements Within a TCP/IP or PROFINET network, computers are addressed using network names. These network names are translated from a DNS or WINS server to TCP/IP and PROFINET addresses. Direct addressing via TCP/IP and PROFINET addresses is also supported by the operating system. This is why a DNS or WINS server is needed for addressing via device name names when the HMI device is in a TCP/IP or PROFINET network. Appropriate servers are available in common TCP/IP and PROFINET networks. Consult your network administrator if you have questions in this regard. Printing via a Network Printer The HMI device's operating system does not support the direct alarm logging via a network printer. All other printer functions, such as printing hardcopies or logs, are possible via the network without restriction. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 129 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B General Procedure for Configuring the Network The HMI device must be appropriately configured before setting into network operation. The configuration is basically divided into the following steps: Set device name of the HMI device. Configure the network address. Set the logon information. Save the settings. Switch off the HMI device once the network is configured. If your network address is assigned automatically: Before switching the HMI device on, insert the network cable in the corresponding interface so that a unique IP address for the HMI device can be assigned during startup. Switch on the HMI device. Preparation Before beginning the configuration, request the following network parameters from your network administrator. Does the network use DHCP for dynamic assignment of network addresses? If not, get a new TCP/IP network address for the HMI device. What is the TCP/IP address of the default gateway? If a DNS network is used, what is the address of the name server? If a WINS network is used, what is the address of the name server? 130 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 6.2.2.21 Setting the Device Name of the HMI Device Requirement The "Communications Properties" dialog has been opened with the "Communications" icon. The HMI device uses this information to identify itself to other PCs. Device name of the HMI device Description for the HMI device (optional) Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Enter the device name for the HMI device in the "Device name" input field. Touch the input field. The screen keyboard is displayed. 2. Enter a description for the HMI device in the "Device description" input field. Touch the input field. The screen keyboard is displayed. 3. Close the dialog and save your entries with . Touch to discard the entries. Result The device name for the HMI device is now set. Note Change the device name for the HMI device in the "Device name" input field to activate the network functions. See also Overview of Network Operation (Page 129) TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 131 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 6.2.2.22 Activating a Direct Connection Requirement The "Communications Properties" dialog has been opened with the "Communications" icon. These settings control the connection between the HMI device and a desktop computer. Enabling a direct connection Button for changing the desktop computer Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Open the "PC Connection" tab. The information about the direct connection is displayed. 2. Close the dialog with . NOTICE "PC Connection" Tab If you want to operate a project on the HMI device, do not change the information in the "PC Connection" tab. 132 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 6.2.2.23 Changing Network Settings Requirement The "Network Configuration" dialog has been opened with the "Network" icon. Selection for PROFINET adapters MAC address of the HMI device Button for the properties dialog Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Touch the " SMSC100FD1: Onboard LAN Ethernet Driver" 2. Touch the "Properties" button The "Onboard LAN Ethernet Driver" dialog is displayed. Address assignment setting Input field for the IP address Input field for the address of the subnet mask Input field for the address of the default gateway TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 133 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 3. Select either automatic address assignment via DHCP or manual address assignment 4. If you set the address yourself, use the screen keyboard and enter the respective addresses in the input fields for "IP Address", "Subnet Mask" and, if used, "Default Gateway." 5. If a name server (DNS) is used in the network, open the "Name Server" tab. The "Name Servers" tab of the "Onboard LAN Ethernet Driver" dialog is displayed: 6. Enter the respective addresses in the input fields using the screen keyboard. 7. Close the dialog and save your entries with . Touch to discard the entries Once you have applied the settings, you are prompted to reboot the HMI device. 8. When prompted, open the "Device" tab of the "OP Properties" dialog and reboot the HMI device Result The network parameters for the HMI device have now been set. See also Displaying Information about the HMI Device (Page 112) Overview of Network Operation (Page 129) 134 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 6.2.2.24 Changing the Logon Information Requirements The "Network Configuration" dialog has been opened with the "Network" icon. Windows CE uses this information to gain access to the network resources. Enter the user name, password and domain you have received from your administrator Input field for the user name Input field for the password Input field for the domain Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Enter the user name in the "User name" input field 2. Touch the input field. The screen keyboard is displayed. 3. Enter your password in the "Password" input field Touch the input field. The screen keyboard is displayed. 4. Enter the domain name in the "Domain" input field Touch the input field. The screen keyboard is displayed. 5. Close the dialog and save your entries with . Touch to discard the entries. Result The logon data has now been set. See also Overview of Network Operation (Page 129) TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 135 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 6.2.2.25 Changing Internet Settings Requirement The "WinCC flexible Internet Settings" dialog has been opened with the "WinCC Internet Settings" icon. Procedure - Changing E-mail Settings Proceed as follows: 1. Select the "Email" tab. Setting for the SMTP server Name for the sender E-mail account 2. Specify the SMTP server - Activate the check box "Use the default of the project file" if you want to use the SMTP server permanently configured in the project - Deactivate the check box "Use the default of the project file" if you do not want to use the SMTP server permanently configured in the project Touch the input field to enter the SMTP server. The screen keyboard is displayed. 3. Enter the name for the sender in the "Sender" input field Touch the input field. The screen keyboard is displayed. 4. Enter the e-mail account for your e-mail in the "Authentication" input field Touch the input field. The screen keyboard is displayed. Some e-mail providers only allow you to send mail if you specify the e-mail account. The "Authentication" input field can remain empty if your e-mail provider allows you to send mail without checking the account. 136 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.2 Configuring the operating system for TP 177B 6" and OP 177B Procedure - changing proxy settings Proceed as follows: 1. Select the "Proxy" tab Check box for using a proxy server Address of the proxy server Port 2. Activate the check box "Use proxy server" if you want to use a proxy server 3. If you use a proxy server: Specify the address of the proxy server and the desired port. Touch the corresponding input field. The screen keyboard is displayed. 4. Close the dialog and save your entries with . Touch to discard the entries. Result The Internet settings have been changed. Note Options Additional tabs may appear in the "WinCC Internet Settings" tab. This depends on the options that have been enabled for network operation in the project. Refer to your plant documentation to find any additional information on this topic. See also Overview of Network Operation (Page 129) TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 137 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.1 Loader Overview The figure below shows the Loader. The header line contains details of the loader version. These details are not shown in the following figure. The Loader buttons have the following functions: Press the "Transfer" button to set the HMI device to "Transfer" mode. The transfer mode can only be activated when at least one data channel has been enabled for the transfer. Press the "Start" button to start the project on the HMI device. If you do not perform an operation, the project on the HMI device will automatically start after a delay. Press the "Control Panel" button to open the HMI device Control Panel. You can change various settings in the Control Panel, for example, the transfer settings. Press the "Taskbar" button to activate the taskbar with the Windows CE start menu open. 138 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" Open Loader The following options are available to open the Loader: The Loader appears briefly after starting the HMI device. The Loader appears when the project is closed. If configured, use the relevant operating element to close the project. For further information on this, refer to your plant documentation. Protection against unauthorized access You can use a password to protect the Control Panel and taskbar from unauthorized access. In addition, you can protect the taskbar and the desktop with the aid of the SecureMode. If the HMI device is protected, the label "secure mode" will be displayed on the Windows CE desktop. For more information, refer to SecureMode in section "Setting up and disabling SecureMode (Page 140)". The "Transfer" and "Start" buttons can always be operated without a password entry. Password protection prevents maloperation. This in turn increases security on the plant or machine. The settings for the active project can only be changed by entering the password. NOTICE Password not available If the password is no longer available, you can execute the following once you have first reset the computer to factory settings: * Change settings in the Control Panel * Operating the Windows CE taskbar All data on the HMI device will be deleted when you update the operating system! Therefore use the password to protect against loss. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 139 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.2 Setting up and disabling SecureMode Overview You can use a password to protect the Control Panel against unauthorized access. You can also protect the taskbar and the desktop with the aid of the SecureMode. Function of SecureMode You set up the SecureMode by setting up a password in the Control Panel. The SecureMode is then automatically activated. The label "secure mode" will be displayed on the Windows CE desktop. For more information, refer to the "Changing password protection (Page 151)" section. If you now operate a function in the taskbar or the desktop, you must enter a password. After entering the password, the label "secure mode" is no longer displayed. All functions in the taskbar and the desktop can now be operated. To reactivate SecureMode, double-click the symbol on the desktop. The label "secure mode" will be shown again. The HMI device is protected again. Disabling SecureMode To completely disable SecureMode, delete the password. 140 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.3 Control Panel 6.3.3.1 Overview The HMI device's Control Panel is similar to the control panel on a PC. The Control Panel looks like this: The control panel can be used to modify the following settings: Date and time Screen saver Regional settings Transfer settings Network settings Delay time Password TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 141 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.3.2 Opening the Control Panel Introduction The HMI device Control Panel can be opened as follows: Independently of a running project - Press the "Control panel" button in the loader. - By calling up from the Windows CE start menu. With active project An operating element must be configured to open the Control Panelfor this purpose. Procedure - open the Control Panel via the Start menu Proceed as follows: 1. Open the Windows CE start menu. Alternatively, press the key twice on the alphanumerical screen keyboard. 2. Select "Settings > Control panel". Result The control panel is opened. 6.3.3.3 Reference for functions Overview of functions The following table shows the settings in the Control Panel. Icon 142 Function Tab / entry Saving and restoring with external storage device - Importing, displaying and deleting certificates "Stores" Setting the date and time "Date/Time" Configuring the screen keyboard - Setting the character repeat for the keyboard "Repeat" Setting the double-click "Double-Click" TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" Icon Function Tab / entry Configuring the LAN connection "LAN9115" Setting the IP address "'LAN9115'Settings" "IP Address" Set name server "'LAN9115'Settings" "Name Servers" Changing Ethernet settings "'LAN9115'Settings" "Ethernet Parameters" Changing the logon data "Network ID" Backup registry information "Persistent Storage" Changing monitor settings "Display" Displaying information about the HMI device "Device" Restarting the HMI device "Device" Calibrating the touch screen "Touch" Activate memory management "Memory Monitoring" Changing password protection "Password Settings" Changing the printer properties - Changing the PROFINET IO setting - Changing regional settings "Regional Settings" Changing the number format "Number" Changing the currency format "Currency" Changing the time format "Time" Changing the date format "Date" Changing transfer settings "MPI" Changing the PROFIBUS DP transfer settings "PROFIBUS" S7 Ethernet settings "S7-Ethernet" Setting the screen saver - Reducing the backlit display Displaying system properties "General" Displaying memory information "Memory" Setting the device name of the HMI device "Device Name" Configuring the data channel "Channel" Setting the delay time "Directories" Setting the uninterruptible power supply "Configuration" State of uninterruptible power supply "Current Status" Changing e-mail 1) settings1) "Email" Additional tabs may appear in the "WinCC flexible Internet Settings" dialog. This depends on the options that have been enabled for network operation in the project. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 143 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.3.4 Operator control options for the Control Panel Entries using the touch screen The operating elements shown in the dialogs are touch-sensitive. Touch objects are basically operated in the same way as mechanical keys. You activate operating elements by touching them with your finger. To double-click them, touch an operating element twice in succession. Entries using an external USB keyboard An external keyboard can be used to operate the Control Panel in exactly the same way as the HMI device keyboard. Use the keys of the external keyboard which correspond to the HMI device keys in the description. Operating using an external USB mouse An external mouse can be used to operate the Control Panel in exactly the same way as the HMI device touch screen. Click the described operating elements with the mouse. 6.3.3.5 Operating the Control Panel with the touch screen Introduction The control panel is operated with the HMI device touch screen or a connected mouse. Requirement An active project has been terminated. The Loader appears. Procedure Proceed as follows to change settings in the Control Panel: 1. Open the Control Panel with the "Control Panel" button. 2. To open the required dialog, double-click on its icon. 3. Change the tab as required. 4. Make the necessary changes. Touch the corresponding input object. - Use the screen keyboard of the HMI device to enter the new values in the text boxes. - Touch a button to operate it. - To open a selection list, touch the triangle at the end of the field. Touch the required entry from the selection list. - Touch the check box to activate or deactivate a check box. - Touch a radio button to select it. 5. Confirm the selection with the button or abort the entry with the button. The dialog closes. 6. Close the Control Panel with the button. The Loader appears. 144 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" Input with the screen keyboard A screen keyboard is available for data input. The screen keyboard is displayed as soon as you touch a text box. You can also call up the screen keyboard directly from the Control Panel. Display methods for the screen keyboard You can change the display method for the screen keyboard and fix the position on the screen. Confirm the entry with the button or abort the entry with the key. Either action closes the screen keyboard. Numerical screen keyboard Alphanumerical screen keyboard The alphanumerical keyboard is organized in the following two layers: - Normal level - Shift level Reduced screen keyboard TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 145 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" Changing the display of the screen keyboard Key Function Switching between the numerical and alphanumerical keyboard Switching between the normal level and Shift level of the alphanumerical screen keyboard Switching from full display to reduced display Switching from reduced display to full display Closing the reduced display on the screen keyboard 6.3.4 Changing settings for operation 6.3.4.1 Configuring the screen keyboard Introduction You can set at which screen position and in which view the screen keyboard will open. Requirements You have opened the "Siemens HMI Input Panel - Options" dialog with the "InputPanel" icon. 146 Button for displaying the screen keyboard Button for saving the screen keyboard settings TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Use the "Open Input Panel" button to open the screen keyboard. 2. If you want to switch between the numerical and alphanumerical screen keyboard, press the key. 3. If you want to change the position of the screen keyboard, use the mouse pointer to select a free space between the keys. Move the screen keyboard to the required position and release the mouse pointer once you have reached the required position. 4. If you want to save the settings, press the "Save" button. 5. Confirm your entries. The dialog closes. Result The screen keyboard settings have been modified. 6.3.4.2 Setting the character repeat Introduction You can use this function to set the character repeat and associated delay for the screen keyboard. Requirement You have opened the "Keyboard Properties" dialog with the "Keyboard" icon. Check box for activating the character repeat Slider control and buttons for the delay time before character repeat Slider control and buttons for the rate of the character repeat Test field TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 147 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. If you want to enable character repetition, activate the "Enable character repeat" check box. 2. If you want to change the delay, press a button or the slider in the "Repeat delay" group. Moving the slider to the right will shorten the delay. Moving to the left will extend the delay. 3. If you want to change the repeat rate, press a button or the slider in the "Repeat rate" group. Moving the slider to the right will shorten the repeat rate. Moving to the left will extend the repeat rate. 4. Touch the test field in order to check the settings. The screen keyboard opens. 5. Move the screen keyboard as needed. 6. Press an alphanumeric key and keep the key pressed down. Check the implementation of the character repetition and the rate of the character repetition in the test field. 7. If the settings are not perfect, correct them. 8. Confirm your entries. The dialog closes. Result The character repetition and delay are set. 6.3.4.3 Setting the double-click Introduction You can start applications in the Control Panel and in Windows CE with a double-click. A double-click corresponds to two brief touches in sequence. In the "Mouse Properties" dialog, make the following adjustments for touch screen operation and operation with external mouse: Interval between touch contacts on the touch screen Interval between mouse clicks 148 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" Requirement You have opened the "Mouse Properties" dialog with the "Mouse" icon. Pattern Icon Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Click the pattern twice. After one double-click, the grid is shown in inverse colors. The white fields change to grey. The time before the second click is saved. 2. Check the double-click. Click on the icon twice in succession to do this. If the double-click is recognized, the icon is displayed as follows: 3. If the settings are not perfect, correct them. To do this, repeat steps 1 to 2. 4. Confirm your entries. The dialog closes. Result The double-click adjustment is completed. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 149 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.4.4 Calibrating the touch screen Introduction Depending on the mounting position and viewing angle, it is possible that parallax may occur when operating the touch screen. In order to prevent any operating errors as a result, calibrate the touch screen again in the startup phase or during runtime. Requirement You have opened the "OP Properties" dialog box, "Touch" tab, by touching the icon. "OP" If the HMI device does not react precisely to a touch, the touch screen may require calibration. Button for calibrating the touch screen Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Click on the "Recalibrate" button. The following dialog opens: &DUHIXOO\SUHVVDQGEULHIO\KROGVW\OXVRQWKHFHQWHURI WKHWDUJHW5HSHDWDVWKHWDUJHWPRYHVDURXQGWKHVFUHHQ 150 Carefully press the center of the calibration crosshairs. Repeat this process as long as the calibration crosshair moves on the touch screen. Calibration crosshair TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 2. Briefly touch the center of the calibration crosshairs . The calibration crosshairs is then displayed at four more positions. 3. Briefly touch the middle of the calibration crosshairs for each position. Once you have touched all the positions of the calibration crosshairs, the following dialog appears: New calibration settings have been measured. Tap the screen to register saved data. Wait for 30 seconds to cancel saved data and keep the current setting. Time limit: 30 sec The new calibration values are measured. Touch the touch screen to save the calibration values. If you do not touch the screen within 30 seconds, the new calibration values will be discarded. Time remaining until the calibration values are discarded 4. Touch the touch screen. The calibration is saved. The "OP Properties" dialog box, "Touch" tab is displayed again. If you do not touch the touch screen within the time shown, your original setting will be retained. 5. Close the dialog. Result The HMI device touch screen is calibrated. 6.3.5 Changing password protection Introduction You can protect access to the Control Panel and the Windows CE taskbar with a password. When you set up the password protection, the SecureMode is activated automatically. For more information, refer to SecureMode in section "Setting up and disabling SecureMode (Page 140)". TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 151 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" Requirements You have opened the "Password Properties" dialog with the "Password" icon. NOTICE Password not available If the password is no longer available, you can execute the following once you have first reset the computer to factory settings: * Change settings in the Control Panel * Use the Windows CE taskbar All data on the HMI device will be deleted when you update the operating system! Therefore use the password to protect against loss. Procedure - setting up password protection Note The following characters cannot be used in passwords: * Blank * Special characters * ? . % / \ ' " Proceed as follows: 1. Enter a password in the "Password" text box. 2. Repeat the password entry in the "Confirm password" text box. 3. Confirm your entries. The dialog closes. Result You cannot open the Control Panel or Windows CE taskbar without entering a password. 152 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" Procedure - disabling password protection Proceed as follows: 1. Delete the entries in the "Password" and "Confirm password" input fields. 2. Confirm your entries. The dialog closes. Result Password protection for the Control Panel and the Windows CE taskbar is disabled. There is free access to these applications. 6.3.6 Changing the HMI device settings 6.3.6.1 Setting the date and time Introduction You can set the date and time on the HMI device. The HMI must be restarted in the following cases: You have changed the time zone setting. You have changed the "Daylight savings time currently in effect" check box setting. Requirements You have opened the "Date/Time Properties" using the "Date/Time Properties" icon. Date selection field Input field for the time Button for applying changes Time zone selection list "Daylight savings" check box TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 153 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Select the appropriate time zone for the HMI device from the "Time Zone" selection list. 2. Touch the "Apply" button to confirm your entry. The time of day shown in the "Current Time" field is adjusted correspondingly to the selected time zone. 3. Set the date in the selection field. 4. Set the current time of day in the "Current Time" text box. 5. Touch the "Apply" button to confirm your input. The values you have set are now in effect. Note The system does not automatically switch between winter and summer time. 6. If you want to switch from winter to summer time, activate the "Daylight savings time currently in effect" check box. When you press the "Apply" button, the time is brought forward by one hour. 7. If you want to switch from summer to winter time, deactivate the "Daylight savings time currently in effect" check box. When you press the "Apply" button, the time is moved backwards by one hour. 8. Confirm your entries. The dialog closes. Result The settings for the data and time of day have now been changed. Internal clock The HMI device has an internal buffered clock. The buffering is time-restricted. Synchronizing the date and time with the PLC The date and time of the HMI device can be synchronized with the PLC if this has been configured in the project and the PLC program. Further information on this subject is available in the "WinCC flexible" system manual. NOTICE Time-dependent reactions You have to synchronize the date and time when time-controlled responses are triggered in the PLC by the HMI device. 154 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.6.2 Changing regional settings Introduction In different countries, for example, the date, time and decimal points are displayed differently. You can adjust this display to meet the requirements of different regions. The country-specific settings apply to the current project. If the project language is changed, the country-specific settings are also changed. Requirements You have opened the "Regional and Language Settings" dialog with the "Regional Settings" icon. Region selection list Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Select the region from the selection list. 2. Change to the "Number", "Currency", "Time" and "Date" tabs and set the selection lists to the desired settings. 3. Confirm your entries. The dialog closes. Result The HMI device's regional settings have been changed. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 155 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.6.3 Backup registry information Registry information and temporary data You can install and uninstall your own programs on the HMI devices under Windows CE. You must save the registry settings after installation or uninstallation. You can save the following data to the flash memory: Registry Information Temporary files Restoring the file system of a memory card If memory cards are used, the file system on the memory card may become damaged, perhaps due to a power failure. The HMI device detects the defective file system on start-up or when the memory card is inserted. The HMI device can restore the file system automatically or on request. Requirements You have opened the "OP Properties" dialog, "Persistant Storage" tab with the "OP" icon. 156 Saves the current registry information to the flash memory. The HMI device loads the saved registry information the next time it boots. Button for saving registry information Button for saving temporary files Saves all the files in temporary storage to the flash memory (for example, from the "Program Files" directory). These files are written back when the HMI device is started. The "\Temp" directory is not saved. Automatically restores the file system on the memory card when the HMI device starts up and when a memory card is inserted. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. If you want the system to be restored automatically, activate the "Automatically repair file system errors ..." check box. If the check box is unchecked, the system is restored only once prompted to do so. 2. Click on the necessary buttons. 3. Confirm your entries. The dialog closes. Result The HMI device uses the saved registry information the next time it starts. The temporary files are copied back. 6.3.6.4 Changing monitor settings Requirements You have opened the "OP Properties", dialog "Display" tab with the "OP" icon. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. If you want to increase the brightness, press the "UP" button. 2. If you want to decrease the brightness, press the "DOWN" button. 3. Confirm your entries. The dialog closes. Result The screen settings have been changed. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 157 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.6.5 Setting the screen saver Introduction You can activate a screen saver for the HMI device. You can also set the HMI device so that the backlighting of the screen is reduced if it is not used for a while. This has the following advantages: The service life of the screen LEDs is extended. The HMI device uses less power. You can set the following time intervals on the HMI device: For the automatic activation of the screen saver For the automatic reduction in the screen's backlighting When you do not undertake an operation within the configured interval, the configured function will be activated automatically. The screen saver and the reduced screen backlighting functions are switched back off by means of the following actions: By pressing any key By touching the touch screen The function associated to the key or button will not be executed by this. NOTICE Reduce backlighting The brightness of the backlighting decreases incrementally during its operational life. In order to not shorten the operational lifetime of the backlighting unnecessarily, activate the backlighting reduction. Activating the screen saver Screen contents which remain unchanged for long periods can remain dimly visible in the background. This effect is reversible. Therefore activate the screen saver. When the screen saver is active, the backlighting is also reduced. If you set the screen saver "Blank Screen", the backlighting is switched off completely. 158 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" Requirements You have opened the "Screensaver" dialog with the "ScreenSaver" icon. Time interval in minutes until backlighting is reduced Period of time in minutes before the screen saver is activated Radio buttons for the screensaver Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Enter the interval in minutes after which the backlighting is to be reduced. Entering "0" will deactivate the backlighting reduction. 2. Enter the number of minutes before the screen saver is to be activated. The minimum time is 5 minutes and the maximum time is 71582 minutes. Entering "0" disables the screen saver. 3. Select either the screen saver or an empty screen. - If you want the screen saver to function, activate the "Standard" radio button. - If you do not want the screen saver to function, activate the "Blank Screen" radio button. With this setting, the backlighting of the HMI device is switched off completely if the set interval for activating the screen saver expires. 4. Confirm your entries. The dialog closes. Result The screen saver and the reduced backlighting for the HMI device is set. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 159 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.6.6 Changing the printer properties Introduction The HMI device can print on local printers or network printers. You can print hardcopies and reports on a network printer. Line printing of alarms is not possible on a network printer. The list of current printers and required settings for HMI devices can be found on the Internet under "http://support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/11376409". Requirements You have opened the "Printer Properties" dialog with the "Printer" icon. 160 Selection list for the printer Selection list for the interface Network address of the printer Paper format selection list "Orientation" group with radio buttons for print orientation Check box to improve the color quality (only for Brother HL 2700 printers) Color printing check box Print quality check box TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Select a printer from the "Printer Language" selection list. 2. Select the port for the printer from the "Port" selection list. 3. If you wish to print via the network, enter the printer's network address in the "Network" text box. 4. Select a paper format in the "Paper Size" selection list. 5. Activate a radio button in the "Orientation" group. - "Portrait" for portrait - "Landscape" for landscape 6. Select the print quality. - Select the "Draft Mode" check box if you wish to print in draft mode. - Deactivate the "Draft Mode" check box if you wish to print with higher quality. 7. If the printer selected can print in color and you wish it to do so, select the "Color" check box. 8. If you use the Brother HL 2700 printer model, enable the "CMY" check box. In this way you can increase the color quality when printing. 9. Confirm your entries. The dialog closes. Result The settings for the printer have now been changed. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 161 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.6.7 Restarting the HMI device Introduction You can restart the HMI device or reset it to factory settings prior to the restart. For more information, refer to the section "Resetting factory settings (Page 213)". Essential restart The HMI device must be restarted in the following cases: You have activated or deactivated the PROFINET IO direct keys. You have changed the time zone setting. You have changed the automatic daylight savings and standard setting. NOTICE Data loss when the HMI device is restarted All volatile data is lost when the HMI device is rebooted. Check the following: * The project on the HMI device is complete. * No data is being written to the flash memory. The HMI device must be restarted in the following cases: Requirement You have opened the "OP Properties", dialog "Device" tab with the "OP" icon. Button for restarting the HMI device If you wish to start the HMI device by resetting to factory settings: The HMI device is connected via PROFINET to a configuration PC. 162 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" Procedure 1. If you want to restart the HMI device, press the "Reboot" button. The following message is displayed: If you run this function, all data which has not been backed up will be lost. Please close all applications before restarting. Button for resetting factory settings and subsequent restart Button for the restart 2. Click on one of the buttons. If you want to restart the HMI device, press the "Reboot" button. The HMI device restarts without delay. If you want to reset the HMI device to factory settings and then perform a restart, press the "Prepare for Reset" button. You are given the option to reset the HMI device via ProSave to factory settings. Then restart the HMI device. If you want do not want to restart the HMI device, press the "No" button. The message ends. There will be no restart. Result The HMI device starts. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 163 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.6.8 Displaying information about the HMI device Introduction You will need the device-specific information if you contact A&D Technical Support. Requirements You have opened the "OP Properties", dialog "Device" tab with the "OP" icon. The HMI device-specific information is displayed in the "Device" tab. The data displayed are device-specific and may therefore deviate from that of your HMI device. HMI device name Version of the HMI device image Version of the boot loader Boot loader release date Size of the internal flash memory in which the HMI device image and project are stored MAC address of the HMI device See section Restarting the HMI device (Page 162) Note The size of the internal flash memory does not correspond to the available working memory for a project. 164 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.6.9 Displaying system properties Introduction The general system-specific information provides you with information about the processor, operating system and memory. Requirements You have opened the "System Properties" dialog box, "General" tab, by touching the "System" icon. The data displayed are device-specific and may therefore deviate from that of your HMI device. Copyright to Microsoft Windows CE Details on processor and size of internal Flash memory Result The system properties are displayed. This dialog is read-only. Close the dialog. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 165 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.6.10 Displaying memory distribution Introduction The "Memory" system-specific information provides you with information about the distribution and size of the memory in the HMI device. NOTICE "Memory" tab Do not change the memory distribution in the "Memory" tab. Applies for the usage of options: An alteration to the memory distribution may be necessary. Please refer to the accompanying documentation for further information. Requirements You have opened the "System Properties" dialog box, "Memory" tab, by touching the "System" icon. Procedure 1. Determine the HMI device's current memory structure. 2. Close the dialog. 166 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.6.11 Activate memory management Memory management Provided the memory management is activated, the HMI device will automatically close the project if the memory needs reorganizing during an active project. The project is shut down and the HMI device will display a message. You have to restart the project. NOTICE Memory management If you do not activate memory management, undefined states can occur during the runtime of the project. Activate the memory management. Requirements You have opened the "OP Properties" dialog, "Memory Monitoring" tab with the "OP" icon. Maximum memory used since the HMI device was last switched on Percentage of memory currently used Activate memory management Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. If you want to enable memory management, activate the check box. If memory management is active and there is not enough working memory, the SIMATIC HMI runtime and therefore the current project will be closed. 2. Confirm your entries. The dialog closes. Result Memory management is activated. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 167 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.7 Setting storage location Introduction There are various storage locations available for storing the compressed source file of your project. The following describes how you can set the storage location. Requirements You have opened the "Transfer Settings", dialog "Directories" tab with the "Transfer" icon. Memory location for the project file Memory location for the compressed source file of your project for backtransfer Storage location and initialization file of the HMI device for process operation NOTICE Settings under "Project File" and "Path" The project may not open the next time the HMI device is started if changes are made in the "Project File" and "Path" text boxes. Do not change the entries in the "Project File" and "Path" text boxes. Procedure 1. Select a memory location from the "Project Backup" input field. The external memory card or the location in the data network can be defined as the storage location. During the next backup process, the project's source file is stored in the specified location. 2. Confirm your entries. The dialog closes. Result The storage location for the source file is now set. 168 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.8 Setting the delay time Introduction Once the HMI device has been switched on, a project can be started after a delay. The Loader is displayed during the delay time. Requirements You have opened the "Transfer Settings", dialog "Directories" tab with the "Transfer" icon. NOTICE Settings under "Project File" and "Path" The project may not open the next time the HMI device is started if changes are made in the "Project File" and "Path" text boxes. Do not change the entries in the "Project File" and "Path" text boxes. Procedure 1. Select the desired delay time in seconds from the "Wait [sec]" selection list. With the value "0", the project starts immediately. It is then no longer possible to call the Loader after switching on the HMI device. If you still wish to access the loader, an operating element must be configured to close the project. 2. Confirm your entries. The dialog closes. Result The delay time for the HMI device is now set. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 169 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.9 Enabling PROFINET IO PROFINET IO If the HMI device is connected to the PLC via PROFINET, function keys or buttons, for example, can be configured as PROFINET IO direct keys. If PROFINET IO direct keys are used in the project, they must be enabled. Note If you enable PROFINET IO direct keys, you cannot use the RS 422 / RS 485 port for serial communication. PROFINET IO direct keys and PROFIBUS DP direct keys are mutually exclusive. Requirements You have opened the "PROFINET" dialog with the "PROFINET" icon. Activating or deactivating the PROFINET IO direct keys Text box for the device name MAC address of the HMI device NOTICE Inconsistent device name If the device name does not match the device name entered in the HW Config of STEP 7, the direct keys do not work. Use the device name from the HW Config of STEP 7. This device name does not correspond to the device name used under Windows CE. 170 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" Within the ETHERNET data network, the device name must be unique and satisfy the DNS conventions. These include: The device name can consist of maximum 240 characters. If the device name is longer than 63 characters, it must be classified in the name component. Each name component can consist of maximum 63 characters. Name components are separated from each other by means of points. Example: .. The device name may include characters, figures, hyphens or points. The device name must not start or end with a "-" character. The device name must not take the form n.n.n.n (n = 0 to 999). The device name must not start with the character sequence "port-xyz-" (x, y, z = 0 to 9). Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. If you want to enable the PROFINET IO direct keys, activate the "PROFINET IO enabled" check box. 2. Enter the device name of the HMI device. 3. Confirm your entries. The dialog closes. Result The PROFINET IO direct keys are enabled. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 171 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.10 Changing transfer settings 6.3.10.1 Configuring the data channel Introduction If you block all data channels, the HMI device is protected against unintentional overwriting of the project data and HMI device image. Note A project can only be transferred from the configuring PC to the HMI device when at least one of the data channels is enabled on the HMI device. Requirements The "Transfer Settings" dialog, "Channel" tab has been opened with the "Transfer Settings" icon. 172 Group for the data channel 1 (Channel 1) Group for the data channel 2 (Channel 2) Button for the "S7-Transfer Settings" and / or "Network and Dial-Up Connections" dialog TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" WARNING Unintentional transfer mode Unintentional transfer mode could cause unintentional actions to be triggered in the plant. Ensure that the configuring PC does not inadvertently switch the HMI device to transfer mode during the open project. NOTICE "Remote control" for "Channel 1" If the "Remote Control" check box is activated during "Online" operating mode, the X10 / IF 1B port cannot be used for communication. The "Remote Control" check box must be deactivated for "Online" operating mode. Once the serial transfer is complete, in the "Channel 1" group you must therefore deactivate the "Remote Control" check box. Transfer mode using "Channel 2" When the project on the HMI device starts, transfer parameters, e.g. HMI device address, for MPI / PROFIBUS DP are overwritten with the values from the project. You can change the settings for the transfer via "Channel 2". The following steps are required: * Close the project. * Change the settings on the HMI device. * Then return to "Transfer" mode. The next time the project is started on the HMI device, the settings will be overwritten by the values from the project. Note If the HMI device is in "Transfer" mode while changes are made to the transfer settings, the settings only go into effect after the transfer function is restarted. This may occur if the Control Panel is opened to change the transfer properties in an active project. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 173 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. If you want to enable a data channel, activate the "Enable Channel" check box in the "Channel 1" or "Channel 2" group. In the "Channel 1" group, the RS-422/RS-485 port is enabled for the serial data transfer. The network port is enabled in the "Channel 2" group. 2. If you want to enable the automatic transfer, activate the associated "Remote Control" check box. 3. If you have enabled the data channel for "Channel 2", select the log from the selection list. 4. Enter further parameters if required. Applies to "MPI / PROFIBUS / S7 Ethernet": - Press the "Advanced" button to switch to the "S7-Transfer Settings" dialog box. You can change the settings for MPI / PROFIBUS / S7 Ethernet there. - Confirm your entries. - The "S7-Transfer Settings" dialog box closes. Applies to "ETHERNET": - Use the "Advanced" button to change to "Network&Dial-Up Connections". - Open the "LAN9115" entry. You can change the TCP/IP settings there. - Confirm your entries. - Close "Network&Dial-Up Connections". Applies to "USB": - No settings are needed for "USB". 5. Confirm your entries. The dialog closes. Result The data channel is configured. 174 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.10.2 Changing MPI/PROFIBUS DP settings Introduction The communication settings for MPI, PROFIBUS DP and S7 Ethernet are defined in the HMI device project. In the following cases, the transfer settings might have to be changed: With the first project transfer. If changes are made to the project but are only applied later. NOTICE Transfer mode using MPI / PROFIBUS DP The bus parameters are read from the project currently loaded on the HMI device. You can change the settings for MPI / PROFIBUS DP transfer. The following steps are required: * Close the project. * Change the settings on the HMI device. * Then return to "Transfer" mode. The changed MP/PROFIBUS DP settings will be overwritten in the following cases: * The project is started again. * A project is transferred and started. Transfer settings If the HMI device is in "Transfer" mode while changes are made to the transfer settings, the settings only go into effect after the transfer function is restarted. Requirements You have opened the "S7-Transfer Settings" dialog with the "S7-Transfer Settings" icon. Network selection Button for opening the properties dialog TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 175 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Select a network. If you have chosen S7 Ethernet, continue as described under Changing the network configuration (Page 181). 2. Use the "Properties" button to open the "MPI" or "PROFIBUS" dialog. The HMI device is the only master on the bus. Bus address of the HMI device Time-out Data transmission rate in total network Highest station address in the network Profile Button for displaying the bus parameters 3. If there are several masters connected on the bus, deactivate the "Panel is the only master on the bus" check box. NOTICE The bus address in the "Address" text box must be unique throughout the MPI/PROFIBUS DP network. 176 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 4. Enter the bus address for the HMI device in the "Address" text box. 5. Select the transmission rate from the "Transmission Rate" selection list. 6. Enter the highest station address on the bus in the "Highest Station Address" or "Highest Station" text box. 7. With PROFIBUS settings: Select the required profile in the "Profile" selection list. 8. With PROFIBUS settings: If you want to view the profile data, press the "Busparameter" button of the PROFIBUS dialog. The profile data are displayed. The "Profile" dialog is read-only. NOTICE The bus parameters must be the same for all stations in the MPI/PROFIBUS DP network. 9. Close the "Profile" dialog. 10. Confirm your entries. The dialog closes. Result The MPI/PROFIBUS DP settings of the HMI device have been changed. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 177 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.11 Network operation 6.3.11.1 Overview Introduction You can connect the HMI device to a PROFINET network via the Ethernet port. Note The HMI device can only be used in PROFINET networks. If Sm@rtService or Sm@rtAccess are not used on the HMI device, the following applies: The HMI device only has client functionality in the PC network. This means that users can access files of a node with TCP / IP server functionality from the HMI device via the network. However, you cannot, for example, access data on the HMI device from a PC via the network. The Sm@rtService or Sm@rtAccess options enable access to an HMI device located somewhere else. Note Information on communication using SIMATIC S7 via PROFINET is provided in the "WinCC flexible communication" user manual. The connection to a network offers, for example, the following options: Printing via a network printer Saving, exporting and importing of recipe data records on or from a server Transferring a project Saving data Addressing Within a PROFINET network, computers are usually addressed using computer names. These computer names are translated from a DNS or WINS server to TCP/IP addresses. This is why a DNS or WINS server is needed for addressing via computer names when the HMI device is in a PROFINET network. The corresponding servers are generally available in PROFINET networks. Note The use of TCP / IP addresses to address PCs is not supported by the HMI device's operating system. Consult your network administrator if you have questions in this regard. 178 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" Printing via a network printer The HMI device's operating system does not support line by line alarm logging via a network printer. All other printing functions, for example hardcopy or logs are available without restriction via the network. Preparation Before beginning the configuration, request the following network parameters from your network administrator. Does the network use DHCP for dynamic assignment of network addresses? If not, get a new TCP/IP network address for the HMI device. Which TCP/IP address does the default gateway have? If a DNS network is used, what are the addresses of the name server? If a WINS network is used, what are the addresses of the name server? General procedure for configuring the network The HMI device must be configured prior to network operation. The configuration is basically divided into the following steps: 1. Enter the computer name of the HMI device. 2. Configure the network address. 3. Set the logon information. 4. Save the settings. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 179 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.11.2 Setting the device name of the HMI device Introduction The HMI device uses the device name to identify itself in the communication network. Requirements You have opened the "System Properties" dialog box, "Device Name" tab, by touching the "System" icon. Device name of the HMI device Description for the HMI device (optional) Note To activate the network functions, enter a unique computer name in the Device name input field. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Enter the device name for the HMI device in the "Device name" text box. 2. If necessary, enter a description for the HMI device in the "Device description" text box. 3. Confirm your entries. The dialog closes. Result The device name for the HMI device is now set. 180 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.11.3 Changing the network configuration Introduction You can change the network settings for the LAN connection under "Network&Dial-Up Connections". Requirements You have opened the following display by touching the "Network&Dial-Up Connections" icon. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Open the "LAN9115" entry. The "'LAN9115' Settings" dialog opens. 2. If you need automatic issuing of addresses, select the "Obtain an IP address via DHCP" radio button. 3. If you need manual issuing of addresses, select the "Specify an IP address" radio button. 4. If you have selected manual issuing of addresses, enter the corresponding addresses in the following input fields: - "IP Address" - "Subnet Mask" - If necessary: "Default Gateway" TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 181 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 5. If a name server is used in the network, change to the "Name Servers" tab. 6. If you wish to change the Ethernet settings, switch to the "Ethernet Parameters" tab. For the data rate and the transmission speed of the Ethernet connection, the following is set as default "Mode and Speed" "Automatic". With this setting, the HMI device detects the data rate and the speed of communication via the Ethernet and automatically employs it. 7. If you do not want to use these settings, select the required combination of data rate and transmission speed in the selection list. 8. Confirm your entries. The dialog closes. 9. Close the "Network&Dial-Up Connections" display. The Control Panel is displayed again. Result The LAN connection parameters for the HMI device have been changed. 182 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.11.4 Changing the logon data Introduction Windows CE uses this logon data to gain access to the network resources. Enter the user name, password and domain you have received from your administrator. Requirements You have opened the "Owner Properties" dialog with the "Network ID" icon. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Enter the user name in the "User name" text box. 2. Enter your password in the "Password" text box. 3. Enter the domain name in the "Domain" text box. 4. Confirm your entries. The dialog closes. Result The logon information has now been set. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 183 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.11.5 Changing e-mail settings Requirements You have opened the "WinCC flexible Internet Settings" dialog with the "WinCC Internet Settings" icon. Setting the SMTP server Name for the sender E-mail account Note Additional tabs may appear in the "WinCC flexible Internet Settings" dialog. This depends on the options that have been enabled for network operation in the project. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Specify the SMTP server. - Activate the "Use the default of the project file" radio button if you want to use the SMTP server configured in the project. - Deactivate the "Use the default of the project file" radio button if you do not want to use the SMTP server configured in the project. Specify the required SMTP server. 2. Enter the name for the sender in the "Sender" text box. 3. Enter the e-mail account for your e-mail in the "Authentication" text box. Some e-mail providers only allow you to send mail if you specify the e-mail account. The "Authentication" text box can remain empty if your e-mail provider allows you to send mail without checking the account. 4. Confirm your entries. The dialog closes. Result The e-mail settings have been changed. 184 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.11.6 Importing and deleting certificates Overview You can import, view and delete certificates that have been imported for the HMI device. The certificates differ in the following ways: Certificates that you trust Own certificates Other certificates You can import additional certificates and delete certificates that are not required. The required settings can be obtained from your network administrator. Requirements You have opened the "Certificates" dialog with the "Certificates" icon. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Select the type of certificate from the selection list: - "Trusted Authorities" - "My Certificates" - "Other Certificates" 2. If required, start the importing process with the "Import" button. A dialog with source details will open. 3. If required, delete certificates with the "Remove" button. Mark the desired certificate. 4. If you want to list the properties of the certificate marked, press the "View" button. 5. Confirm your entries. The dialog closes. Result The certificates have been changed. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 185 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.12 Backup and restore 6.3.12.1 Saving to external storage device (backup) Introduction A backup involves copying the operating system, applications and data from the internal in flash memory of the HMI device to an external storage device. Requirements The HMI device features an external storage device with sufficient free space. You have opened the "Backup/Restore" dialog with the "Backup/Restore" icon. Procedure - using a memory card for the first time NOTICE Loss of data possible The first time you use a memory card the HMI device will request that you format the card. Save a backup copy of memory card data to a PC before formatting. Proceed as follows: 1. Cancel the formatting procedure by pressing "ESC". 2. Remove the memory card from the HMI device. 3. Save a backup copy of vital data to a PC. 4. Insert the memory card into the HMI device. 5. Format the memory card on the HMI device. 186 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Press the "BACKUP" button to open the "Select Storage Card" dialog. The --- no storage card available --- message appears if there is no external memory in the HMI device or if this memory is defective. Insert an external memory or a different one. 2. Select the external memory for backup from the "Please select a Storage Card" selection field. 3. Click on the "Start Backup" button. The HMI device checks the external memory. If an external memory with a greater memory capacity is needed, a message is displayed. Acknowledge this message. Backup is aborted. Insert an external memory with a greater memory capacity and restart the backup process. If the "You may have an old backup on the storage card. Do you want to delete it?" message appears, there is already a backup on the external memory. If you do not want to overwrite the backup, press the "No" button. Otherwise, click on the "Yes" button. Several messages are displayed in sequence during the backup process: - "Saving registry data" - "Copy files" A progress bar shows the status of the backup process. When the backup process is completed, the following message is displayed: "The operation completed successfully." 4. Acknowledge this message. The dialog closes. Result The HMI device data is now saved on the external memory. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 187 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 6.3.12.2 Restoring from external storage device Introduction A restore operation deletes the old data from flash memory of the HMI device on confirmation. The data stored on the external memory is then copied to the internal flash memory. Requirements The external memory holding the backed up data is inserted in the HMI device. You have opened the "Backup/Restore" dialog with the "Backup/Restore" icon. NOTICE Loss of data possible All data on the HMI device will be deleted during a restore operation. License keys are deleted after counter-inquiry. Back up the HMI device's data before restoring if required. External memory with data backup If several external memories with data backups are plugged in, the data cannot be restored. Remove the external memory with the data backups not needed. 188 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Select "RESTORE" to start restore. The HMI device checks the external memory. The HMI device issues messages in the following situations: - The external memory is not available or is defective: Acknowledge the displayed messages. The Control Panel is displayed again. Replace the external memory. - More than one external memory with valid backup is available: Remove all external memories with backups that are not needed. If necessary, you can check the available external memories using the "REFRESH" button. 2. If necessary, start the restore process with the "RESTORE" button. The data to be restored is checked. When the check is complete, one of the following prompts is displayed: - "You are starting RESTORE now. All files (except files on storage cards) and the registry will be erased. Are you sure?" At this point you can cancel the restore using the "No" button to prevent the data on the HMI device from being deleted. - You are now starting RESTORE. All files on the panel and the licenses listed below as well as the registry will be erased. Are you sure? This query is displayed when license keys are available both on the HMI device and in the backup data. If necessary, cancel the restore process with the "No" button and first back up the HMI device's license keys. For more information, refer to the section "Transferring and transferring back license keys (Page 225)". - Then restart the restore process. 3. Start to restore the data by selecting "Yes". A progress bar shows the status of the restoration of the Windows CE image. 4. After successful restoration of the Windows CE image, the following message is displayed: "Restore of CE Image is finished. The device will be rebooted now. Dont remove the storage card." Acknowledge this message. 5. The HMI device starts. The operating system boots, opening the Loader and Restore dialog in sequence. 6. The restore process is resumed. All data stored on the flash file system is restored. Afterwards the following message is displayed: "Restore succesfully finished. Press ok, remove your storage card and reboot your device." 7. Remove the external memory. 8. Acknowledge this message. The HMI device starts. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 189 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" Result The data from the external memory is now on the HMI device. Note Calibrating the touch screen After the reset, you may have to recalibrate the touch screen. 6.3.13 Setting the uninterruptible power supply Introduction UPS monitoring is an option you load as an add-on with ProSave. A UPS ensures that the HMI device is shut down in a controlled manner after a buffer time in the event of a power failure. This avoids the loss of data. The following uninterruptible power supplies are supported: SITOP DC UPS modules as of a rated power value of 6 A, e.g. 6EP1931-2DC42 Connect the UPS to the 24-V input and a USB port. Configure the USB port for UPS monitoring. Requirements You have opened the "UPS Properties", dialog "Configuration" tab with the "UPS" icon. 190 Text box for the time after which the "Battery mode activated" message is displayed Check box for enabling battery mode Text box for the time after which the "Faulty port" message is displayed Check box for the "Faulty port" message TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" Procedure for setting the UPS Proceed as follows: 1. Activate the "Battery mode" check box to enable battery mode. 2. Delete the entries in the "min" and "s" input fields. You will receive a message when UPS takes effect. If battery mode is enabled, the applications on the HMI device are closed after the specified interval. 3. If the port to which the UPS is connected is faulty and you therefore want to receive a message, activate the "Port disturbed" check box. 4. Select the desired message from the selection list. 5. Enter the time after which the "Faulty port" message is displayed in the "min" and "s" input fields. Result Port monitoring for the UPS is set. Procedure for displaying the USP status To display the monitoring status of the USP, switch to the "Current Status" tab. If you want to refresh the display, press the "Update" button. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 191 Configuring the Operating System 6.3 Configuring the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 192 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 7 Commissioning a project 7.1 Overview Configuration and Process Control Phases HMI devices can be used to operate and monitor tasks in process and production automation. The plant screens on the HMI devices are used to provide a clearer overview of active processes. The HMI device project, which includes the plant screens, is created during the configuration phase. Once the project is transferred to the HMI device and the HMI device is connected to a PLC in the automation system, processes can be operated and monitored in the process control phase. &RQILJXUDWLRQSKDVH &RQILJXUDWLRQ3& &UHDWHSURMHFW 7HVWWKHSURMHFW 6LPXODWHWKHSURMHFW +0,GHYLFHGHSHQGHQW 6DYHWKHSURMHFW 7UDQVIHUWKHSURMHFW 3URFHVVFRQWUROSKDVH +0,GHYLFH 2SHUDWHWKHSURMHFW &RQQHFWLRQWRWKH3/& 3/& TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 193 Commissioning a project 7.1 Overview Transferring the project to the HMI device To transfer a project to an HMI device, the following procedures can be selected: Transfer from the configuration PC Restore from a PC using ProSave In this case, an archived project is transferred from a PC to the HMI device. The configuration software need not be installed on this PC. On the TP 177B and OP 177B: Restoring from an external storage device These procedures can be selected both during the initial startup as well as in the recommissioning of a project. Initial startup and recommissioning When the HMI device is initially started up there is no project at first. The HMI device is also in this state after the operating system has been updated. When recommissioning, any project already on the HMI device is replaced. See also Transfer (Page 198) Backup and Restore using WinCC flexible (Page 204) Backup and Restore using ProSave (Page 206) Backup and Restore Using a Memory Card (Page 105) Restoring from external storage device (Page 188) 194 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Commissioning a project 7.1 Overview 7.1.1 Setting the Operating Mode Operating Modes Operating modes of the HMI device: Offline Online Transfer "Offline mode" and "Online mode" can be set on the configuration computer and on the HMI device. To set these modes on the HMI device, use a corresponding operator control object of the project. Switching the Operating Mode The configuration engineer must have configured an appropriate operator control object to allow a change of the operating mode on the HMI device during ongoing operation. Refer to your plant documentation to find any additional information on this topic. "Offline" Operating Mode In this mode, there is no communication between the HMI device and PLC. Although the HMI device can be operated, it cannot exchange data with the PLC. "Online" Operating Mode In this mode, the HMI device and PLC communicate. You can operate the plant on the HMI device according to your system configuration. "Transfer" Operating Mode In this mode, you can transfer a project from the configuration computer to the HMI device or backup and restore HMI device data, for example. The following options are available for setting "Transfer" mode on the HMI device: When the HMI device starts up Start "Transfer" mode manually in the HMI device Loader. During ongoing operation Start the "Transfer" mode manually within the project using an operator control object. The HMI device toggles to "Transfer" mode when automatic mode is set and a transfer is initiated on the configuring PC. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 195 Commissioning a project 7.1 Overview 7.1.2 Reusing Existing Projects You can reuse existing projects from the following HMI devices: Projects from TP 170A on the TP 177A or TP 177B Projects from TP 170B on the TP 177B Projects from OP 17 on the OP 177B Projects from OP 170B on the OP 177B Projects for the OP 77B for the TP 177B 4" Projects for the TP 177B 6" for the TP 177B 4" The following cases are possible: 1. A project created with ProTool is available. Migrate the project to WinCC flexible and then switch the HMI device. 2. A project created with WinCC flexible is available. Switch the HMI device in WinCC flexible. If you switch to TP 177B 4", the available images will automatically adapt to the broader screen on the HMI device. For more information, please see the online help for WinCC flexible or the "WinCC flexible Migration" user manual. 196 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Commissioning a project 7.1 Overview 7.1.3 Data Transmission Options Overview The table below shows the channels for data transfer between TP 177A, TP 177B or OP 177B and a configuration computer. Type Data channel TP 177A TP 177B 6", OP 177B TP 177B 4" Backup Serial Yes Yes Yes MPI/PROFIBUS DP Yes Yes Yes - Yes Yes - Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes 1) / No 2) No No USB 3) PROFINET 4) Serial Restoring Serial, with reset to factory setting Serial Yes Yes Yes MPI/PROFIBUS DP Yes Yes Yes - Yes Yes USB 3) PROFINET Updating the operating system - Yes Yes Serial, with reset to factory setting Yes Yes No Serial Yes Yes Yes MPI/PROFIBUS DP Yes Yes Yes - Yes Yes - Yes Yes - No Yes 4) USB 3) PROFINET 4) PROFINET 4), with restore to factory setting Transferring a project Serial Yes Yes Yes MPI/PROFIBUS DP Yes Yes Yes - Yes Yes USB 3) - Yes Yes Serial - Yes Yes MPI/PROFIBUS DP - Yes Yes USB 3) - Yes Yes - Yes Yes PROFINET Install or remove option 3) PROFINET 4) 4) Transferring license Serial keys and uploading MPI/PROFIBUS DP license keys 3) USB 3) PROFINET 4) - Yes Yes - Yes Yes - Yes Yes - Yes Yes 1) Applies to complete restoring 2) Applies to restoring the password list 3) Applies to TP 177B 6" DP, TP 177B 4" PN/DP, TP 177B 6" PN/DP, OP 177B DP, and OP 177B PN/DP when using a USB master-master cable. You will find more information about transferring via USB on the Internet at "http://support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/19142034." 4) Applies to TP 177B 4" PN/DP, TP 177B 6" PN/DP, and OP 177B PN/DP TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 197 Commissioning a project 7.2 Transfer Serial data transmission with the TP 177A You can use one of the following adapters for serial transmission between TP 177A and a configuration PC: RS 232/PPI cable MM Multimaster USB/PPI cable MM Multimaster (as of manufacturer version 05 of the cable) Serial data transmission with TP 177B and OP 177B Use a PC / PPI cable, order number 6ES7 901-3CB30-0XA0, for serial transmission between TP 177B or OP 177B and a configuration PC . Resetting to factory settings via USB with TP 177B 6" and OP 177B You can only use the USB/PPI cable MM Multimaster adapter (as of manufacturer version 05) if you have updated the operating system with reset to factory setting in stand-alone mode via ProSave. 7.2 Transfer 7.2.1 Overview Transfer During transfer, the project is downloaded from the configuration computer to the HMI device. The "Transfer" mode can be started manually or automatically on the HMI device. Transferred data is written directly to the flash memory on the HMI device. The transfer function uses a data channel you need to configure before you initiate any transfers. 198 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Commissioning a project 7.2 Transfer 7.2.2 Starting Manual Transfer Introduction You can manually switch the HMI device to "Transfer" mode as follows: With a configured operating element during ongoing operation. In the Loader of the HMI device. Requirements The project "*.hmi" is opened in WinCC flexible. The HMI device is connected to a configuring PC. The data channel is configured on the HMI device. The HMI device is in "Transfer" mode. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. On the configuring PC, select the "Transfer settings" command in the menu "Project > Transfer" in WinCC flexible. The "Select devices for transfer" dialog opens. 2. Select the HMI device in the left area of the dialog. 3. Select the type of connection between the HMI device and the configuring PC. Set the connection parameters. 4. Set the transfer parameters in the right area of the dialog. 5. Start transfer in WinCC flexible with "Transfer". The configuring PC checks the connection to the HMI device. The project is transferred to the HMI device. If the connection is not available or is defective, an error message is displayed on the configuring PC. Result When the transfer is completed successfully, the project can be found on the HMI device. The transferred project is then started automatically. See also Configuring the data channel (Page 172) Setting the Operating Mode (Page 195) Data Transmission Options (Page 197) Overview (Page 198) TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 199 Commissioning a project 7.2 Transfer 7.2.3 Starting Automatic Transfer Introduction The HMI device can be automatically switched to "Transfer" mode during runtime as soon as transfer is started on the configuring PC connected. Automatic transfer is particularly suited for the test phase of a new project since transfer is completed without interfering with the HMI device. Automatic transfer is available for the following data channels: HMI device Serial MPI/PROFIBUS DP USB PROFINET TP 177A No Yes - - TP 177B, OP 177B Yes Yes Yes Yes NOTICE If the automatic transfer has been activated on the HMI device and a transfer is initiated on the configuring PC, the project currently running is automatically stopped. The HMI device then automatically switches to "Transfer" mode. After the commissioning phase, deactivate the automatic transfer so that the HMI device cannot be inadvertently switched to transfer mode. The transfer mode can trigger unintentional actions in the device. You can set a password for the Loader of the HMI device to restrict access to the transfer settings and thus avoid unauthorized modifications. Requirements The project *.hmi is opened in WinCC flexible. The HMI device is connected to a configuring PC. The data channel is configured on the HMI device. The automatic transfer is activated in the data channel for the transfer. The project is started on the HMI device. 200 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Commissioning a project 7.2 Transfer Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. On the configuring PC, select the "Transfer settings" command in the menu "Project > Transfer" in WinCC flexible. The "Select devices for transfer" dialog opens. 2. Select the HMI device in the left area of the dialog. 3. Select the type of connection between the HMI device and the configuring PC. Set the connection parameters. 4. Set the transfer parameters in the right area of the dialog. 5. Start transfer in WinCC flexible with "Transfer". The configuring PC checks the connection to the HMI device. The HMI device shuts down the current project and automatically switches to "Transfer" mode. The project is transferred to the HMI device. If the connection is not available or is defective, an error message is displayed on the configuring PC. Result When the transfer is completed successfully, the project can be found on the HMI device. The transferred project is then started automatically. See also Configuring the data channel (Page 172) Setting the Operating Mode (Page 195) Data Transmission Options (Page 197) Overview (Page 198) TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 201 Commissioning a project 7.2 Transfer 7.2.4 Testing a Project Introduction There are two options to test a project: Test the project on the configuring PC You can test a project at a configuring PC, using a simulator. For detailed information, refer to the "WinCC flexible" user manual and to the WinCC flexible Online Help. Offline testing of the project on the HMI device Offline testing means that communication between the HMI device and PLC is down while the test is being carried out. Online testing of the project on the HMI device Online testing means that the HMI device and PLC communicate with each other during testing. Perform the tests, starting with the "Offline test", followed by the "Online test". Note You should always test the project on the HMI device on which the project will be used. Check the following: 1. Check the correct layout of the screens. 2. Check the screen navigation. 3. Check the input objects. 4. Enter the tag values. The test increases the certainty that the project will run error-free on the HMI device. Requirements for offline testing The project has been transferred to the HMI device. The HMI device is in "Offline" mode. Procedure In "Offline" mode, you can test individual project functions on the HMI device without them being affected by the PLC. PLC tags, therefore, are not updated. Test the operating elements and visualization of the project as far as possible without connecting to the PLC. Requirements for online testing The project has been transferred to the HMI device. The HMI device is in "Online" mode. 202 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Commissioning a project 7.3 Backup and Restore Procedure In "Online" mode, you can test individual project functions on the HMI device without them being affected by the PLC. PLC tags are updated in this case. You have the option to test all communication-dependent functions, for example alarms, etc. Test the operating elements and views of the project. See also Setting the Operating Mode (Page 195) 7.3 Backup and Restore 7.3.1 Overview Backup and restoring You can back up and restore the following data found in the internal flash memory of the HMI device with a PC: Project and HMI device image User administration Recipe data License keys Use one of the following tools for backup and restoring: WinCC flexible ProSave General information NOTICE Power failure If a complete restore operation is interrupted due to power failure on the HMI device, the operating system of the HMI device may be deleted! In this case, you have to reset the HMI device to its factory settings. Compatibility conflict If a message is output on the HMI device warning of a compatibility conflict during the restore operation, the operating system must be updated. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 203 Commissioning a project 7.3 Backup and Restore 7.3.2 Backup and Restore using WinCC flexible Requirements The HMI device is connected to a configuring PC. No project is open in WinCC flexible. The data channel is configured on the HMI device. Procedure for backup Proceed as follows: 1. On the configuring PC, select the "Communication settings" command in the menu "Project > Transfer" in WinCC flexible. The "Communication Settings" dialog opens. 2. Select the type of HMI device. 3. Select the type of connection between the HMI device and the configuring PC. Set the connection parameters. 4. Close the dialog with "OK". 5. Select the "Backup" command in the menu "Project > Transfer" in WinCC flexible. The "SIMATIC ProSave [Backup]" dialog opens. 6. Select the data to be backed up. 7. Select a destination folder and a file name for the "*.psb" backup file. 8. Set "Transfer" mode on the HMI device. If automatic transfer mode is enabled on the HMI device, the HMI device automatically sets "Transfer" mode when a backup is initiated. 9. Start the backup operation in WinCC flexible with "Start Backup" on the configuration PC. Follow the instructions in WinCC flexible. A status view opens to indicate the progress of the operation. Result The system outputs a message when the backup is completed. The relevant data is now backed up on the configuration PC. 204 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Commissioning a project 7.3 Backup and Restore Procedure for restoring Proceed as follows: 1. On the configuring PC, select the "Communication settings" command in the menu "Project > Transfer" in WinCC flexible. The "Communication Settings" dialog opens. 2. Select the type of HMI device. 3. Select the type of connection between the HMI device and the configuring PC. 4. Set the connection parameters. 5. Close the dialog with "OK". 6. Select the "Restore" command in the menu "Project > Transfer" in WinCC flexible. The "SIMATIC ProSave [Restore]" dialog opens. 7. Select the "*.psb" backup file to be restored from the "Open" field. You can see the HMI device for which the backup file was created and the type of backup data the file contains. 8. Set "Transfer" mode on the HMI device. If automatic transfer mode is enabled on the HMI device, the device automatically sets "Transfer" mode when a restore operation is initiated. 9. Start the restore operation in WinCC flexible with "Start Restore" on the configuration PC. If there are license keys both on the HMI device and in the backup, a dialog box will appear. Use this dialog to establish whether you want to overwrite the license keys or abort the restore process. - If necessary, abort the backup and first back up the License Keys of the HMI device. For more information, refer to the section "Transferring and transferring back license keys (Page 225)". - Then restart the restore process. 10. Follow the instructions in WinCC flexible. A status view opens to indicate the progress of the operation. Result When the restore is successfully completed, the data backed up on the configuring PC is now on the HMI device. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 205 Commissioning a project 7.3 Backup and Restore 7.3.3 Backup and Restore using ProSave Requirement The HMI device is connected to a PC on which ProSave is installed. The data channel is configured on the HMI device. Procedure for backup Proceed as follows: 1. From the Windows Start menu, start ProSave on the PC. 2. Select the HMI device type in the "General" tab. 3. Select the type of connection between the HMI device and the PC. Set the connection parameters. 4. Select the data to be backed up in the "Backup" tab. 5. Select the folder and file name for the backup file "*.psb." If you are working with the TP 177A with WinCC flexible 2008 or higher and backup recipes in CSV format, then select a folder. A CSV file is created for each recipe in this folder. 6. Set "Transfer" mode on the HMI device. If automatic transfer mode is enabled on the HMI device, the HMI device automatically sets "Transfer" mode when a backup is initiated. 7. Start the backup operation in ProSave with "Start Backup". Follow the instructions in ProSave. A status view opens to indicate the progress of the operation. Result The system outputs a message when the backup is completed. The relevant data is now backed up on the PC. 206 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Commissioning a project 7.3 Backup and Restore Procedure for restoring Proceed as follows: 1. From the Windows Start menu, start ProSave on the PC. 2. Select the HMI device type in the "General" tab. 3. Select the type of connection between the HMI device and the PC. 4. Set the connection parameters. 5. Select the "*.psb" backup file to be restored from the "Restore" tab. You will receive information for which HMI device the backup file was created and which type of backup data are available in the file. If you are working on a TP 177A with WinCC flexible 2008 or higher and want to restore recipes in CSV format, then select one or more CSV files from the source directory. 6. Set "Transfer" mode on the HMI device. If automatic transfer mode is enabled on the HMI device, the device automatically sets "Transfer" mode when a restore operation is initiated. 7. Start the restore operation in ProSave on the PC with "Start Restore". If there are license keys both on the HMI device and in the backup, a dialog box will appear. Use this dialog to establish whether you want to overwrite the license keys or abort the restore process. - If necessary, abort the backup and first back up the License Keys of the HMI device. For more information, refer to the section "Transferring and transferring back license keys (Page 225)". - Then restart the restore process. 8. Follow the instructions in ProSave. A status view opens to indicate the progress of the operation. Result When the restore is successfully completed, the data backed up on the PC is now on the HMI device. Procedure for restoring by resetting to factory settings on the TP 177A On the TP 177A, when restoring data you can also reset the HMI device to factory settings. Proceed as follows: 1. Switch off power to the HMI device. 2. Execute steps 1 through 5 as described in "Procedure for restoring". 3. Select the "Bootstrap" check box. 4. Execute steps 7 through 8 as described under "Procedure for restoring". 5. Switch on the power supply of the HMI device. Result When the restore is successfully completed, the data backed up on the PC is now on the HMI device. The HMI device is reset to factory settings. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 207 Commissioning a project 7.4 Updating operating systems on the TP 177A, TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 7.4 Updating operating systems on the TP 177A, TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 7.4.1 Overview Updating the operating system A compatibility conflict may occur when transferring a project to the HMI device. This is caused by different versions of the configuration software used and the HMI device image available on the HMI device. If there are different versions, the transfer is aborted. A message indicating a compatibility conflict is displayed on the configuring PC. There are two ways to match the versions: Update the HMI device image if the project was created with the most recent version of the configuration software. Transfer a matching older version of the HMI device image if you do not want to adapt the project to the most recent version of the configuration software for the project. NOTICE Data loss All data on the HMI device, such as the projects and passwords, will be deleted when you update the operating system. Data channels An operating system update resets all parameters for the data channels. The transfer can only be started in the Loader following reconfiguration of the data channels. Note Calibrating the touch screen After updating, you may have to re-calibrate the touch screen. 208 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Commissioning a project 7.4 Updating operating systems on the TP 177A, TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 7.4.2 Resetting to factory settings Resetting to factory settings In ProSave or WinCC flexible, you can update the operating system with or without resetting to factory settings, depending on the HMI device used. Updating the operating system without reset to factory setting First, set "Transfer" mode on the HMI device or use the automatic transfer function if the project is active. Then start the operating system update in ProSave or WinCC flexible. Updating the operating system with reset to factory setting First, start the operating system update in ProSave or WinCC flexible. Then switch the power on the HMI device off and on again. Note Updating the operating system by resetting to factory settings must be carried out in the following cases: * No operating system is loaded on the HMI device. * The operating system of the HMI device is damaged. Point-to-point coupling with a PC / PPI cable is necessary in order to update the operating system with reset to factory settings. In ProSave or WinCC flexible, set the "Reset to factory state" check box status according to your selected operating system update mode. 7.4.3 Updating the operating system with WinCC flexible Requirements The HMI device is connected to a configuring PC. No project is open in WinCC flexible. When updating the operating system without reset to factory setting only: The data channel is configured on the HMI device. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 209 Commissioning a project 7.4 Updating operating systems on the TP 177A, TP 177B 6" and OP 177B Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. When updating the operating system with reset to factory setting only: Switch off power to the HMI device. 2. On the configuration PC, select the "Communication settings" command in the menu "Project > Transfer" in WinCC flexible. The dialog "Communication settings" opens. 3. Select the type of HMI device. 4. Select the type of connection between the HMI device and the configuration PC, then set the connection parameters. 5. Close the dialog with "OK". 6. In WinCC flexible, select the command "OS Update" in the "Project > Transfer" menu. 7. Select whether to update the operating system with / without resetting to factory settings by setting the "Reset to factory settings" check box accordingly. 8. In "Image path", select the HMI device image file "*.img". The HMI device image files are available under "WinCC flexible Images" in the WinCC flexible installation folder or on the WinCC flexible installation CD. In the output area, you are provided information on the version of the HMI device image file after it is opened. 9. When updating without reset to factory setting only: Set "Transfer" mode on the HMI device. If automatic transfer mode is enabled on the HMI device, the device automatically sets "Transfer" mode when an update is initiated. 10. In WinCC flexible, select "Update OS" on the configuration PC to run the operating system update. 11. When updating with reset to factory setting only: Switch on the power supply to the HMI device. 12. Follow the instructions in WinCC flexible. During the operating system update a status view opens to indicate progress. Result A message is displayed when the operating system update is successfully completed. This operation has deleted the project data from the HMI device. 210 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Commissioning a project 7.4 Updating operating systems on the TP 177A, TP 177B 6" and OP 177B 7.4.4 Updating the operating system with ProSave Requirement The HMI device is connected to a PC on which ProSave is installed. When updating the operating system without reset to factory setting: The data channel is configured on the HMI device. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. When updating the operating system with reset to factory setting: Switch off power to the HMI device. 2. From the Windows Start menu, start ProSave on the PC. 3. Select the HMI device type in the "General" tab. 4. Select the type of connection between the HMI device and the PC, then set the connection parameters. 5. Select the "OS Update" tab. 6. Select whether to update the operating system with / without resetting to factory settings by setting the "Reset to factory settings" check box accordingly. 7. In "Image path", select the HMI device image file "*.img". The HMI device image files are available under "WinCC flexible Images" in the WinCC flexible installation folder or on the WinCC flexible installation CD. In the output area, you are provided information on the version of the HMI device image file after it is opened. 8. When updating without reset to factory setting: Set "Transfer" mode on the HMI device. If automatic transfer mode is enabled on the HMI device, the device automatically sets "Transfer" mode when an update is initiated. 9. Select "Update OS" on the PC to run the operating system update. 10. When updating with reset to factory setting only: Switch on the power supply to the HMI device. 11. Follow the instructions in ProSave. During the operating system update a status view opens to indicate progress. Result A message is displayed when the operating system update is successfully completed. This operation has deleted the project data from the HMI device. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 211 Commissioning a project 7.5 Updating the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 7.5 Updating the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 7.5.1 Overview Updating the operating system A compatibility conflict may occur when transferring a project to the HMI device. This is caused by different versions of the configuration software used and the HMI device image available on the HMI device. If there are different versions, the transfer is aborted. A message indicating a compatibility conflict is displayed on the configuring PC. There are two ways to match the versions: Update the HMI device image if the project was created with the most recent version of the configuration software. Transfer a matching version of the HMI device image if you do not want to adapt the project for the HMI device to the most recent version of the configuration software for the project. NOTICE Data loss All data on the HMI device, such as the project and passwords, will be deleted when you update the operating system. Note Calibrating the touch screen After updating, you may have to re-calibrate the touch screen. 212 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Commissioning a project 7.5 Updating the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 7.5.2 Resetting factory settings In ProSave or WinCC flexible, you can update the operating system with or without resetting to the factory setting. Updating the operating system without resetting to factory settings First, switch into "Transfer" mode on the HMI device or use the automatic transfer function if the project is active. Then start the operating system update in ProSave or WinCC flexible. Updating the operating system with resetting to factory settings Note Updating the operating system by resetting to factory settings must be carried out in the following cases: * No operating system is loaded on the HMI device. * The operating system of the HMI device is damaged. NOTICE Loss of license keys The license keys on the HMI device will be deleted when resetting to factory settings. The license keys on the HMI device will be retained when updating the operating system without resetting to factory settings. NOTICE Data channels When resetting to factory settings, all data channel parameters are reset. The transfer can only be started following reconfiguration of the data channels. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 213 Commissioning a project 7.5 Updating the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 7.5.3 Updating the operating system using WinCC flexible Requirements No project is open on the configuring PC in WinCC flexible. The HMI device is connected to this configuring PC. The data channel is configured on the HMI device. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. On the configuring PC, select the "Communication settings" command from the "Projekt > Transfer" menu in WinCC flexible. The "Communication Settings" dialog opens. 2. Select the type of HMI device. 3. Select the type of connection between the HMI device and the configuring PC. 4. Set the connection parameters. 5. Close the dialog with "OK". 6. In WinCC flexible, select the command "OS Update" from the "Projekt > Transfer" menu. 7. In "Image path", select the HMI device image file "*.img". The HMI device image files are available under "WinCC flexible Images" in the WinCC flexible installation folder or on the WinCC flexible installation CD. In the output area, you are provided information on the version of the HMI device image file after it is opened. 8. Switch into "Transfer" mode on the HMI device. If you have activated automatic transfer mode for the HMI device, the device automatically switches to "Transfer" mode when an update is initiated. 9. In WinCC flexible, select "Update OS" on the configuring PC to run the operating system update. 10. Follow the instructions in WinCC flexible. During the operating system update a status view opens to indicate progress. Result A message is displayed when the operating system update is successfully completed. This operation has deleted the project data from the HMI device. 214 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Commissioning a project 7.5 Updating the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 7.5.4 Updating the operating system using ProSave Requirements The HMI device is connected to a PC on which ProSave is installed. The data channel is configured on the HMI device. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. From the Windows Start menu, start ProSave on the PC. 2. Select the HMI device type in the "General" tab. 3. Select the type of connection between the HMI device and the PC. 4. Set the connection parameters. 5. Select the "OS Update" tab. 6. In "Image path", select the HMI device image file "*.img". The HMI device image files are available under "WinCC flexible Images" in the WinCC flexible installation folder or on the WinCC flexible installation CD. In the output area, you are provided information on the version of the HMI device image file after it is opened. 7. Switch into "Transfer" mode on the HMI device. If you have activated automatic transfer mode for the HMI device, the device automatically switches to "Transfer" mode when an update is initiated. 8. Select "Update OS" n the PC to run the operating system update. 9. Follow the instructions in ProSave. During the operating system update a status view opens to indicate progress. Result A message is displayed when the operating system update is successfully completed. This operation has deleted the project data from the HMI device. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 215 Commissioning a project 7.5 Updating the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 7.5.5 Resetting to factory settings with WinCC flexible Requirements No project is open on the configuring PC in WinCC flexible. The HMI device is connected to this configuration PC over the standard Ethernet cable. Have the MAC address of the Ethernet interface on your HMI device to hand. - The MAC address is displayed briefly when the HMI device is turned on. - The MAC address is displayed in the "PROFINET" dialog in the Control Panel. Procedure - Setting the PC interface 1. Select "Start > Control Panel > Set PG / PC interface" on the configuration PC. 2. Select "S7ONLINE (STEP7) -> TCP / IP" from the "Application access point" area. 3. Select the interface which is connected to the HMI device from the "Interface parameterization used" area. 4. Confirm your entries. Procedure - Restoring factory settings Proceed as follows: 1. On the configuring PC, select the "Communication settings" command in the menu "Project > Transfer" in WinCC flexible. The "Communication Settings" dialog opens. 2. Select the HMI device type from the "General" tab, and select "Ethernet" from the "Connection" area. 3. Enter an IP address. Note Possible address conflicts with incorrect IP address Do not use a dynamic IP configuration for "Reset to factory settings". Specify a unique IP address in which the configuration PC is located. For the duration of the update process, the HMI device is automatically assigned to the specified address. If the HMI device has already been used with WinCC flexible or ProSave you can use the existing IP address for "Reset to factory settings." 216 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Commissioning a project 7.5 Updating the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 4. Confirm your entries. 5. In WinCC flexible, select the command "Update OS" in the "Project > Transfer" menu. 6. Activate the "Reset to factory settings" check box. A text box opens where you can enter the MAC address. 7. Enter the HMI device's MAC address in the text box. 8. In "Image path", select the HMI device image file "*.img". The HMI device image files are available under "WinCC flexible Images" in the WinCC flexible installation folder or on the WinCC flexible installation CD. In the output area, you are provided information on the version of the HMI device image file after it is opened. 9. In WinCC flexible, select "Update OS" on the configuring PC to run the operating system update. 10. In the Control Panel of the HMI device, open the "OP Properties" dialog and select the "Device" tab. 11. Click on the "Reboot" button. A query is opened. 12. Click on the "Prepare for Reset" button. 13. On the configuration PC, follow the instructions in WinCC flexible. During the operating system update a status view opens to indicate progress. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 217 Commissioning a project 7.5 Updating the operating system on the TP 177B 4" Result A message is displayed when the operating system update is successfully completed. This operation has deleted the project data from the HMI device. The factory settings are reset. Note If you can no longer call the Control Panel on the HMI device, as the operating system is missing, switch off the HMI device. Then reset to factory settings and restart the HMI device. If the HMI device doesnt start up, switch it off and then on again. Note Calibrating the touch screen After the reset, you may have to recalibrate the touch screen. 7.5.6 Resetting to factory settings with ProSave Requirement The HMI device is connected over the Ethernet to a PC on which ProSave is installed. Have the MAC address of the Ethernet interface on your HMI device to hand. - The MAC address is displayed briefly when the HMI device is turned on. - The MAC address is displayed in the "PROFINET" dialog in the Control Panel. Procedure - Setting the PC interface 1. Select "Start > Control Panel > Set PG / PC interface" on the configuration PC. 2. Select "S7ONLINE (STEP7) -> TCP / IP" from the "Application access point" area. 3. Select the interface which is connected to the HMI device from the "Interface parameterization used" area. 4. Confirm your entries. 218 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Commissioning a project 7.5 Updating the operating system on the TP 177B 4" Procedure - Restoring factory settings Proceed as follows: 1. From the Windows Start menu, start ProSave on the PC. 2. Select the HMI device type from the "General" tab, and select "Ethernet" from the Connection area. 3. Enter an IP address. Note Possible address conflicts with incorrect IP address Do not use a dynamic IP configuration for "Reset to factory settings". Specify a unique IP address of the subnet in which the configuration PC is located. For the duration of the update process, the HMI device is automatically assigned to the specified address of ProSave. If the HMI device has already been used with WinCC flexible or ProSave you can use the existing IP address for "Reset to factory settings." TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 219 Commissioning a project 7.5 Updating the operating system on the TP 177B 4" 4. Change to the "OS Update" tab. 5. Activate the "Reset to factory settings" check box. A text box opens where you can enter the MAC address. 6. Enter the HMI device's MAC address in the text box. 7. In "Image path", select the HMI device image file "*.img". The HMI device image files are available under "WinCC flexible Images" in the WinCC flexible installation folder or on the WinCC flexible installation CD. In the output area, you are provided information on the version of the HMI device image file after it is opened. 8. Select "Update OS" on the PC to start the "Reset to factory settings" process. 9. In the Control Panel of the HMI device, open the "OP Properties" dialog and select the "Device" tab. 10. Click on the "Reboot" button. A query is opened. 11. Click on the "Prepare for Reset" button. 12. Follow the instructions in ProSave. During the operating system update a status view opens to indicate progress. Result A message is displayed when the operating system update is successfully completed. This operation has deleted the project data from the HMI device. The factory settings are reset. Note If you can no longer call the Control Panel on the HMI device, as the operating system is missing, switch off the HMI device. Then reset to factory settings and restart the HMI device. If the HMI device doesnt start up, switch it off and then on again. Note Calibrating the touch screen After the reset, you may have to recalibrate the touch screen. 220 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Commissioning a project 7.6 Installing and Removing Options 7.6 Installing and Removing Options 7.6.1 Overview Options You can install options on for the HMI device, for example, additional programs developed especially for the HMI device. You can also remove options from the HMI device. Note A license key may be need to run an option. The license key unlocks the option for use. 7.6.2 Installing and Removing Options using WinCC flexible Requirements The HMI device is connected to a configuring PC. No project is open in WinCC flexible. The data channel is configured on the HMI device. Procedure for installing an option Proceed as follows: 1. On the configuring PC, select the "Communication settings" command in the menu "Project > Transfer" in WinCC flexible. The "Communication Settings" dialog opens. 2. Select the type of HMI device. 3. Select the type of connection between the HMI device and the configuring PC, then set the connection parameters. 4. Close the dialog with "OK". 5. Select the "Options" command in the menu "Project > Transfer" in WinCC flexible. 6. Select the desired option under "Available options". 7. Set "Transfer" mode on the HMI device. If automatic transfer mode is enabled on the HMI device, the device automatically sets "Transfer" mode when the installation of an option is initiated. 8. Start the installation of the option in WinCC flexible on the configuring PC with the ">>" button. Follow the instructions in WinCC flexible. A status display appears indicating the progress of the installation. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 221 Commissioning a project 7.6 Installing and Removing Options Result The option has now been installed on the HMI device. Procedure for removing an option Proceed as follows: 1. On the configuring PC, select the "Communication settings" command in the menu "Project > Transfer" in WinCC flexible. The "Communication Settings" dialog opens. 2. Select the type of HMI device. 3. Select the type of connection between the HMI device and the configuring PC, then set the connection parameters. 4. Close the dialog with "OK". 5. Select the "Options" command in the menu "Project > Transfer" in WinCC flexible. 6. Select the desired option under "Installed options". 7. Set "Transfer" mode on the HMI device. If automatic transfer mode is enabled on the HMI device, the device automatically sets "Transfer" mode when the removal of an option is initiated. 8. Start the removal of the option in WinCC flexible on the configuring PC with the "<<" button. Follow the instructions in WinCC flexible. A status display appears indicating the progress of the removal. Result The option has now been removed on the HMI device. See also Configuring the data channel (Page 172) Setting the Operating Mode (Page 195) Data Transmission Options (Page 197) Overview (Page 221) 222 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Commissioning a project 7.6 Installing and Removing Options 7.6.3 Installing and removing options using ProSave Requirements The HMI device is connected to a PC on which ProSave is installed. The data channel is configured on the HMI device. Procedure for installing an option Proceed as follows: 1. From the Windows Start menu, start ProSave on the PC. 2. Select the HMI device type in the "General" tab. 3. Select the type of connection between the HMI device and the PC. 4. Set the connection parameters. 5. Select the "Options" tab. 6. Select the desired option under "Available options". 7. Set "Transfer" mode on the HMI device. If automatic transfer mode is enabled on the HMI device, the device automatically sets "Transfer" mode when the installation of an option is initiated. 8. Start the installation of the option in ProSave with the ">>" button. 9. Follow the instructions in ProSave. A status display appears indicating the progress of the installation. Result The option has now been installed on the HMI device. Procedure for removing an option Proceed as follows: 1. From the Windows Start menu, start ProSave on the PC. 2. Select the HMI device type in the "General" tab. 3. Select the type of connection between the HMI device and the PC. 4. Set the connection parameters. 5. Select the "Options" tab. 6. Press the "Device status" button to update the display. 7. Select the desired option under "Installed options". 8. Set "Transfer" mode on the HMI device. If automatic transfer mode is enabled on the HMI device, the device automatically sets "Transfer" mode when the removal of an option is initiated. 9. Start the removal of the option in ProSave with the "<<" button. Follow the instructions in ProSave. A status display appears indicating the progress of the removal. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 223 Commissioning a project 7.7 Transfering License Keys and Transfering Them Back Result The option has now been removed on the HMI device. See also Configuring the data channel (Page 172) Setting the Operating Mode (Page 195) Data Transmission Options (Page 197) Overview (Page 221) 7.7 Transfering License Keys and Transfering Them Back 7.7.1 Overview Transferring and transferring back license keys With the purchase of an optional package, you obtain a specific user license with an associated license key. Once you have installed an option, transfer a license key to the HMI device. The license key unlocks an option for use. You can also transfer back the license key from the HMI device to the storage location. Note You only transfer License Keys with the Automation License Manager or WinCC flexible. 224 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Commissioning a project 7.7 Transfering License Keys and Transfering Them Back 7.7.2 Transferring and transferring back license keys Requirements When transferring or transferring back using WinCC flexible: No project is open on the configuring PC in WinCC flexible. The HMI device is connected to this configuring PC. The data channel is configured on the HMI device. The storage location and the license key awaiting transfer are ready. Procedure for transferring a license key Proceed as follows: 1. Switch to "Transfer" mode on the HMI device. 2. When transferring using WinCC flexible: Select the "License Keys" command in the menu "Project > Transfer". The Automation License Manager opens. When transferring using the Automation License Manager: Start the Automation License Manager via the Windows Start menu. 3. In the Automation License Manager, select the command "Connect HMI device" in the menu "Edit > Connect target system". The "Connect Target System" dialog opens. 4. Under "Device Type", select the appropriate HMI device type. 5. Select the type of connection from the "Connection" box. 6. Set the connection parameters. 7. Select "OK". The connection to the HMI device is established. The connected HMI device is displayed in the left window of the Automation License Manager. 8. In the left window, select the source drive. The right window displays the available license keys. 9. Drag one or more license keys from the right window and drop them on the HMI device in the left window. The license keys are then transferred to the HMI device. Result The license key is transferred from the storage location to the HMI device. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 225 Commissioning a project 7.7 Transfering License Keys and Transfering Them Back Procedure for transferring a license key back Proceed as follows: 1. Switch to "Transfer" mode on the HMI device. 2. When transferring back using WinCC flexible: Select the "License Keys" command in the menu "Project > Transfer". The Automation License Manager opens. When transferring back using the Automation License Manager: Start the Automation License Manager via the Windows Start menu. 3. In the Automation License Manager, select the command "Connect HMI device" in the menu "Edit > Connect target system". The "Connect Target System" dialog opens. 4. Under "Device Type", select the appropriate HMI device type. 5. Select the type of connection from the "Connection" box. 6. Set the connection parameters. 7. Select "OK". The connection to the HMI device is established. The connected HMI device is displayed in the left window of the Automation License Manager. 8. In the left window, select the HMI device. The right window displays the available license keys. 9. Drag one or more license keys from the right window and drop them on the destination drive in the left window. The license keys are transferred back to the storage location. Result The license key is transferred back from the HMI device to the storage location. See also Overview (Page 224) Configuring the data channel (Page 172) Setting the Operating Mode (Page 195) Data Transmission Options (Page 197) 226 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating a Project 8.1 Operating a Project on the TP 177A 8.1.1 Overview 8 Using Operator Controls on the Touch Screen Operator controls are touch-sensitive objects on the HMI screen such as buttons, I/O fields and alarm windows. Touch objects are basically operated in the same way as mechanical keys. You activate operator controls by touching them with your finger. Some operations with the project may require in-depth knowledge about the specific plant on the part of the operator. It is therefore important to take special care, for example, in displaying typing. Further information on this may be available in your plant documentation. CAUTION Always touch only one operator control on the screen. Never touch more than one operator control at a time, otherwise you may trigger unintentional actions. CAUTION Do not use any pointed or sharp objects when operating the touch screen as this may damage the plastic membrane of the touch screen. Operation Feedback The HMI provides optical feedback when it detects that an operator control has been touched. This feedback is independent of any communication with the PLC. Therefore, this feedback does not indicate whether the relevant action is actually executed or not. The configuration engineer may also have configured the feedback function in a different manner. Further information on this may be available in your plant documentation. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 227 Operating a Project 8.1 Operating a Project on the TP 177A Optical Operation Feedback The type of optical feedback depends on the operator control object: Buttons The HMI outputs different views of the "Touched" and "Untouched" states, provided the configuration engineer has configured a 3D effect: - "Touched" state: - "Untouched" state: The configuration engineer defines the appearance of a selected field, for example, its line width and color for the focus. Invisible buttons The focus for invisible buttons is not identified after selection by default. No optical operation feedback is provided in this case. The configuration engineer may, however, configure invisible buttons so that their outline appears as lines when touched. This outline remains visible until the you select another operator control object. I/O fields After you touch an IO field, a screen keyboard appears as optical operation feedback. 228 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating a Project 8.1 Operating a Project on the TP 177A 8.1.2 Setting the Project Language Introduction The HMI device supports multilingual projects. You need to configure a corresponding operator control object which lets you change the language setting on the HMI device during runtime. The project always starts with the language set in the previous session. Requirements The relevant project language must be available on the HMI device. The language switching function must be logically linked to a configured operator control object such as a button. Selecting a Language You can change project languages at any time. Language-specific objects are immediately output to the screen in the relevant language when you switch languages. The following options are available for switching the language: 1. A configured operator control object switches from one project language to the next in a list. 2. A configured operator control directly sets the desired project language. Further information on this may be available in your plant documentation. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 229 Operating a Project 8.1 Operating a Project on the TP 177A 8.1.3 Entries and Help within a Project 8.1.3.1 Overview Procedure Values are entered in the project input fields. The values are transferred from the input fields to the PLC. Proceed as follows: 1. Touch the input field required on the screen. The screen keyboard opens. Based on your configuration, you can enter the following type of values in the input field: - Numerical - Alphanumerical - Symbolic - Date/time 2. Set the value. 3. Confirm the entry. Screen keyboard When you touch an input object such as an IO field on the HMI touch screen, a screen keyboard appears. This screen keyboard is also displayed when it is necessary to enter a password to access protected functions. The keyboard is automatically hidden again when input is complete. Based on the configuration of the input object, the system opens a screen keyboard for entering numerical, alphanumerical or symbolic values. Note The screen keyboard display is independent of the configured project language. Numerical values You can enter numerical values character-by-character using the numerical screen keyboard Formats for Numerical Values You can enter values in numerical input fields based on the following formats: Decimal Hexadecimal Binary 230 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating a Project 8.1 Operating a Project on the TP 177A Limit Value Test of Numerical Values Variables can be assigned limit values. The current limit values are indicated in the numerical screen keyboard. If an Alarm window has been configured, a system message is automatically output to indicate any violation of the configured input value limits. For example, 80 exceeds the configured limit value of 78. The entered value entered is rejected. The original value is displayed again. Decimal places for numerical values If a numerical input field is configured for a specific number of decimal points, decimal places in excess of the limit are ignored. Empty decimal places are filled with "0" after the number is confirmed. Alphanumerical values Alphanumerical values (numbers and letters) can be entered character-by-character using the alphanumerical screen keyboard. Symbolic values Symbolic values are entered from a list of predefined entries using the symbolic screen keyboard. Date and time You can enter date/time values character-by-character using the alphanumerical screen keyboard 8.1.3.2 Entering and Editing Numerical Values Numerical screen keyboard When you touch an IO field on the HMI touch screen, the numerical screen keyboard appears. The screen keyboard is automatically hidden again when input is complete. The display of the screen keyboard with a vertical mounting of the HMI device slightly differentiates from the figure above. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 231 Operating a Project 8.1 Operating a Project on the TP 177A Procedure Numerical and hexadecimal values can be entered character-by-character via the buttons on the numerical screen keyboard. Proceed as follows: 1. Touch the required input field on the screen. The numerical screen keyboard opens and the existing value is displayed in the screen keyboard. 2. Enter the value. You can only operate the keys that are displayed in the 3D view. The operation of the keys depends on the nature of the values that are entered. You have the following options to enter a value: - The existing value is deleted when you enter the first character. Completely reenter the value. - Use the and keys to move the cursor within the current value. You can now edit or add to the characters of the current value. Use the key to delete the character to the left of the cursor. - Change the sign of the value using the - Select the key. key to view the infotext of the IO field. This button is only enabled if infotext has been configured for the IO field or for the screen which contains the IO field. 3. Use the key to confirm your entry or cancel it with . Either action closes the screen keyboard. Note Numerical I/O fields can be assigned limit values. The entered values are only accepted if they lie within these limits. Values outside of the configured limits are not accepted. A system alarm is then triggered on the HMI device. When the screen keyboard appears, the high and low limit values are indicated if configured. Result You have changed the numerical value or entered a new one. 232 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating a Project 8.1 Operating a Project on the TP 177A 8.1.3.3 Entering and Editing Alphanumerical Values Alphanumerical Screen Keyboard When you touch an IO field on the HMI touch screen, the alphanumerical screen keyboard appears. The keyboard is automatically hidden again when input is complete. Figure 8-1 Alphanumerical screen keyboard, normal level The layout of the screen keyboard for a vertically mounted HMI device differs slightly from that shown in the figure above. Keyboard Levels The alphanumerical keyboard is organized on several levels: Normal level Shift level TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 233 Operating a Project 8.1 Operating a Project on the TP 177A Procedure You can enter alphanumerical values character-by-character using the alphanumerical screen keyboard. Proceed as follows: 1. Touch the relevant IO field on the screen. The alphanumerical screen keyboard opens and displays the current value. 2. Set the value. The following options for entering values are available: - The current value is deleted when you enter the first character. Enter the value again. - Use the and keys to move the cursor within the current value. You can now edit the characters of the current value or add characters. Use the key to delete the character to the left of the cursor. - You can quickly switch between screen keyboard level using he key. When you toggle the level, the key labels on the screen keyboard change. to view the infotext of the IO field. - Select This button is only enabled if infotext has been configured for the IO field or for the screen which contains the IO field. 3. Select to confirm your entries or cancel them with . Both actions close the screen keyboard. Result You have changed the alphanumerical value or entered a new one. 234 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating a Project 8.1 Operating a Project on the TP 177A 8.1.3.4 Entering and Editing Symbolic Values Symbolic Screen Keyboard When you touch a symbolic IO field on the HMI touch screen, the symbolic screen keyboard appears. The screen keyboard is automatically hidden again when input is complete. The display of the screen keyboard with a vertical mounting of the HMI device slightly differentiates from the figure above. Procedure Enter the symbolic values using the symbolic screen keyboard. Proceed as follows: 1. Touch the required symbolic IO field on the screen. The symbolic screen keyboard opens and the existing value is displayed in the screen keyboard. 2. Select an item from the selection list. You have the following options to enter a value: - Set the cursor directly on the entry in the selection list, by touching the entry. - Move the cursor to an entry in the selection list using the , , or keys. - Select the key to view the infotext of the symbolic IO field. This button is only enabled if infotext has been configured for the symbolic IO field or for the screen which contains the IO field. 3. Use the key to confirm your entry or cancel it with . Either action closes the screen keyboard. Result You have changed the symbolic value or entered a new one. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 235 Operating a Project 8.1 Operating a Project on the TP 177A 8.1.3.5 Entering and Modifying the Date and Time Entering the Date and Time Enter the date and time in the same way you enter alphanumerical values. Note When entering the date and time, please note that the format is determined by the configured project language. See also Entering and Editing Alphanumerical Values (Page 233) Setting the Project Language (Page 229) 8.1.3.6 Viewing infotext Purpose The configuration engineer uses infotext to provide additional information and operating instructions with respect to screens and operable screen objects. Infotext can provide information on the value to be entered in an IO field, for example. Infotext for Input Objects Touch the key on the screen keyboard. This key is only enabled if infotext or the current screen has been configured for the input object. Note Switching between displayed infotext If infotext has been configured for an IO field and a screen, touching the infotext window toggles between the two. 236 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating a Project 8.1 Operating a Project on the TP 177A Infotext for the Current Screen Infotext can also be configured for screens. The infotext for the current screen is called up or by the screen keyboard or by an operator control object assigned to this function. Refer to your plant documentation to find any additional information on this topic. Closing the Infotext Close the infotext with 8.1.4 Project security 8.1.4.1 Overview . Overview The configuration engineer can protect the operation of a project by implementing a security system. The security system of the HMI device is based on permissions, user groups and users. If operator control objects protected by a password are operated, the HMI device requests the entry of a password. A logon screen is displayed in which you enter your user name and password. After logging in, you can operate the operator control objects for which you have the necessary permissions. The logon dialog can be set up by the configuration engineer via an individual operator control object. In the same way, the configuration engineer can set up an operator control object to log off. After logging off, objects assigned password protection can no longer be operated; to do so, log in again. Additional information on this may be available in your plant documentation. User groups and permissions Project-specific user groups are created by the configuration engineer. The "Administrators" group is included in all projects by default. User groups are assigned permissions. The permission required for an operation is specifically defined for each individual object and function in the project. The operating permissions can be saved with the "Backup" function. Users Each user is assigned to exactly one user group. Users can be created as follows: By the configuration engineer during configuration By the administrator on the HMI device By a user with user management permission on the HMI device TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 237 Operating a Project 8.1 Operating a Project on the TP 177A Logoff times A logoff time is configured in the system for each user. If the time between any two user actions, e.g, entering a value or changing screens, exceeds this logoff time, the user is automatically logged off. The user must then log in again to continue to operate objects assigned password protection. Passwords If an administrator or a user with administrator permission is logged on, all users on the HMI device are displayed in the User view. If a user without user management permission is logged on, only the personal user entry is displayed. The permissions of a user after logging in depends on the user group to the user is assigned. Additional information on this may be available in your plant documentation. The user data is encrypted and saved on the HMI device to protect it from loss due to power failure. Note Depending on the transfer settings, changes to the user data are overwritten when the project is transferred again. User view Use the User view to display the users on the HMI device. If an administrator or a user with administrator permission is logged on, all users on the HMI device are displayed in the User view. If a user without user management permission is logged on, only the personal user entry is displayed. The group to which each user is assigned is displayed next to the user names. As administrator or user with user management permission, you can also add new users. Use the "" entry. 238 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating a Project 8.1 Operating a Project on the TP 177A Backup and Restore The users, passwords, group assignments and logoff times set up on the HMI device can be backed up and restored. This prevents you having to enter all of the data again on another HMI device. NOTICE During a restore, the currently valid user data is overwritten. The restored user data and passwords are valid immediately. Limits for User, Password and User View Number of characters Length of user name, maximum 8.1.4.2 40 Length of password, minimum 3 Length of password, maximum 24 Entries in user view, maximum 50 User logon Requirements Use the logon dialog to log into the security system of the HMI device. Enter user name and password in the logon dialog. You have the following options for displaying the logon dialog: Touch the operator control object with password protection. Touch an operator control object that was configured for displaying the logon dialog. Double-click on the "" entry in the User view. At the beginning of the project, the logon dialog will be automatically displayed in certain circumstances. Further information on this may be available in your plant documentation. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 239 Operating a Project 8.1 Operating a Project on the TP 177A Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Enter the user name and password. Touch the corresponding input field. The alphanumerical screen keyboard is displayed. 2. Touch the "OK" button. Note The user name is not case-sensitive. The password is case-sensitive. Result After successful logon to the security system, you can execute password-protected functions on the HMI device for which you have permissions. An error message is displayed if you enter the wrong password. In this case, no user is logged in to the project. 8.1.4.3 User logoff Requirements You have logged into the security system of the HMI device. Procedure You have the following options for logging off: When no operator actions occur and the logoff time has expired, the user is automatically logged off. Touching an operator control configured for logging off. Further information on this may be available in your plant documentation. The current user is also logged off if an incorrect password is entered. Result The user is no longer logged into the project. In order to operate an operator control object with password protection, you must first log in again. 240 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating a Project 8.1 Operating a Project on the TP 177A 8.1.4.4 Create user Requirements New users are created in the user view. To display the user view, switch to the screen that contains the user view. To add a new user, you must have user management permission. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Touch the "" entry in the user view. The following dialog appears: 2. Enter the desired user information. Touch the corresponding input field. The appropriate screen keyboard is displayed. - The password may not contain space characters or the special characters * ? . % / \ ' ". - For the logoff time, you can use values of 0 to 60 minutes. The value 0 stands for "no automatic logoff." 3. Touch the "OK" button. Result The new user is created. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 241 Operating a Project 8.1 Operating a Project on the TP 177A 8.1.4.5 Changing user data Requirements Change user data in the user view. To display the user view, switch to the screen that contains the user view. The following options are available for the range of changes that can be made: The administrator or a user with user management permission can change the data for all users on the HMI device system in the user view. - User name - Group assignment - Password - Logoff time Users without user management permission can only change their own user data. - Password - Logoff time Note You can only change the logoff time and password for the "Admin" user. You can only change the logoff time for the "PLC_User". This user entry is used for logging in via the PLC. Procedure This procedure describes changing user data by the administrator or a user with user management permission. Proceed as follows: 1. In the user view, touch the user whose user data you want to change. The following dialog appears: 2. Change the desired user data. Touch the corresponding input field. The appropriate screen keyboard is displayed. 3. Touch the "OK" button. Result The user data for the user is changed. 242 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating a Project 8.1 Operating a Project on the TP 177A 8.1.4.6 Deleting a user Requirements You delete users in the user view: To display the user view, switch to the screen that contains the user view. To delete a user, you must have user management permission. Note The "Admin" and "PLC_User" users exist by default and cannot be deleted. Procedure - Deleting a user Proceed as follows: 1. Touch the user entry that you want to delete in the user view. The following dialog appears: 2. Touch the "User" input field. The alphanumerical screen keyboard is displayed. 3. Touch the button on the screen keyboard. The existing user name is deleted from the screen keyboard. 4. Touch the button on the screen keyboard. The user name in the "User" input field is deleted. 5. Touch the "OK" button. Result The user is deleted. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 243 Operating a Project 8.1 Operating a Project on the TP 177A 8.1.5 Closing the project Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Use the corresponding operator control object to close the project. Wait for the Loader to open after you closed the project. 2. Switch off power to the HMI device. 8.1.6 Operating the Trend View 8.1.6.1 Overview Trends Trends continuously display the current process data. Trend View Trends are displayed in the Trend view. A Trend view can display up to four trends simultaneously. The figure below shows an example of a Trend view: Ruler Trend value in the value table The appearance, axes, value range and labels of the Trend view can be set by the configuration engineer. The configuration engineer can set limits for the trend values. A color transition can be configured when the limits are exceeded. Additional information on this may be available in your plant documentation. 244 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating a Project 8.1 Operating a Project on the TP 177A Value Table The trend values can be read from the value table, if this is configured. Ruler The exact trend values can be read from the ruler, if this is configured. 8.1.6.2 Operating the Trend View Value Table The trend values are displayed in the value table. When the ruler is displayed, the trend values are shown at a position of the ruler. When the ruler is hidden, the latest trend values are displayed. Ruler When configured, a ruler is available to provide an exact reading of the individual values. The position of the ruler can be changed by touching and dragging it on the touch screen. The configuration engineer can configure the following actions for operator controls outside the Trend display: Display or hide ruler Move ruler forward Move ruler backward Further information on this may be available in your plant documentation. Other Operator Actions The configuration engineer can configure the following actions for operator controls outside the Trend display: Enlarge display of time intervals Reduce display of time intervals Scroll back by one display width Scroll forward by one display width Stop or resume trend recording Further information on this may be available in your plant documentation. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 245 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B 8.2.1 Overview Using Operator Controls on the Touch Screen Operator controls are touch-sensitive objects on the HMI screen such as buttons, I/O fields and alarm windows. Touch objects are basically operated in the same way as mechanical keys. You activate operator controls by touching them with your finger. Some operations with the project may require in-depth knowledge about the specific plant on the part of the operator. It is therefore important to take special care, for example, in displaying typing. Further information on this may be available in your plant documentation. CAUTION Always touch only one operator control on the screen. Never touch more than one operator control at a time, otherwise you may trigger unintentional actions. CAUTION Do not use any pointed or sharp objects when operating the touch screen as this may damage the plastic membrane of the touch screen. Locking operator controls The HMI provides optical feedback when it detects that an operator control has been touched. This feedback is independent of any communication with the PLC. Therefore, this feedback does not indicate whether the relevant action is actually executed or not. The configuration engineer may also have configured the feedback function in a different manner. Further information on this may be available in your plant documentation. 246 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B Optical Feedback from Operator Controls The type of optical feedback depends on the operator control object: Buttons The HMI outputs different views of the "Touched" and "Untouched" states, provided the configuration engineer has configured a 3D effect: - "Touched" state: - "Untouched" state: The configuration engineer defines the appearance of a selected field, for example, its line width and color for the focus. Invisible buttons The focus for invisible buttons is not identified after selection by default. No optical operation feedback is provided in this case. The configuration engineer may, however, configure invisible buttons so that their outline appears as lines when touched. This outline remains visible until the you select another operator control object. I/O fields After you touch an I/O field, a screen keyboard appears as optical operation feedback. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 247 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B 8.2.2 Operating keys on the TP 177B 4" and OP 177B Function keys with global function assignment A function key with global function assignment always triggers the same action on the HMI device or in the PLC, regardless of the current screen. An example of such an action is the activation of a screen or the closing an alarm window. Function keys with local function assignment A function key with local function assignment is screen-specific and is therefore only effective within the active screen. The function assigned to a function key can vary from screen to screen. The function key of a screen can be assigned one function only, either a global or local one. The local assignment function takes priority over the global setting. Function keys as system keys Function keys can also be configured as system keys. For example, they can function as the numerical keypad, the cursor keypad or as a section of the alphanumerical keypad. Multi-key operation Unwanted actions may be triggered if the operator unintentionally actuates a key combination. CAUTION Unintentional actions In "Online" mode, simultaneous operation of more than two keys may cause unintentional actions in the plant. Do not press more than two keys simultaneously. 248 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B 8.2.3 Direct keys Introduction Direct keys on the HMI device are used to set bits in the I/O area of a SIMATIC S7. Direct keys enable operations with short reaction times that are, for example, a jog mode requirement. NOTICE Direct keys are still active when the HMI device is in "offline" mode. NOTICE If you operate a function key with direct key functionality in a running project, the direct key function is always executed, independent of the current screen contents. Note You can only use direct keys when there is a connection via PROFIBUS DP or PROFINET IO. Direct keys result in additional basic load on the HMI device. Direct keys The following objects can be configured as a direct key: Buttons On TP 177B 4" and OP 177B: Function keys You can also define image numbers in the case of HMI devices with touch operation. In this way, you can configure the direct keys on an image-specific basis. Further information on configuring direct keys can be found in the "WinCC flexible Communication" system manual. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 249 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B 8.2.4 Setting the project language Introduction The HMI device supports multilingual projects. You need to configure a corresponding operator control object which lets you change the language setting on the HMI device during runtime. The project always starts with the language set in the previous session. Requirements The relevant project language must be available on the HMI device. The language changeover function must be logically linked to a configured operator control object such as a button. Selecting a language You can change project languages at any time. Language-specific objects are immediately output to the screen in the relevant language when you switch languages. The following options are available for switching the language: 1. A configured operator control object switches from one project language to the next in a list. 2. A configured operator control directly sets the desired project language. Further information on this may be available in your plant documentation. 8.2.5 Entries and help within a project 8.2.5.1 Overview Screen keyboard When you touch an operating element requiring entry on the HMI device touch screen, a screen keyboard appears. The screen keyboard is displayed in the following cases: An I/O field is selected for input. A password must be entered for accessing a password-protected function. The screen keyboard is automatically hidden again when input is complete. Based on the configuration of the operating element, the system displays different screen keyboards for entering numerical or alphanumerical values. Note The screen keyboard display is independent of the configured project language. 250 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B General procedure The operating elements of a screen are operated by touching the touch screen. Proceed as follows: 1. Touch the desired operating element within the screen. 2. Depending on the operating element, perform further actions. Detailed descriptions can be found under the respective operating element. Examples: - I/O field: Enter numerical, alphanumerical or symbolic values in the I/O field. - Symbolic I/O field: Select an entry from the selection list. - Slider control: Move the slider control. Procedure for text boxes Values are entered in the project text boxes. Based on your configuration, the values are saved to tags and transferred, for example, to the PLC. Proceed as follows: 1. Touch the desired text box within the screen. The screen keyboard opens. Depending on your configuration, you can enter values in the text box in the following manner: - Numerical values, for example decimal numbers, hexadecimal numbers, binary values - Alphanumerical values, for example digits and letters - Date/time 2. Enter the value. 3. Confirm your entry with TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 or discard your entry with the button . 251 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B 8.2.5.2 Entering numerical values on the TP 177A, TP 177B and OP 177B Numerical screen keyboard When you touch an operating element for numerical input on the HMI-device touch screen, the numerical screen keyboard appears. This is the case, for example, for a text box. The screen keyboard is automatically hidden again when input is complete. Note Opened screen keyboard When the screen keyboard is open, PLC job 51, "Select screen" has no function. Formats for numerical values You can enter values in numerical text boxes based on the following formats: Decimal Hexadecimal Binary Limit value test of numerical values Tags can be assigned limit values. The current limit values are indicated in the numerical screen keyboard. If you enter a value that lies outside of this limit, it will not be accepted, for example, 80 with a limit value of 78. In this case the HMI device will deliver a system alarm, if an alarm window is configured. The original value is displayed again. 252 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B Decimal places for numerical values The configuration engineer can define the number of decimal places for a numerical text box. The number of decimal places is checked when you enter a value in this type of I/O field. Decimal places in excess of the limit are ignored. Empty decimal places are filled with "0." Procedure Numerical and hexadecimal values can be entered character-by-character via the buttons on the numerical screen keyboard. Proceed as follows: 1. Touch the desired operating element within the screen. The numerical screen keyboard opens. The existing value is displayed in the screen keyboard and is selected. 2. Enter the value. You can only operate keys that are required for entering values. The keys with letters cannot be used, for example, for entering a decimal value. Which keys can be operated can be seen from the appearance of the keys. You have the following options to enter a value: - The selected value is deleted when you enter the first character. Completely reenter the value. and - Use the keys to move the cursor within the current value. You can now edit or add to the characters of the current value. key to delete the character to the left of the cursor. If the value is Use the selected, use this key to delete the selected part of the value. - Change the sign of the value using the key. key to display the infotext of the I/O field. - Use the This button is only enabled if infotext has been configured for the input object or the current screen. 3. Use the key to confirm your entry or cancel it with . Either action closes the screen keyboard. Result You have changed the numerical value or entered a new one. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 253 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B 8.2.5.3 Entering alphanumerical values on the TP 177A, TP 177B 6" and OP 177B Alphanumerical screen keyboard When you touch an operating element for numerical input on the HMI-device touch screen, the alphanumerical screen keyboard appears. This is the case, for example, for an input field or a date / time field. The screen keyboard is automatically hidden again when input is complete. The figure below shows the normal level of the alphanumerical screen keyboard. Note Opened screen keyboard When the screen keyboard is open, PLC job 51, "Select screen" has no function. Language change Language change in the project has no influence on the alphanumerical screen keyboard. The entry of Cyrillic or Asian characters is therefore not possible. Keyboard levels The alphanumerical screen keyboard has various levels: Normal level Shift level If you change the levels with key 254 , the key assignments change. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B Procedure Alphanumerical values can be entered character-by-character via the buttons on the alphanumerical screen keyboard. Proceed as follows: 1. Touch the desired operating element within the screen. The alphanumerical screen keyboard opens. The existing value is displayed in the screen keyboard and is selected. 2. Enter the value. You have the following options to enter a value: - The selected value is deleted when you enter the first character. Completely reenter the value. and - Use the keys to move the cursor within the current value. You can now edit or add to the characters of the current value. key to delete the character to the left of the cursor. If the value is Use the selected, use this key to delete the selected part of the value. it is possible to switch between the keyboard levels of the screen - Using key keyboard. On switchover, the key assignments of the screen keyboard change. key to display the infotext of the I/O field. - Use the This button is only enabled if infotext has been configured for the input object or the current screen. 3. Use the key to confirm your entry or cancel it with . Either action closes the screen keyboard. Result You have changed the alphanumerical value or entered a new one. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 255 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B 8.2.5.4 Entering alphanumerical values on the TP 177B 4" Screen keyboard When you touch an operating element on the HMI-device touch screen, the screen keyboard appears. This is the case, for example, for an input field or a date / time field. The screen keyboard is automatically hidden again when input is complete. Note Opened screen keyboard When the screen keyboard is open, PLC job 51, "Select screen" has no function. Language change Language change in the project has no influence on the alphanumerical screen keyboard. The entry of Cyrillic or Asian characters is therefore not possible. Keyboard levels All the keys on the screen keyboard are divided over several levels. Using the keys in the fourth row of the keyboard you can toggle between levels whilst inputting. The following table shows the levels of the screen keyboard and the associated calls: 256 Name Available keys Call Normal level a to m Lowercase letters from a to m Shift level A to M Uppercase letters from A to M Normal level n to z Lowercase letters from n to z Shift level N to Z Uppercase letters from N to Z Normal level 0 to 9 Digits from 0 to 9 Normal level +-/* Special characters Shift level +-/* Special characters + + + TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B Procedure The required values can be entered character by character using the screen keyboard buttons. Proceed as follows: 1. Touch the desired operating element within the screen. The screen keyboard opens. The existing value is displayed in the screen keyboard and is selected. 2. Enter the value. You have the following options to enter a value: - The selected value is deleted when you enter the first character. Completely reenter the value. and - Use the keys to move the cursor within the current value. You can now edit or add to the characters of the current value. key to delete the character to the left of the cursor. If the value is Use the selected, use this key to delete the selected part of the value. , - Using keys , , and it is possible to switch between the levels of the screen keyboard. On switchover, the key assignments change. 3. Use the key to confirm your entry or cancel it with . Either action closes the screen keyboard. Result You have changed the value or entered a new one. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 257 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B 8.2.5.5 Entering and editing symbolic values Selection list When you touch a symbolic IO field on the HMI touch screen, a selection list appears. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Touch the required symbolic IO field. The selection list of the symbolic IO field is displayed. You can scroll through the selection list with the and buttons. 2. Select an entry in the selection list. Touch an entry to select it. This is then taken by the controller. Result You have changed the symbolic value or entered a new one. 8.2.5.6 Entering the Date and Time Entering the date and time Enter the date and time in the same way you enter alphanumerical values. Note When entering the date and time, please note that the format is determined by the configured project language. See also Setting the project language (Page 250) 258 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B 8.2.5.7 Viewing Infotext Purpose The configuration engineer uses infotext to provide additional information and operating instructions with respect to screens and operable screen objects. Infotext can provide information on the value to be entered in an IO field, for example. Infotext for Input Objects Touch the key on the screen keyboard. This key is only enabled if infotext or the current screen has been configured for the input object. Note Switching between displayed infotexts If infotext has been configured for an IO field and a screen, touching the infotext window toggles between the two. Infotext for Other Operator Controls Infotext can also be configured for operator controls, such as buttons. The infotext of the selected operator control can be displayed by pressing a configured function key. Refer to your plant documentation to find any additional information on this topic. Infotext for the Current Screen Infotext can also be configured for screens. The infotext for the current screen is called up or by the screen keyboard or by an operator control object assigned to this function. Refer to your plant documentation to find any additional information on this topic. Closing the Infotext Close the infotext with . TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 259 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B 8.2.6 Operating a Gauge Introduction The gauge displays analog numerical values using a pointer. The operator at the HMI device can thus see at a glance, for example, that the boiler pressure is in the normal range. Appearance The appearance of the gauge depends on the configuration. A trailing pointer can display the maximum value reached so far on the scale. The trailing pointer is reset when the screen is reloaded. The label on the scale can show the measured variable, e.g. boiler pressure, and the physical unit, e.g. bar. Operation The gauge is for display only and cannot be controlled by the operator. 260 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B 8.2.7 Using Switches Introduction The switches described in the following have two circuit states. Each circuit state is assigned a fixed value. When you operate the switch, it changes to the opposite circuit state and thereby activates the configured value. Switches can contain sliders, texts or graphics for a specific project. Procedure - Switch with Slider Proceed as follows: Move the slider on the touch screen of the HMI device to the other position or double-click the slider area. Slider Result The slider is now in the other position. The assigned value is activated. Procedure for a slider with text or graphic Proceed as follows: Touch the switch on the touch screen of the HMI device. Result The switch changes its appearance. The associated value is switched. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 261 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B 8.2.8 Using a Slider Introduction With the slider control you can change and monitor process values within a defined range. The slider control can also be configured without a slider. No value is entered in this case. The slider control servers only to display values. Slider control for entering values Value display with current value Appearance You can configure the appearance and the elements of the slider control. The slider control can contain a label and a setting range, for example. The current value can be configured to appear below the area of the slider control. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Touch the slider. 2. Move the slider to the required value. If a value display has been configured, you can check the exact value that has been set. 3. Release the slider. The set value is applied. Result The assigned value has been changed. 262 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B 8.2.9 Using the Status Force Display Use You read or write access values of the connected controller directly in the status force view. The status force view allows you to carry out operations such as monitoring or modifying the addresses of the controller program, without the need of an online connection via PC or PG. Note The status force view can only be used in combination with SIMATIC S5 or SIMATIC S7 controllers. Appearance The figure shows the general layout of the status force view. A value can be monitored and controlled on every line. The configuration engineer specifies which columns appear in the status force view. The table shows the significance of the potential columns. Column Function "Connection" The PLC of which the address ranges are to be displayed "Type", "DB Number", "Offset", "Bit" The address range of the value "Data type", "Format" The data type of the value "Status value" The value read from the specified address "Control value" The value to be written to the specified address Change column sequence You change the column sequence if this has been configured. To reverse the "Format" and "Control Value" columns, for example, touch the "Format" header on the touch screen of the HMI device. Keep the touch screen pressed and drag the column heading to the "Control Value" heading. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 263 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B Operating elements The buttons have the following functions when configured: Button Function "Read" button Updates the display in the "Status value" column. The button engages when it is pressed. You cannot operate any input fields until the button is actuated again and the refresh is stopped. "Write" button Applies the new value in the "Control value" column. The control value is then written to the PLC. Procedure for reading the status value Proceed as follows: 1. Enter the address and the desired format of a value for each line. Touch the respective columns to display the screen keyboard. 2. Once you have entered all of the desired values, touch the button. Result All values are read cyclically by the controller and entered in the "Status Value" column until the button is touched again. Requirements for controlling The following requirements must be met to control values: The "Control value" column must be available. The "Write" button must be available. Procedure - Controlling a value Proceed as follows: 1. Enter the address of a value for each line. Enter the desired value in the "Control value" column. Touch the respective columns to display the screen keyboard. 2. Once you have entered all of the desired values, touch the button. Result The values from the "Control value" column are transferred once to the PLC. 264 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B 8.2.10 Operating the Sm@rtClient View Overview The Sm@rtClient view for PN/DP HMI devices enables you to remotely monitor and operate an ongoing project on another HMI device. When properly configured, you can also access several democratic HMI devices on a remote HMI device. Procedure - Starting Remote Operation Proceed as follows: 1. Switch to the screen with the Sm@rtClient view on the HMI device. The following options are available to establish a connection to the remote HMI device: - The connection is automatically established. - The connection must be established by touching the appropriate button. You may be required to enter the address of the remote HMI device and a password. 2. The current screen of the ongoing project on the remote HMI device now appears on your HMI device. 3. You can now monitor and control this screen according to your configuration. Scroll bars are displayed if the screen of the remote HMI device is larger than that of the current HMI device. Monitoring mode If the Sm@rtClient view is configured for monitoring mode, you can only monitor the remote HMI device. You cannot control its operation. Operating the function keys on the OP 177B and TP 177B 4" The following options are available for operating the function keys: When a local function is configured for the function key: The function key effects your local HMI device. When no local function is configured for the function key: The function key effects a remote HMI device. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 265 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B Procedure - Forcing Permissions If several HMI devices have access to a HMI device, only one HMI device has operating permission at any one time. Two cases must be distinguished for this calculation: If another HMI device is already controlling the remote HMI device, you can configure for emergency situations in which your HMI device is given forced permission to control the remote HMI device. - You attempt to operate the remote HMI device. - A dialog appears in which you are prompted to enter the appropriate password for remote control. - You can now operate the remote HMI device. If another HMI device is accessing your HMI device via the Sm@rtClient view, you can force local operating permission for your HMI device. - Touch the screen of your HMI device five times in sequence. - You now receive operating permission on the local HMI device. Procedure - Ending Remote Operation You can end remote monitoring and remote control with one of the following methods depending on the configuration: By touching a button configured for this action. By exiting the screen containing the Sm@rtClient view. If configured, a menu appears when you touch an empty location for a given period. Touch the menu item "Close". Refer to your plant documentation to find any additional information on this topic. Note If another HMI device is accessing your HMI device via the Sm@rtClient view, this results in additional load on your HMI device. 266 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B 8.2.11 Operating Trends 8.2.11.1 Overview Trends Trends continuously display the current process data. Trend view Trends are displayed in the Trend view. A Trend view can display several trends simultaneously. Ruler Trend value in the value table The appearance, axes, value range and labels of the Trend view can be set by the configuration engineer. The configuration engineer can set limits for the trend values. A color transition can be configured when the limits are exceeded. Refer to your plant documentation to find any additional information on this topic. Value table The trend values can be read from the value table, if this is configured. Ruler The exact trend values can be read from the ruler, if this is configured. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 267 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B 8.2.11.2 Operating the Trend View Value Table The trend values are displayed in the value table. When the ruler is displayed, the trend values are shown at a position of the ruler. When the ruler is hidden, the latest trend values are displayed. Ruler When configured, a ruler is available to provide an exact reading of the individual values. The position of the ruler can be changed by touching and dragging it on the touch screen. The configuration engineer can configure the following actions for operator controls outside the Trend display: Display or hide ruler Move ruler forward Move ruler backward Further information on this may be available in your plant documentation. Other Operator Actions The configuration engineer can configure the following actions for operator controls outside the Trend display: Enlarge display of time intervals Reduce display of time intervals Scroll back by one display width Scroll forward by one display width Stop or resume trend recording Further information on this may be available in your plant documentation. 268 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B 8.2.12 Project Security 8.2.12.1 Overview Overview The configuration engineer can protect the operation of a project by implementing a security system. The security system of the HMI device is based on permissions, user groups and users. If operator control objects protected by a password are operated, the HMI device requests the entry of a password. A logon screen is displayed in which you enter your user name and password. After logging in, you can operate the operator control objects for which you have the necessary permissions. The logon dialog can be set up by the configuration engineer via an individual operator control object. In the same way, the configuration engineer can set up an operator control object to log off. After logging off, objects assigned password protection can no longer be operated; to do so, log in again. Further information on this may be available in your plant documentation. User Groups and Permissions Project-specific user groups are created by the configuration engineer. The "Administrators" group is included in all projects by default. User groups are assigned permissions. The permission required for an operation is specifically defined for each individual object and function in the project. Users Each user is assigned to exactly one user group. Users can be created as follows: By the configuration engineer during configuration By the administrator on the HMI device By a user with user management permission on the HMI device Logoff Times A logoff time is configured in the system for each user. If the time between any two user actions, e.g, entering a value or changing screens, exceeds this logoff time, the user is automatically logged off. The user must then log in again to continue to operate objects assigned password protection. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 269 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B Passwords If an administrator or a user with administrator permission is logged on, all users on the HMI device are displayed in the User view. If a user without user management permission is logged on, only the personal user entry is displayed. The permissions of a user after logging in depends on the user group to the user is assigned. Further information on this may be available in your plant documentation. The user data is encrypted and saved on the HMI device to protect it from loss due to power failure. Note Depending on the transfer settings, changes to the user data are overwritten when the project is transferred again. User View Use the User view to display the users on the HMI device. All users on the HMI device system are displayed in the User view to the administrator or to a user with administrator permissions. When user management permission is lacking, only the personal user entry is displayed. The configuration engineer can implement simple or advanced User view in the project. The two user views offer the same functions and differ only in the display of information. Simple User View The simple user view only displays the user name and user group. Enhanced User View The enhanced user view displays information about the users. 270 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B Backup and Restore The users, passwords, group assignments and logoff times set up on the HMI device can be backed up and restored. This prevents you having to enter all of the data again on another HMI device. NOTICE During a restore, the currently valid user data is overwritten. The restored user data and passwords are valid immediately. Limits for User, Password and User View Number of characters Length of user name, maximum 8.2.12.2 40 Length of password, minimum 3 Length of password, maximum 24 Entries in user view, maximum 50 User Logon Requirements Use the logon dialog to log into the security system of the HMI device. Enter user name and password in the logon dialog. You have the following options for displaying the logon dialog: Touching an operating element with password protection. Touching an operating element that was configured for displaying the logon dialog. Double-click the "" entry in the simple User view. At the beginning of the project, the logon dialog will be automatically displayed in certain circumstances. Refer to your plant documentation to find any additional information on this topic. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 271 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Enter the user name and password. Touch the corresponding input field. The alphanumerical screen keyboard is displayed. 2. Touch the "OK" button. Note The user name is not case-sensitive. The password is case-sensitive. Result After a successful logon to the security system, you can execute password-protected functions on the HMI device for which you have authorizations. If you enter an incorrect password, an error message is displayed when an Alarm window has been configured. 8.2.12.3 User Logoff Requirements You have logged into the security system of the HMI device. Procedure You have the following options for logging off: The user is logged off automatically if no operations are carried out and if the logoff time has been exceeded By touching the operating object that was configured for logging off Further information on this may be available in your plant documentation. If an incorrect password is entered, the logged-on user is also logged off. Result The user is no longer logged into the project. In order to operate an operator control object with password protection, you must first log in again. 272 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B 8.2.12.4 Creating a User Requirements New users are created in the user view. To display the user view, switch to the screen that contains the user view. To create a new user, you must have user management permission. Procedure - Creating a User in the Simple User View Proceed as follows: 1. Touch the "" entry in the user view. The following dialog appears: 2. Enter the desired user information. Touch the corresponding input field. The alphanumerical screen keyboard is displayed. The password may not contain space characters or the special characters * ? . % / \ ' ". 3. Touch the "OK" button. The following dialog appears: 4. Enter the desired user information. Touch the corresponding input field. The appropriate screen keyboard is displayed. For the logoff time, you can use values of 0 to 60 minutes. The value 0 stands for "no automatic logoff." 5. Touch the "OK" button. Result The new user is created. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 273 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B Procedure - Creating a User in the Advanced User View Proceed as follows: Enter the required user information on the empty lines of the User view. Touch the corresponding input field. The appropriate screen keyboard is displayed. The password may not contain space characters or the special characters * ? . % / \ ' ". For the logoff time, you can use values of 0 to 60 minutes. The value 0 stands for "no automatic logoff." Result The new user is created. 8.2.12.5 Changing User Data Requirements Change user data in the user view. To display the user view, switch to the screen that contains the user view. The following options are available for the range of changes that can be made: The administrator or a user with user management permission can change the data for all users on the HMI device system in the user view. - User name - Group assignment - Password - Logoff time Users without user management permission can only change their own user data. - Password - Logoff time, if configured Note You can only change the logoff time and password for the "Admin" user. You can only change the logoff time for the "PLC_User". This user entry is used for logging in via the PLC. 274 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B Procedure - Changing User Data in the Simple User View This procedure describes changing user data by the administrator or a user with user management permission. Proceed as follows: 1. In the user view, touch the user whose user data you want to change. The following dialog appears: 2. Change the desired user data. Touch the corresponding input field. The appropriate screen keyboard is displayed. 3. Touch the "OK" button. The following dialog appears: 4. Change the desired user data. Touch the corresponding input field. The appropriate screen keyboard is displayed. 5. Touch the "OK" button. Result The user data for the user is changed. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 275 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B Procedure - Changing User Data in the Advanced User View This procedure describes changing user data by the administrator or a user with user management permission. Proceed as follows: 1. In the user view, touch the user whose user data you want to change. The appropriate screen keyboard is displayed. 2. Change the desired user data. Result The user data for the user is changed. 8.2.12.6 Deleting a User Requirements You delete users in the user view: To display the user view, switch to the screen that contains the user view. To delete a user, you must have user management permission. Note The "Admin" and "PLC_User" users exist by default and cannot be deleted. 276 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B Procedure - Deleting a User in the Simple User View 1. Touch the user that you want to delete in the User view. The following dialog appears: 2. Touch the "User" input field. The alphanumerical screen keyboard is displayed. 3. Touch the button on the screen keyboard. The existing user name is deleted from the screen keyboard. 4. Touch the button on the screen keyboard. The user name in the "User" input field is deleted. The following dialog appears: 5. Touch the "OK" button. Result The user is deleted. The User view appears again. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 277 Operating a Project 8.2 Operating a project on TP 177B and OP 177B Procedure - Deleting a User in the Advanced User View Proceed as follows: 1. Touch the user you want to delete in the "User" input field of the User view. The alphanumerical screen keyboard is displayed. 2. Touch the button on the screen keyboard. The existing user name is deleted from the screen keyboard. 3. Touch the button on the screen keyboard. The user name in the "User" input field is deleted. Result The user is deleted. 8.2.13 Closing the Project Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Use the corresponding operator control object to close the project. Wait for the Loader to open after you closed the project. 2. Switch off power to the HMI device. 278 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating Alarms 9.1 Operating Alarms TP 177A 9.1.1 Overview 9 Alarms Alarms indicate events and states on the HMI device which have occurred in the system, in the process or on the HMI device itself. A status is reported when it is received. An alarm could trigger one of the following alarm events: Incoming Outgoing Acknowledge The configuration engineer defines which alarms must be acknowledged by the user. An alarm may contain the following information: Date Time Alarm text Error location State Alarm class Alarm number Acknowledgement group TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 279 Operating Alarms 9.1 Operating Alarms TP 177A Alarm Classes Alarms are assigned to various alarm classes: Error Alarms in this class must always be acknowledged. Alarms normally indicate critical errors within the plant such as "Motor temperature too high". Warning Warning alarms usually indicate states of a plant such as "Motor switched on". System System alarms indicate states or events which occur on the HMI device. User-specific alarm classes The properties of this alarm class must be defined in the configuration. Further information on this may be available in your plant documentation. Alarm Buffer Alarm events are saved to an internal, volatile buffer. The size of this alarm buffer depends on the HMI device type. 9.1.2 Displaying Alarms Alarm view and alarm window Alarms are indicated in the Alarm view or in the Alarm window on the HMI device. The layout and operation of the Alarm window correspond to that of the Alarm view. The Alarm window is independent of the process screen. Depending on the configuration, the Alarm window appears automatically as soon as a new, unacknowledged alarm has been received. The Alarm window can be configured so that it only closes after all the alarms have been acknowledged. Refer to your plant documentation to find any additional information on this topic. 280 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating Alarms 9.1 Operating Alarms TP 177A Operating elements Functions of the Alarm view buttons: Button Function Displays infotext for an alarm Edit alarm Acknowledging an alarm Shows the full text of the selected alarm in a separate window, the alarm text window. In the alarm text window, you can view alarm texts that require more space than is available in the alarm view. Close the alarm text window with . Select the next or previous alarm in the list. Scroll one page up or down. Alarm class layout The various alarm classes are identified to distinguish them in the Alarm view: Icon Alarm class ! Error (empty) Operation (depends on the configuration) User-defined alarm classes $ System The configuration engineer can edit the alarm class symbols. Refer to your plant documentation to find any additional information on this topic. Displaying infotext The configuration engineer can also provide infotext for alarms. Proceed as follows to view the infotext for an alarm: 1. Select the required alarm in the Alarm view 2. Touch . If configured, the infotext assigned to this alarm is displayed. 3. Close the infotext window with TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 281 Operating Alarms 9.1 Operating Alarms TP 177A Alarm indicator The alarm indicator is a graphic symbol that shows current errors or errors that need to be acknowledged, depending on the configuration. The alarm indicator flashes as long as alarms are queued for acknowledgment. The number indicates the number of queued alarms. The configuration engineer can assign functions to be executed when the alarm indicator is operated. Usually, the alarm indicator is only used for error alarms. Refer to your plant documentation to find any additional information on this topic. 9.1.3 Acknowledging Alarms Requirements The alarm which is to be acknowledged is displayed in the Alarm window or in the Alarm view. Either the Alarm window or the Alarm view is enabled. The alarm must be acknowledged. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Select the alarm by touching it in the Alarm view or Alarm window. 2. Touch . Result The alarm or all alarms of the corresponding acknowledgement group are acknowledged. Further information about acknowledgment groups may be available in your plant documentation. See also Displaying Alarms (Page 280) 282 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating Alarms 9.1 Operating Alarms TP 177A 9.1.4 Editing Alarms Introduction The configuration engineer can assign additional functions to each alarm. These functions are executed when the alarm is processed. Requirements The alarm to be edited is indicated in the Alarm window or in the Alarm view. Either the Alarm window or the Alarm view is enabled. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Select the alarm by touching it in the Alarm view or Alarm window. 2. Touch . Result The system executes the additional functions of the alarm. Further information on this may be available in your plant documentation. Note When you edit an unacknowledged alarm, it is acknowledged automatically. See also Displaying Alarms (Page 280) TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 283 Operating Alarms 9.2 Operating Alarms on TP 177B and OP 177B 9.2 Operating Alarms on TP 177B and OP 177B 9.2.1 Overview Alarms Alarms indicate events and states on the HMI device which have occurred in the system, in the process or on the HMI device itself. A status is reported when it is received. An alarm could trigger one of the following alarm events: Incoming Outgoing Acknowledge The configuration engineer defines which alarms must be acknowledged by the user. An alarm may contain the following information: Date Time Alarm text Error location State Alarm class Alarm number Acknowledgement group Diagnostics capability 284 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating Alarms 9.2 Operating Alarms on TP 177B and OP 177B Alarm Classes Alarms are assigned to various alarm classes: Error Alarms in this class must always be acknowledged. Alarms normally indicate critical errors within the plant such as "Motor temperature too high". Warning Warning alarms usually indicate states of a plant such as "Motor switched on". System System alarms indicate states or events which occur on the HMI device. SIMATIC diagnostic alarms SIMATIC diagnostic alarms show states and events of the SIMATIC S7 or SIMOTION controllers. User-specific alarm classes The properties of this alarm class must be defined in the configuration. Further information on this may be available in your plant documentation. Alarm Buffer Alarm events are saved to an internal buffer. The size of this alarm buffer depends on the HMI device type. 9.2.2 Displaying Alarms Alarm view Alarms are indicated in the Alarm view or in the Alarm window on the HMI device. The Alarm view can be implemented with the following components: Alarm numbers and alarm texts are displayed as single lines. As simple Alarm view As advanced Alarm view In the simple or advanced Alarm views the configuration engineer specifies the alarm information to be displayed. Alarm window The layout and operation of the Alarm window correspond to that of the Alarm view. The Alarm window is independent of the process screen. Depending on the configuration, the Alarm window appears automatically as soon as a new, unacknowledged alarm has been received. The Alarm window can be configured so that it only closes after all the alarms have been acknowledged. Refer to your plant documentation to find any additional information on this topic. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 285 Operating Alarms 9.2 Operating Alarms on TP 177B and OP 177B Simple Alarm view The buttons have the following functions: Button Function Displays infotext for an alarm Edit alarm Acknowledging an alarm Select the next or previous alarm in the list. Scroll one page up or down. Advanced Alarm view The buttons have the following functions: Button Function Displays infotext for an alarm Edit alarm Acknowledging an alarm 286 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating Alarms 9.2 Operating Alarms on TP 177B and OP 177B Changing the column sequence and sorting in the advanced Alarm view You can change the column sequence and sorting to suit the project. Change column sequence To reverse the "Time" and "Date" columns, for example, touch the "Date" header on the HMI device touch screen. Continue to press the touch screen and drag the column heading to the "Time" heading. Changing sorting To change the sorting of the alarms, touch the respective column heading on the touch screen of the HMI device. Alarm class layout The various alarm classes are identified to distinguish them in the Alarm view: Icon Alarm class ! Error (empty) Operation (depends on the configuration) User-defined alarm classes S7 SIMATIC or SIMOTION diagnostic alarms $ System The configuration engineer can edit the alarm class symbols. Refer to your plant documentation to find any additional information on this topic. Displaying infotext The configuration engineer can also provide infotext for alarms. Proceed as follows to view the infotext for an alarm: 1. Select the required alarm in the Alarm view. 2. Touch the button in the simple Alarm view or in the advanced Alarm view. If configured, the infotext assigned to this alarm is displayed. 3. Close the infotext window with TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 287 Operating Alarms 9.2 Operating Alarms on TP 177B and OP 177B Alarm indicator The alarm indicator is a graphic symbol that shows current errors or errors that need to be acknowledged, depending on the configuration. The alarm indicator flashes as long as alarms are queued for acknowledgment. The number indicates the number of queued alarms. The configuration engineer can assign functions to be executed when the alarm indicator is operated. Usually, the alarm indicator is only used for error alarms. Please refer to your system documentation to check whether additional information on this subject is available there. 9.2.3 Acknowledging Alarms Requirements The alarm which is to be acknowledged is displayed in the Alarm window or in the Alarm view. Either the Alarm window or the Alarm view is enabled. The alarm must be acknowledged. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Select the alarm by touching it in the Alarm view or Alarm window. 2. Touch the button in the simple Alarm view or in the advanced Alarm view. A soft key can also be configured to acknowledge alarms. Result The alarm or all alarms of the corresponding acknowledgement group are acknowledged. Further information about acknowledgment may be available in your plant documentation. See also Displaying Alarms (Page 285) 288 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating Alarms 9.2 Operating Alarms on TP 177B and OP 177B 9.2.4 Editing Alarms Introduction The configuration engineer can assign additional functions to each alarm. These functions are executed when the alarm is processed. Requirements The alarm to be edited is indicated in the Alarm window or in the Alarm view. Either the Alarm window or the Alarm view is enabled. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Select the alarm by touching it in the Alarm view or Alarm window. 2. Touch the button in the simple Alarm view or in the advanced Alarm view. Result The system executes the additional functions of the alarm. Further information on this may be available in your plant documentation. Note When you edit an unacknowledged alarm, it is acknowledged automatically. See also Displaying Alarms (Page 285) TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 289 Operating Alarms 9.2 Operating Alarms on TP 177B and OP 177B 290 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating Recipes 10.1 10 Overview Introduction Recipes are used when different variants of a product are manufactured with the same process. In this case, the product variants differ in terms of their type and quantity of the components, but not in terms of the manufacturing process sequence. The configuration engineer can store the combination of each individual product variant in a recipe. Field of application Recipes can be used everywhere the same product components are used in variable combinations to create different product variants. Examples: Beverage industry Food processing industry Pharmaceutical industry Paint industry Building materials industry Steel industry TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 291 Operating Recipes 10.2 Structure of a recipe 10.2 Structure of a recipe Recipes The recipe collection for the production of a product family can be compared to a file cabinet. A recipe which is used to manufacture a product corresponds to a drawer in a file cabinet. Example: In a plant for producing fruit juice, recipes are required for different flavors. There is a recipe, for example, for the flavors orange, grape, apple and cherry. 292 File cabinet Recipe collection Recipes for a fruit juice plant Drawer Recipe Orange flavored drinks Drawer Recipe Grape flavored drinks Drawer Recipe Apple flavored drinks Drawer Recipe Cherry flavored drinks TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating Recipes 10.2 Structure of a recipe Recipe data records The drawers of the file cabinet are filled with suspension folders. The suspension folders in the drawers represent records required for manufacturing various product variants. Example: Product variants of the flavor apple might be a soft drink, a juice or nectar, for example. Drawer Recipe Product variants of apple flavored drinks Suspension folder Recipe data record Apple drink Suspension folder Recipe data record Apple nectar Suspension folder Recipe data record Apple juice Elements In the figure showing the file cabinet, each suspension folder contains the same number of sheets. Each sheet in the suspension folder corresponds to an element of the recipe data record. All the records of a recipe contain the same elements. The records differ, however, in the value of the individual elements. Example: All drinks contain the same components: water, concentrate, sugar and flavoring. The records for soft drink, fruit juice or nectar differ, however, in the quantity of sugar used in production. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 293 Operating Recipes 10.3 Recipes in the Project 10.3 Recipes in the Project Overview If recipes are used in a project, the following components interact: HMI device recipe memory Recipes are saved in the form of data records in the HMI device recipe memory. The recipe data can also be saved in recipe tags. Recipe view / recipe screen On the HMI device, recipes are displayed and edited in the recipe view or in a recipe screen. - The recipe data records from the internal memory of the HMI device are displayed and edited in the recipe view. - The values of the recipe tags are displayed and edited in the recipe screen. Note The same recipe tags can be configured in a variety of recipes. If you modify the value of a recipe tag, the synchronization changes the value of the recipe tag in all recipes. Recipe tags on the TP 177A The recipe tags contain recipe data. Recipe tags configured in IO fields are always automatically synchronized with the recipe view. You can exchange the values of the recipe tags with the PLC. Recipe tags on the TP 177B and OP 177B The recipe tags contain recipe data. When you edit recipes in a recipe screen, the recipe values are stored in recipe tags. The recipe tags are not automatically synchronous with the recipe view. You can synchronize the recipe tags with the recipe data records so that the same values are saved in both. Depending on the configuration, the values of the recipe tags are exchanged with the PLC. External storage medium on the TP 177B and OP 177B You can store recipe data records on the memory card of the TP 177B and OP 177B. On the TP 177B 4" you can also save the recipe data records on a USB stick. Recipe data records are exported from the HMI device recipe memory and are saved to a CSV file on the external storage medium. The records can be reimported from the storage medium to the recipe memory. 294 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating Recipes 10.3 Recipes in the Project Data flow The following figure shows the data flow in a project with recipes: +0,GHYLFH 5HFLSH0HPRU\ 5HFLSHGLVSOD\ 5HFLSH 5HFLSH 5HFLSH 5HFLSHQ 5HFLSH VFUHHQ 5HFLSHWDJ &RQWUROOHU ([WHUQDO VWRUDJHGHYLFH Editing, saving or deleting a recipe data record Display recipe data record Synchronize or do not synchronize recipe tags Display and edit recipe tags in the recipe screen Write records from the recipe view to the PLC or read records from the PLC and display them in the recipe view. TP 177B and OP 177B: Recipe tags are to the PLC online or offline TP 177B and OP 177B: Export or import recipe data records to an external storage medium. The recipe tags are always synchronized on the TP 177A. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 295 Operating Recipes 10.4 Displaying a Recipe 10.4 Displaying a Recipe Displaying Recipes You can display and edit recipes on the HMI device with a recipe view or recipe screen. Recipe view A recipe view is a screen object used to manage recipe data records. The recipe view shows recipe data records in tabular form. Depending on the configuration, the recipe view is displayed as follows: As enhanced recipe view As simple recipe view The configuration engineer also defines which operator controls are displayed in the recipe view. Only the simple recipe view can be configured on the TP 177A. Enhanced recipe view on the TP 177B and OP 177B The figure below shows an example of the enhanced recipe view: 296 Selection list for the recipe Selection list for the recipe data record Element name The element name designates a specific element in the recipe data record. Display field This show the number of the selected recipe or the selected recipe data record. Value of the element Buttons for editing a recipe data record Status bar for display of the status messages TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating Recipes 10.4 Displaying a Recipe Simple recipe view The simple recipe view consists of three areas: Recipe list Record list Element list In the simple recipe view, each area is shown separately on the HMI device. Depending on the configuration, the simple recipe view starts with the recipe list or data record list. The figure below shows an example of the record list: -XLFH %HYHUDJH 1HFWDU Number of the recipe data record Recipe data records Buttons for changing the displayed list and calling the menu Display of Values NOTICE Changing the recipe data record in the background Applies to the processing of a recipe data record: If values of the corresponding recipe data record are changed by a PLC job, the recipe view is not updated automatically. To update the recipe view, reactivate the respective recipe data record. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 297 Operating Recipes 10.4 Displaying a Recipe Recipe screen A recipe screen allows the correlation between the plant and the recipe data to be displayed in graphic form. The configuration engineer combines IO fields and screen objects to form a custom input screen. The configuration engineer can distribute the IO fields of a recipe over several recipe screens, thus allowing recipe elements to be arranged by subject. The recipe screen can be operated using buttons configured accordingly. The figure below shows an example of the recipe screen: :DWHU O &RQFHQWUDWH O 6XJDU NJ $URPD O 5HFLSHQDPH 2UDQJH 1R 'DWDUHFRUGQDPH 1HFWDU 1R 6DYH 'DWDIURPWKH3/& /RDG 'DWDWR3/& Element names and corresponding values The element name designates a specific element in the recipe data record. Buttons for editing a recipe data record Modified recipe view Buttons for transferring recipe data The values displayed or entered in the recipe screen are saved in recipe tags. The recipe values are exchanged with the PLC immediately or later via these tags. A configured recipe view can itself be a component of a recipe screen. You must synchronize the tags in order to synchronize data between the tags of the recipe screen and the recipe data records displayed in the recipe view. The recipe tags are always automatically synchronized on the TP 177A. Refer to your plant documentation to find any additional information on this topic. 298 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating Recipes 10.5 Recipe Values in the HMI Device and the PLC 10.5 Recipe Values in the HMI Device and the PLC Introduction You can change the values of a recipe on the HMI device and therefore influence the manufacturing process or a machine. Depending on the configuration, the recipe values are displayed, edited and saved in different ways. If you are editing recipes with a recipe view in your project, the values are saved in recipe data records. If you are editing recipes in a recipe screen in your project, the values are saved in recipe tags. Differences may occur between the display values in the recipe view and the values saved in the associated tags in an ongoing project when you edit recipes with a recipe view and in a recipe screen. To prevent this, you need to synchronized the values of the recipe data records on the TP 177B and OP 177B with the values of the recipe tags. The recipe tags are always automatically synchronized on the TP 177A. Synchronizing Recipe Tags on the TP 177B and OP 177B Note Recipe tags can only be synchronized with the enhanced recipe view on the TP 177B and OP 177B. Synchronization of the recipe tags depends on the configuration of the enhanced recipe view: Automatic synchronization: The values of the recipe view are synchronized with the associated recipe tags. In this case, changes to values in the recipe view have an immediate effect on the values of the associated recipe tags. The values are only synchronized, when an operator control that is outside the recipe view is operated. Synchronization by the user: The values of the recipe view and the associated recipe tags are not synchronized automatically. The configuration engineer has assigned the same function to the button or a different operator control in the recipe view. The recipe tags and the recipe view are only synchronized when you operate the buttons or the appropriate operator control. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 299 Operating Recipes 10.6 Operating the Enhanced Recipe View Recipe Tags Online / Offline The configuration engineer can configure a recipe so that changes to the values of the recipe tags do not have an immediate effect on the current process. Synchronization of the recipe values between the HMI device and the PLC depends on whether the configuration engineer has selected the settings "Tags online" or the setting "Tags offline" for a recipe. The recipe tags are always offline on the TP 177A. "Tags online": This setting has the following effect: - When you change recipe values in the recipe screen, these changes are applied immediately by the PLC and immediately influence the process. - If recipe values are changed in the PLC, the changed values are displayed immediately in the recipe screen. "Tags offline": With this setting, changed recipe values are not synchronized immediately between the HMI device and the PLC. In this case, the configuration engineer must configure operator controls for transferring the values to the PLC or reading them from the PLC in a recipe screen. The recipe values are only synchronized between HMI device and PLC when you operate the appropriate operator control. 10.6 Operating the Enhanced Recipe View 10.6.1 Overview Operation The recipe view can be operated as follows: Enter values for the recipe elements Create recipe data records Save recipe data records or save them under a new name Delete recipe data records TP 177B and OP 177B: Synchronize values of the recipe view with the associated recipe tags Transfer recipe data records from the PLC and to the PLC 300 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating Recipes 10.6 Operating the Enhanced Recipe View Operator Controls of the Recipe View The table below shows the operator controls of the recipe view: Buttons Function Creates a new recipe data record. If a start value is configured, it is shown in the input field. Saves the displayed values of the recipe data record. The storage location is predefined by the project. The recipe data record is saved under a different name irrespective of the recipe view. A dialog box opens in which the name is entered. The displayed recipe data record is deleted. TP 177B and OP 177B: The values of the recipe view are synchronized with the associated recipe tags. The values changed during editing are written to the associated recipe tags. Subsequently all the values of the tags are read out and updated in the table. The recipe values from the PLC are displayed in the recipe view. The values of the set recipe data record displayed in the recipe view are transferred to the PLC. Operating the Recipe Screen You operate the recipes in a recipe screen with the operator controls provided by the configuration engineer. Further information on this may be available in your plant documentation. Entering the value. If you want to change the value of a tag, call up the screen keyboard. The functions listed in the table and the entry of values may also be assigned to a softkey on the OP 177B. Refer to the plant documentation for more information in this regard. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 301 Operating Recipes 10.6 Operating the Enhanced Recipe View 10.6.2 Creating a recipe data record Introduction You create a new recipe data record by modifying an existing record. You then save the modified data record under a new name. Requirements A screen with a recipe view is displayed. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. If the recipe view contains several recipes: Select the recipe for which you want to create a new recipe data record. 2. Touch . A new recipe data record with the next available number is created. If you change the new data record number to an existing data record number, the existing data record is overwritten. 3. Enter values for the elements of the data record. The elements of the recipe data record can be assigned default values depending on the configuration. 4. Touch . 5. Enter a name for the data record. The data record is saved under the new name. If the recipe data record already exists, a dialog is opened. In this dialog, specify whether the existing data record is to be overwritten. Result The new recipe data record is saved to the selected recipe. See also Overview (Page 300) 302 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating Recipes 10.6 Operating the Enhanced Recipe View 10.6.3 Editing a recipe data record Introduction Edit the values of the recipe data records and save them in a recipe view. Synchronization with the PLC If you want to display the current recipe values from the PLC in the recipe view, you first have to read the current values from the PLC with . The values changed in the recipe view only become effective when the amended data record is transferred to the PLC by means of the button. Requirements A screen with a recipe view is displayed. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. If the recipe view contains several recipes: Select the recipe which contains the desired recipe data record. 2. Select the recipe data record you want to change. 3. Change the data record as required. 4. Save your changes by means of the button. If you want to save the recipe data record under a different name, touch the key. 5. The recipe data record is saved. Result The edited recipe data record has now been saved in the selected recipe. See also Overview (Page 300) Recipes in the Project (Page 294) TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 303 Operating Recipes 10.6 Operating the Enhanced Recipe View 10.6.4 Deleting a recipe data record Introduction You can delete all the data records of a recipe which are not required. Requirements A screen with a recipe view is displayed. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. If the recipe view contains several recipes: Select the recipe which contains the desired recipe data record. 2. Select the recipe data record you want to delete. 3. Touch . Result The recipe data record is deleted. See also Overview (Page 300) Recipes in the Project (Page 294) 304 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating Recipes 10.6 Operating the Enhanced Recipe View 10.6.5 Synchronizing Tags on the TP 177B and OP 177B Introduction The values of the recipe elements can be saved to recipe tags, depending on the configuration. Differences may occur between the display values in the recipe view and the actual values of tags in an ongoing project. Synchronize the tags to equalize such differences. Synchronization always includes all the variables which belong to a recipe data record. NOTICE Changed tag name Tags and the value of the recipe data record cannot be assigned to each other if the tag name of the tag to be synchronized has been changed. The tags in question are not synchronized. Note Recipe tags can only be synchronized in the enhanced recipe view. Requirement A screen with a recipe view is displayed. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. If the recipe view contains several recipes: Select the recipe which contains the desired recipe data record. 2. Select the recipe data record you want to synchronize. 3. Touch . Result The elements of the recipe data record are synchronized with the recipe tags. If the values of the recipe view and the tag do not match, the more current value is accepted. See also Overview (Page 300) Recipes in the Project (Page 294) Recipe Values in the HMI Device and the PLC (Page 299) TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 305 Operating Recipes 10.6 Operating the Enhanced Recipe View 10.6.6 Reading a recipe data record from the PLC Introduction In the current project, the values which are also stored in the recipes in the HMI device can be changed directly in the plant. This is the case, for example, if a valve was opened further directly at the plant than is stored in the recipe. The values of the recipe data records saved in the HMI device possibly no longer match the values in the PLC. To synchronize the recipe values, read the values from the PLC and display them in the recipe view. Requirements A screen with a recipe view is displayed. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. If the recipe view contains several recipes: Select the recipe which contains the desired recipe data record. 2. Select the recipe data record to which you want to apply the values from the PLC. 3. Touch . The values are read from the PLC. 4. If you want to store the displayed values in the HMI device, touch the button. Result The values were read from the PLC, displayed on the HMI device and saved to the selected recipe data record. See also Overview (Page 300) Recipes in the Project (Page 294) Recipe Values in the HMI Device and the PLC (Page 299) 306 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating Recipes 10.6 Operating the Enhanced Recipe View 10.6.7 Transferring a recipe data record to the PLC Introduction In order for an edited recipe data record to take effect in the process, you must transfer the values to the PLC. The display values in the recipe view are always transferred to the PLC. Requirements A screen with a recipe view is displayed. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. If the recipe view contains several recipes: Select the recipe which contains the desired recipe data record. 2. Select the recipe data record whose values you want to transfer to the PLC. 3. Touch . Result The display values in the recipe view were transferred to the PLC and take effect in the process. See also Overview (Page 300) Recipes in the Project (Page 294) Recipe Values in the HMI Device and the PLC (Page 299) TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 307 Operating Recipes 10.7 Operating the Simple Recipe View 10.7 Operating the Simple Recipe View 10.7.1 Overview Introduction The simple recipe view consists of three areas: Recipe list Record list Element list You can use the shortcut menu to operate each of these display areas. Operation The simple recipe view can be operated as follows: Create recipe data records Save recipe data records or save them under a new name Rename recipe data records Delete recipe data records Transfer recipe data records from the PLC and to the PLC Operator controls of the simple recipe view Toggle between the display areas and the shortcut menus to operate the simple recipe views. The table below shows the operation of the display area: Operation Function Touching an entry The next lower display area opens, i.e. the data record list or the element list. The next higher display area opens, i.e. the recipe list or the data record list. The shortcut menu of the display area opens. The previous entry is selected in the display area. The next entry is selected in the display area. A display page is scrolled up in the display area. A display page is scrolled down in the display area. The table below shows the operation of the shortcut menu. Operation Function The menu is closed. The display area opens. Touch the menu command 308 The menu command is executed. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating Recipes 10.7 Operating the Simple Recipe View Shortcut menus of the simple recipe view A shortcut menu can be called for each display area. The commands available in the shortcut menu depend on the currently selected display area. A number is assigned to each command. The command is executed when you enter the number of the command. Recipe list Menu command Function New A new recipe data record is created for the selected recipe. If a start value is configured, it is shown in the input field. Display infotext The infotext configured for the simple recipe view is displayed. Open The record list of the selected recipe opens. Record list Menu command Function New Creates a new recipe data record. If a start value is configured, it is shown in the input field. Delete The selected recipe data record is deleted. Save as The selected recipe data record is saved under another name. A dialog box opens in which the name is entered. Rename The selected recipe data record is renamed. A dialog box opens in which the name is entered. Opening The element list of the selected recipe data record opens. Back The recipe list opens. With the TP 177A HMI device, the following menu commands can also be configured for the record list: To PLC The displayed values of the selected record are transferred from the HMI device to the PLC. From PLC The recipe values from the PLC are displayed on the HMI device in the recipe view. Display infotext The infotext configured for the simple recipe view is displayed. Element list Menu command Function Save The selected record is saved. To PLC The displayed values of the selected record are transferred from the HMI device to the PLC. From PLC The recipe values from the PLC are displayed on the HMI device in the recipe view. Save as The data record is saved under the new name. A dialog box opens in which the name is entered. With the TP 177A HMI device, the following menu commands can also be configured for the element list: Display infotext The infotext configured for the simple recipe view is displayed. Rename The selected record is renamed. A dialog box opens in which the name is entered. Back The data record list opens. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 309 Operating Recipes 10.7 Operating the Simple Recipe View Operating Menus Touch the desired menu command. The command is executed. Operating the Recipe Screen You operate the recipes in a recipe screen with the operator controls provided by the configuration engineer. Additional information on this may be available in your plant documentation. 10.7.2 Creating a Recipe Data Record Introduction Create a new recipe data record in the recipe list or in the record list. Then enter the values for the new record in the element list and save the record. Requirement A screen with a simple recipe view is displayed. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. If the recipe list contains several recipes: Select the recipe for which you want to create a new recipe data record. 2. Open the recipe list menu. 3. Select the menu command "New". A new record is created. The element list of the new record opens. 4. Enter values for the elements of the data record. The tags of the record can be assigned default values depending on the configuration. 5. Open the menu of the element list and select the command "Save". 6. Enter a name for the new record. 7. Confirm your entries. If you change the new data record number to an existing data record number, the existing data record is overwritten. Result The new recipe data record is saved to the selected recipe. See also Overview (Page 308) 310 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating Recipes 10.7 Operating the Simple Recipe View 10.7.3 Editing a Recipe Data Record Introduction Edit the values of the recipe data records in a simple recipe view. Synchronization with the PLC If you want to display the current recipe values from the PLC in the simple recipe view, you first have to read the current values from the PLC with the menu command "From PLC" in the element list. The values changed in the recipe view only take effect in the PLC when you transfer the edited data record to the PLC with the menu command "To PLC". Requirement A screen with a simple recipe view is displayed. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. If the recipe list contains several recipes: Select the recipe which contains the desired recipe data record. 2. Open the data record list. 3. Select the recipe data record you want to change. 4. Open the element list. 5. Change the values of the records as required. 6. Save your changes with the menu command "Save". The recipe data record is saved. Result The edited recipe data record has now been saved in the selected recipe. See also Overview (Page 308) TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 311 Operating Recipes 10.7 Operating the Simple Recipe View 10.7.4 Deleting a Recipe Data Record Introduction You can delete all the data records which are not required. Requirement A screen with a simple recipe view is displayed. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. If the recipe list contains several recipes: Select the recipe which contains the desired recipe data record. 2. Open the data record list. 3. Select the data record you want to delete. 4. Open the menu. 5. Select the menu command "Delete". Result The data record is deleted. See also Overview (Page 308) 312 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating Recipes 10.7 Operating the Simple Recipe View 10.7.5 Reading a Recipe Data Record from the PLC Introduction The values of recipe elements are exchanged with the PLC via tags. In the current project, the values which are also stored in the recipes in the HMI device can be changed directly in the plant. This is the case, for example, if a valve was opened further directly at the plant than is stored in the recipe. The values of the tags on the HMI device possibly no longer match the values in the PLC. To synchronize the recipe values, read the values from the PLC and display them in the recipe view. TP 177A With the TP 177A HMI device, the "From PLC" menu command can also be configured for the data record list: In this case, you can also select the "From PLC" menu command in the data record list. Requirement A screen with a simple recipe view is displayed. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. If the recipe list contains several recipes: Select the recipe which contains the desired recipe data record. 2. Select the element list of the recipe data record to which you want to apply the values from the PLC. 3. Open the menu. 4. Select the menu command "From PLC". The values are read from the PLC. 5. If you want to save the displayed values in the HMI device, select the menu command "Save". Result The values were read from the PLC, displayed on the HMI device and saved to the selected recipe data record. See also Overview (Page 308) TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 313 Operating Recipes 10.7 Operating the Simple Recipe View 10.7.6 Transferring a Recipe Data Record to the PLC Introduction In order for an edited recipe data record to take effect in the process, you must transfer the values to the PLC. The displayed values in the recipe view are always transferred to the PLC. TP 177A With the TP 177A HMI device, the "To PLC" menu command can also be configured for the data record list: In this case, you can also select the "To PLC" menu command in the data record list. Requirement A screen with a simple recipe view is displayed. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. If the recipe list contains several recipes: Select the recipe which contains the desired recipe data record. 2. Select the element list of the recipe data record whose values you want to transfer to the PLC. 3. Open the menu. 4. Select the menu command "To PLC". Result The values of the recipe data record were transferred to the PLC and take effect in the process. See also Overview (Page 308) 314 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operating Recipes 10.8 Exporting Recipe Data Records on the TP 177B and OP 177B 10.8 Exporting Recipe Data Records on the TP 177B and OP 177B Introduction You can export one or more recipe data records to a CSV file, depending on the configuration. After export, the values in the recipe data record can be further processed in a spreadsheet program such as MS Excel. The degree to which you can influence the export depends on the configuration: Requirements A screen with a recipe view is displayed An operating element with the function "Export record" has been configured. The following tags are configured equally in the recipe view and for the "Export record" operating element. - Recipe number - Data record number Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. If the recipe view contains several recipes: Select the recipe which contains the desired recipe data record. 2. Select the recipe data record you want to export. 3. Operate the operating element which was configured for export, for example the "Export data record" button. The data record is exported as a CSV file to an external data medium. Further information on this may be available in your plant documentation Result The recipe data record is exported. See also Recipes in the Project (Page 294) TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 315 Operating Recipes 10.9 Importing Recipe Data Records on the TP 177B and OP 177B 10.9 Importing Recipe Data Records on the TP 177B and OP 177B Introduction You can import values from a CSV file to a recipe data record, depending on the configuration. Requirements An operating element with the function "Import data record" has been configured, for example a button A screen with a recipe view is displayed Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. If the recipe view contains several recipes: Select the recipe which contains the recipe data record to be imported. 2. Operate the operating element with the function "Import data record". The record is imported from an external data medium as a CSV file and then displayed in the recipe view after import. Result The imported recipe data record is saved on the HMI device. Deviating structure If the structure of the CSV file differs from the structure of the recipe, deviations are handled as follows: Any additional values in the CSV file will be rejected The system applies the configured default value to the recipe data record if the CSV file contains an insufficient number of values If the CSV file contains values of the wrong data type, the configured default value is set in the recipe data record Example: The imported CSV file contains values that were entered as floating point numbers However, the corresponding tag expects an integer value. In this case, the system discards the imported value and uses the configured default See also Recipes in the Project (Page 294) 316 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Maintenance and care 11.1 Maintenance and Service 11.1.1 Maintenance and care 11 Introduction The HMI device is designed for maintenance-free operation. The touch screen and keyboard membrane should nevertheless be cleaned regularly. Requirements Use a cleaning cloth dampened with a cleaning agent to clean the equipment. Only use water with a little liquid soap or a screen cleaning foam. NOTICE Unintentional response When cleaning the touch screen, an unintentional response in the controller can be triggered by touching keys. Switch the HMI device off before cleaning to prevent unintentional responses. Damage caused by unauthorized cleaning products The HMI device may be damaged if compressed air, steam jet-air ejectors, aggressive solvents or scouring powders are used for cleaning purposes. Do not clean the HMI device with compressed air or steam jet blowers. Do not use aggressive solvents or scouring powder. Procedure Proceed as follows: 1. Switch off the HMI device. 2. Spray the cleaning solution onto a cleaning cloth. Do not spray directly onto the HMI device. 3. Clean the HMI device. When cleaning the display wipe from the screen edge inwards. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 317 Maintenance and care 11.1 Maintenance and Service 11.1.2 Clean screen on the TP 177A and TP 177B 6" Introduction The HMI screen can be cleaned when it is switched on and a project is running. An operating element must be available in the project to open the clean screen. After activating the clean screen, the touch screen and function keys are locked for the configured interval. The time the touch screen is locked can be set between 5 and 30 seconds. The time remaining for the lockout is indicated by a progress bar. NOTICE Unintentional actions Clean the HMI device screen during operation with activated clean screen or switch off the HMI device. Once the period for the clean screen has passed, operations are again possible. The HMI device cannot be operated with an active clean screen When the clean screen is active, operations on the HMI device are not possible. Wait for the period for the clean screen to lapse. Then you can operate the plant again with the HMI device. 11.1.3 Protective Membrane Protective foil A protective foil is available for the HMI touch screens. The protective foil is not part of the scope of delivery of the HMI device. Required order information is available on the Internet at "http://mall.automation.siemens.com". The self-adhesive protective foil prevents the screen from being scratched and soiled. The mat surface of the protective foil reduces reflections under unfavorable lighting. The protective film can be removed without leaving any adhesive residue on the screen. CAUTION Installing and removing the protective foil Always shut down the HMI device before installing the protective foil. You might otherwise trigger unintended functions. This also applies when removing the protective foil. Never use sharp or pointed tools, such as a knife, to remove the protective foil. This may damage the touch screen. 318 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Maintenance and care 11.1 Maintenance and Service 11.1.4 Protective covers on the TP 177A and TP 177B 6" Protective cover The cover protects the front of the TP 177A and TP 177B 6". The cover protects the display and the frame of the HMI device from dirt, scratches and chemicals. This allows the HMI devices to also be used in environments with a higher level of harmful substances. When the cover is used, the protective class NEMA4 is achieved. The following figure shows the components of protective cover: Frame Protective cover Base frame TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 319 Maintenance and care 11.1 Maintenance and Service The figure below shows the HMI device with installed protective cover: Eyelet for securing a touch screen pen Touch screen of the HMI device Protective cover Note Custom designs of the front using the protective cover The front of the HMI device can be adapted for custom designs. You can find template "Labeling protective_cover_TP070_TP170.doc" for the labeling strips on the WinCC flexible Installation CD 2 under "\Documents\\Slides." The templates are formatted for various languages. stands for the respective language you are using. Requirement The HMI device has been removed. 320 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Maintenance and care 11.1 Maintenance and Service Procedure for installation Proceed as follows: 1. Position the HMI device with the front facing down. Set the HMI device down in such a way that the touch screen cannot be damaged during the work to follow. 2. Remove the mounting seal on the HMI device Do not damage the mounting seal. Mounting seal 3. Position the base frame on the HMI device Position the base frame in such a way that the legend field is visible. Base frame Attachment point for the frame Legend field on the base frame TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 321 Maintenance and care 11.1 Maintenance and Service 4. Insert the mounting seal. Make sure the mounting seal is not twisted when inserting. Mounting seal 5. Turn the HMI device and position it on its back. 6. Position the protective cover Check to ensure that the protective cover and seal adhere to each other without any gaps. Make sure you use a protective cover that is in perfect condition. Protective cover 7. Place the protective cover on the base frame and press down firmly. You will find eight attachment points on the base frame. Press the base frame and frame together at these points, until you hear them engage. 8. Insert the HMI device in the mounting cut-out. 9. Secure the HMI device as previously described in the operating instructions. 322 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Maintenance and care 11.2 Service and spare parts Procedure for dismantling To remove the frame from the base frame, insert a screwdriver of a suitable size into a slot on the base frame. Then you can lever the frame from the base frame. 11.2 Service and spare parts Repairs In case of repair, the HMI device must be shipped to the Return Center in Furth. The HMI device may only be repaired there. The address is: Siemens AG Industry Sector Returns Center Siemensstr. 2 90766 Furth Germany Service pack A service pack can be ordered for servicing purposes. It contains the following spare parts: Mounting seal Mounting clamps Terminal block, 2-pin The service pack can be ordered from your Siemens representative. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 323 Maintenance and care 11.2 Service and spare parts 324 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 12 Specifications Dimension drawings of the TP 177B 4" 12.1 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 325 Specifications 12.2 Dimension drawings of the TP 177A and TP 177B 6" Dimension drawings of the TP 177A and TP 177B 6" 12.2 326 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Specifications 12.3 Dimension Drawings of the OP 177B Dimension Drawings of the OP 177B 12.3 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 327 Specifications 12.4 Specifications of the TP 177A 12.4 Specifications of the TP 177A HMI Device Weight without packing Approx. 750 g Display Type LCD-STN, blue mode Display area, active 115.18 mm x 86.38 mm (5.7") Resolution 320 x 240 pixels, 240 x 320 pixels with vertical mounting Colors, displayable 4 shades of blue Contrast control yes Back-lighting Half Brightness Life, typical CCFL 50 000 h Input unit Type Resistive analog touch screen Memory Program memory 512 KB Supply voltage Rated voltage +24 VDC Range, permissible 20.4 V to 28.8 V (-15 %, +20 %) Transients, maximum permissible 35 V (500 msec) Time between two transients, minimum 50 s Current input * Typical * Constant current, maximum * Power on current surge I2t * * * Fuse, internal Electronic Approx. 300 mA Approx. 450 mA Approx. 0.5 A2s See also Standards and Approvals (Page 30) Electromagnetic Compatibility (Page 36) Transport and Storage Conditions (Page 38) Mounting Information (Page 39) Specifications for Insulation Tests, Protection Class and Degree of Protection (Page 45) 328 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Specifications 12.5 Technical specifications of the TP 177B 4" 12.5 Technical specifications of the TP 177B 4" HMI device Weight without packing Approximately 500 g Display Type LCD-TFT Display area, active 95 mm x 53 mm (4.3", wide screen) Resolution 480 x 272 pixels Colors, displayable 256 Brightness control yes Backlighting Half Brightness Life Time, typical LED 30 000 h Pixel error class according to DIN EN ISO 13406-2 II Input unit Type Resistive analog touch screen Memory Application memory 2 MB Interfaces 1 x RS 422/RS 485 Max. 12 Mbit/s, applies to DP operations 1 x USB 1.1 USB host, maximum load 500 mA 1 x Ethernet RJ45 10/100 Mbits Supply voltage Rated voltage +24 VDC Range, permissible 19.2 V to 28.8 V (-20 %, +20 %) Transients, maximum permissible 35 V (500 ms) Time between two transients, minimum 50 s Current consumption * Typical * Constant current, maximum * Power on current surge I2t * * * Fuse, internal Electronic TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 approximately 200 mA approximately 550 mA approximately 0.1 A2s 329 Specifications 12.6 Technical specifications of the TP 177B 6" 12.6 Technical specifications of the TP 177B 6" HMI device Weight without packing Approx. 800 g Display Type LCD STN Display area, active 115.18 mm x 86.38 mm (5.7") Resolution 320 x 240 pixels Colors, displayable 256 colors for TP 177B 6" PN/DP 4 colors (blue mode) for TP 177B 6" DP Contrast control Yes Back-lighting Half Brightness Life, typical CCFL 50 000 h Input unit Type Resistive analog touch screen Memory Application memory 2 MB Supply voltage Rated voltage +24 VDC Range, permissible 20.4 V to 28.8 V (-15%, +20%) Transients, maximum permissible 35 V (500 ms) Time between two transients, minimum 50 s Current consumption * Typical * Constant current, maximum * Power on current surge I2t * * * Fuse, internal Electronic 330 Approx. 300 mA Approx. 500 mA Approx. 0.5 A2s TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Specifications 12.7 Specifications of the OP 177B 12.7 Specifications of the OP 177B HMI Device Weight without packing Approx. 1000 g Display Type LCD STN Display area, active 115.18 mm x 86.38 mm (5.7") Resolution 320 x 240 pixels Colors, displayable 256 colors for OP 177B PN/DP 4 colors (blue mode) for OP 177B DP Contrast control yes Back-lighting Half Brightness Life, typical CCFL 50 000 h Input unit Type Resistive analog touch screen Membrane keyboard Memory Program memory 2 MB Supply voltage Rated voltage +24 VDC Range, permissible 20.4 V to 28.8 V (-15 %, +20 %) Transients, maximum permissible 35 V (500 msec) Time between two transients, minimum 50 s Current input * Typical * Constant current, maximum * Power on current surge I2t * * * Fuse, internal Electronic TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Approx. 300 mA Approx. 500 mA Approx. 0.5 A2s 331 Specifications 12.8 Description of the Interfaces 12.8 Description of the Interfaces 12.8.1 Power Supply Plug connector, 2-pin PIN 12.8.2 Assignment 1 +24 VDC 2 GND 24 V X10/IF 1B (RS 422/RS 485) Sub-d socket, 9-pin, with screw lock PIN 1) 332 Assignment for the RS 422 Assignment for the RS 485 1 n. c. n. c. 2 GND 24 V GND 24 V 3 TxD+ Data channel B (+) 4 RD+ RTS 1) 5 GND 5 V, floating GND 5 V, floating 6 +5 VDC, floating +5 VDC, floating 7 +24 VDC, out (max. 100 mA) +24 VDC, out (max. 100 mA) 8 TxD- Data channel A (-) 9 RxD- RTS 1) On pin 4 or pin 9, can be set with DIP switch on the rear of the device TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Specifications 12.8 Description of the Interfaces 12.8.3 X20 (USB) USB standard connector 12.8.4 PIN Assignment 1 +5 VDC, out, 2 USB-DN 3 USB-DP 4 GND on TP 177A, TP 177B 6", OP 177B: 100 mA on the TP 177B 4": 500 mA X1 (PROFINET) RJ45 plug connector PIN 1 Assignment TX+ 2 TX- 3 RX+ 4 n.c. 5 n.c. 6 RX- 7 n.c. 8 n.c. Each PROFINET port features one green and one yellow LED. These LEDs show the status of the PROFINET communication. The following table shows the meaning of the LEDs: Green "LINK" LED Yellow "RX/TX" LED Meaning off off There is no PROFINET connection. on off PROFINET communication possible. on on Data is being sent over the PROFINET connection. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 333 Specifications 12.8 Description of the Interfaces 334 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 A Appendix A.1 ESD Guidelines What does ESD mean? All electronic modules are equipped with highly integrated modules or components. Based on their design, these electronic components are highly sensitive to overvoltage and thus to discharge of static electricity. These electronic components are therefore specially identified as ESD. Abbreviations The following abbreviations are commonly used for electrostatic sensitive devices: ESD - Electrostatic Sensitive Devices ESD - Electrostatic Sensitive Device as common international designation Labeling ESD modules are labeled with the following symbol: TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 335 Appendix A.1 ESD Guidelines Electrostatic charge CAUTION Electrostatic charge ESDs may be destroyed by voltages well below the perception threshold of persons. Voltages of this kind develop when a component or an assembly is touched by a person who is not grounded against static electricity. Usually, it is unlikely that damage to an ESD as a result of overvoltage is detected immediately but may become apparent only after a longer period of operation. Prevent electrostatic charge of your body before you touch the ESD! Anyone who is not connected to the electrical potential of their surroundings is subjected to electrostatic charge. 9ROWDJH The figure indicates the maximum electrostatic charge anyone is subjected to when contacting the materials shown. These values correspond with specifications to IEC 801-2. >N9@ >@ 5HODWLYHKXPLGLW\ 336 Synthetic materials Wool Antistatic materials such as wood or concrete TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Appendix A.2 System Alarms Protective Measures against Discharge of Static Electricity CAUTION Grounding Measures When working with electrostatic sensitive devices, make sure that the person, the workplace and the packaging are properly grounded. This helps to avoid electrostatic charge. As a rule, only touch the ESD if this is unavoidable. Example: for maintenance. When you touch modules, make sure that you do not touch the pins on the modules or the PCB tracks. This prevents any discharge of static electricity to sensitive component and thus avoids damage. Discharge electrostatic electricity from your body if you are performing measurements on an ESD. To do so, touch a grounded metallic object. Always use grounded measuring instruments. A.2 System Alarms Introduction System alarms on the HMI device provide information about internal states of the HMI device and PLC. The overview below shows the causes of system alarms and how to eliminate the cause of error. Depending on scope of functions, only parts of the system alarms described in this section apply to the various HMI devices. Note System alarms are only indicated if an alarm window was configured. System alarms are output in the language currently set on your HMI device. System Alarm Parameters System alarms may contain encrypted parameters which are relevant to troubleshooting because they provide a reference to the source code of the Runtime software. These parameters are output after the text "Error code:" TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 337 Appendix A.2 System Alarms Meaning of the System Alarms Number Effect/cause Remedy 10000 The print job could not be started or was canceled due to an unknown error. Faulty printer setup. Or: No permission is available for accessing the network printer. Power supply failure during data transfer. Check the printer settings, cable connections and the power supply. Set up the printer once again. Obtain a network printer authorization. If the error persists, contact the Hotline! 10001 No printer is installed or a default printer has not been set up. Install a printer and/or select it as the default printer. 10002 Overflow of the graphics buffer for printing. Up to two images are buffered. Allow sufficient intervals between successive print jobs. 10003 Images can now be buffered again. -- 10004 Overflow of the buffer for printing lines in text mode (e.g.alarms). Up to 1000 lines are buffered. Allow sufficient intervals between successive print jobs. 10005 Text lines can now be buffered again. -- 10006 The Windows printing system reports an error. Refer to the output text and the error ID to determine the possible causes. Nothing is printed or the print is faulty. Repeat the action if necessary. 20010 An error has occurred in the specified script line. Execution of the script was therefore aborted. Note the system alarm that may have occurred prior to this. Select the specified script line in the configuration. Ensure that the tags used are of the allowed types. Check system functions for the correct number and types of parameters. 20011 An error has occurred in a script that was called by the specified script. Execution of the script was therefore aborted in the called script. Take the system alarm that may have occurred prior to this into account. In the configuration, select the script that has been called directly or indirectly by the specified script. Ensure that the tags used are of the allowed types. Check the system functions for the correct number and type of parameters. 20012 The configuration data is inconsistent. The script could therefore not be generated. Recompile the configuration. 20013 The scripting component of WinCC flexible Runtime Reinstall WinCC flexible Runtime. is not correctly installed. Therefore, no scripts can be executed. 20014 The system function returns a value that is not written in any return tag. Select the specified script in the configuration. Check if the script name has been assigned a value. 20015 Too many successive scripts have been triggered in short intervals. When more than 20 scripts are queued for processing, any subsequent scripts are rejected. In this case, the script indicated in the alarm is not executed. Find what is triggering the scripts. Extend the times, e.g. the polling time of the tags which trigger the scripts. 30010 The tag could not accept the function result, e.g. when it has exceeded the value range. Check the tag type of the system function parameter. 30011 A system function could not be executed because the function was assigned an invalid value or type in the parameter. Check the parameter value and tag type of the invalid parameter. If a tag is used as a parameter, check its value. 40010 The system function could not be executed since the parameters could not be converted to a common tag type. Check the parameter types in the configuration. 338 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Appendix A.2 System Alarms Number Effect/cause Remedy 40011 The system function could not be executed since the parameters could not be converted to a common tag type. Check the parameter types in the configuration. 50000 The HMI device is receiving data faster than it is capable of processing. Therefore, no further data is accepted until all current data have been processed. Data exchange then resumes. -- 50001 Data exchange has been resumed. -- 60000 This alarm is generated by the "DisplaySystemAlarms" function. The text to be displayed is transferred to the function as a parameter. -- 60010 The file could not be copied in the direction defined because one of the two files is currently open or the source/target path is not available. It is possible that the Windows user has no access rights to one of the two files. Restart the system function or check the paths of the source/target files. Using Windows NT/2000/XP: The user executing WinCC flexible Runtime must be granted access rights for the files. 60011 An attempt was made to copy a file to itself. It is possible that the Windows user has no access rights to one of the two files. Check the path of the source/target file. Using Windows NT/2000/XP with NTFS: The user executing WinCC flexible Runtime must be granted access rights for the files. 70010 The application could not be started because it could not be found in the path specified or there is insufficient memory space. Check if the application exists in the specified path or close other applications. 70011 The system time could not be modified. The error alarm only appears in connection with area pointer "Date/time PC". Possible causes: * An invalid time was transferred in the job mailbox. * The Windows user has no right to modify the system time. Check the time which is to be set. Using Windows NT/2000/XP: The user executing WinCC flexible Runtime must be granted the right to change the system time of the operating system. If the first parameter in the system alarm is displayed with the value 13, the second parameter indicates the byte containing the incorrect value. 70012 An error occurred when executing the function "StopRuntime" with the option "Runtime and operating system". Windows and WinCC flexible Runtime are not closed. One possible cause is that other programs cannot be closed. 70013 The system time could not be modified because an Check the time which is to be set. invalid value was entered. Incorrect separators may have been used. 70014 The system time could not be modified. Possible causes: * An invalid time was transferred. * The Windows user has no right to modify the system time. * Windows rejects the setting request. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Close all programs currently running. Then close Windows. Check the time which is to be set. Using Windows NT/2000/XP: The user executing WinCC flexible Runtime must be granted the right to change the system time of the operating system. 339 Appendix A.2 System Alarms Number Effect/cause Remedy 70015 The system time could not be read because Windows rejects the reading function. -- 70016 An attempt was made to select a screen by means of a system function or job. This is not possible because the screen number specified does not exist. Or: A screen could not be generated due to insufficient system memory. Check the screen number in the function or job with the screen numbers configured. Assign the number to a screen if necessary. 70017 Date/Time is not read from the area pointer because the address set in the controller is either not available or has not been set up. Change the address or set up the address in the controller. 70018 Acknowledgment that the password list has been successfully imported. -- 70019 Acknowledgment that the password list has been successfully exported. -- 70020 Acknowledgment for activation of alarm reporting. -- 70021 Acknowledgment for deactivation of alarm reporting. -- 70022 Acknowledgment to starting the Import Password List action. -- 70023 Acknowledgment to starting the Export Password List action. -- 70024 The value range of the tag has been exceeded in the system function. The calculation of the system function is not performed. Check the desired calculation and correct it if necessary. 70025 The value range of the tag has been exceeded in the system function. The calculation of the system function is not performed. Check the desired calculation and correct it if necessary. 70026 No other screens are stored in the internal screen memory. No other screens can be selected. -- 70027 The backup of the RAM file system has been started. -- 70028 The files from the RAM have been copied in the Flash memory. The files from the RAM have been copied in the Flash memory. Following a restart, these saved files are copied back to the RAM file system. -- 70029 Backup of the RAM file system has failed. No backup copy of the RAM file system has been made. Check the settings in the "Control Panel > OP" dialog and save the RAM file system using the "Save Files" button in the "Persistent Storage" tab. 70030 The parameters configured for the system function are faulty. The connection to the new controller was not established. Compare the parameters configured for the system function with the parameters configured for the controllers and correct them as necessary. 70031 The controller configured in the system function is not an S7 controller. The connection to the new controller was not established. Compare the S7 controller name parameter configured for the system function with the parameters configured for the controller and correct them as necessary. 340 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Appendix A.2 System Alarms Number Effect/cause Remedy 70032 The object configured with this number in the tab order is not available in the selected screen. The screen changes but the focus is set to the first object. Check the number of the tab order and correct it if necessary. 70033 An e-mail cannot be sent because a TCP/IP connection to the SMTP server no longer exists. This system alarm is generated only at the first attempt. All subsequent unsuccessful attempts to send an e-mail will no longer generate a system alarm. The event is regenerated when an e-mail has been successfully sent in the meantime. The central e-mail component in WinCC flexible Runtime attempts, in regular intervals (1 minute), to establish the connection to the SMTP server and to send the remaining e-mails. Check the network connection to the SMTP server and re-establish it if necessary. 70034 Following a disruption, the TCP/IP connection to the SMTP server could be re-established. The queued e-mails are then sent. -- 70036 No SMTP server for sending e-mails is configured. An attempt to connect to an SMTP server has failed and it is not possible to send e-mails. WinCC flexible Runtime generates the system alarm after the first attempt to send an e-mail. Configure an SMTP server: 70037 An e-mail cannot be sent for unknown reasons. The contents of the e-mail are lost. Check the e-mail parameters (recipient etc.). 70038 The SMTP server has rejected sending or forwarding an e-mail because the domain of the recipient is unknown to the server or because the SMTP server requires authentication. The contents of the e-mail are lost. Check the domain of the recipient address or deactivate the authentication on the SMTP server if possible. SMTP authentication is currently not used in WinCC flexible Runtime. 70039 The syntax of the e-mail address is incorrect or contains illegal characters. The contents of the e-mail are discarded. Check the e-mail address of the recipient. 70040 The syntax of the e-mail address is incorrect or contains illegal characters. -- 70041 The import of the user management was aborted due to an error. Nothing was imported. Check your user management or transfer it again to the panel. 80001 The log specified is filled to the size defined (in percent) and must be stored elsewhere. Store the file or table by executing a `move' or `copy' function. 80002 A line is missing in the specified log. -- 80003 The copying process for logging was not successful. In this case, it is advisable to check any subsequent system alarms, too. -- 80006 Since logging is not possible, this causes a permanent loss of the functionality. In the case of databases, check if the corresponding data source exists and start up the system again. 80009 A copying action has been completed successfully. -- TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 In WinCC flexible Engineering System using "Device settings > Device settings" In the Windows CE operating system using "Control Panel > Internet Settings > E-mail > SMTP Server" 341 Appendix A.2 System Alarms Number Effect/cause Remedy 80010 Since the storage location was incorrectly entered in WinCC flexible, this causes a permanent loss of the functionality. Configure the storage location for the respective log again and restart the system when the full functionality is required. 80012 Log entries are stored in a buffer. If the values are read to the buffer faster than they can be physically written (using a hard disk, for example), overloading may occur and recording is then stopped. Archive fewer values. Or: Increase the logging cycle. 80013 The overload status no longer applies. Archiving resumes the recording of all values. -- 80014 The same action was triggered twice in quick succession. Since the process is already in operation, the action is only carried out once. -- 80015 This system alarm is used to report DOS or database errors to the user. -- 80016 The logs are separated by the system function "CloseAllLogs" and the incoming entries exceed the defined buffer size. All entries in the buffer are deleted. Reconnect the logs. 80017 The number of incoming events cause a buffer overflow. his can be caused, for example, by several copying actions being activated at the same time. All copy jobs are deleted. Stop the copy action. 80019 The connection between WinCC flexible and all -- logs were closed, for example, after executing the system function "CloseAllLogs". Entries are written to the buffer and are then written to the logs when a connection is re-established. There is no connection to the storage location and the storage medium may be replaced, for example. 80020 The maximum number of simultaneously copy operations has been exceeded. Copying is not executed. Wait until the current copying actions have been completed, then restart the last copy action. 80021 An attempt was made to delete a log which is still busy with a copy action. Deletion has not been executed. Wait until the current copying actions have been completed, then restart the last action 80022 An attempt was made to start a sequence log, which is not a sequence log, from a log using the system function "StartSequenceLog". No sequence log file is created. In the project, check * if the "StartSequenceLog" system function was properly configured * if the tag parameters are properly provided with data on the HMI device 80023 An attempt was made to copy a log to itself. The log is not copied. In the project, check * if the "CopyLog" system function was properly configured * if the tag parameters are properly provided with data on the HMI device 80024 The "CopyLog" system function does not allow copying when the target log already contains data ("Mode" parameter). The log is not copied. Edit the "CopyLog" system function in the project if necessary. Before you initiate the system function, delete the destination log file. 342 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Appendix A.2 System Alarms Number Effect/cause Remedy 80025 You have canceled the copy operation. Data written up to this point are retained. The destination log file (if configured) is not deleted. The cancellation is reported by an error entry $RT_ERR$ at the end of the destination log. -- 80026 This alarm is output after all logs are initialized. Values are written to the logs from then on. Prior to this, no entries are written to the logs, irrespective whether WinCC flexible Runtime is active or not. -- 80027 The internal Flash memory has been specified as the storage location for a log. This is not permissible. No values are written to this log and the log file is not created. Configure "Storage Card" or a network path as the storage location. 80028 The alarm returns a status report indicating that the logs are currently being initialized. No values are logged until the alarm 80026 is output. -- 80029 The number of logs specified in the alarm could not be initialized. The logs are initialized. The faulty log files are not available for logging jobs. Evaluate the additional system alarms, related to this alarm which is also generated. Check the configuration, the ODBC (Open Database Connectivity) and the specified drive. 80030 The structure of the existing log file does not match the expected structure. Logging is stopped for this log. Delete the existing log data manually, in advance. 80031 The log in CSV format is corrupted. The log cannot be used. Delete the faulty file. 80032 Logs can be assigned events. These are triggered as soon as the log is full. If WinCC flexible Runtime is started and the log is already full, the event is not triggered. The log specified no longer logs data because it is full. Close WinCC flexible Runtime, delete the log, then restart WinCC flexible Runtime. Or: Configure a button which contains the same actions as the event and press it. 80033 "System Defined" is set in the data log file as the Install MSDE again. data source name. This causes an error. No data is written to the database logs, whereas the logging to the CSV logs works. 80034 An error has occurred in the initialization of the No action is necessary. However, it is recommended to logs. An attempt has been made to create the save the backup files or delete them in order to make the tables as a backup. This action was successful. space available again. A backup has been made of the tables of the corrupted log file and the cleared log was restarted. 80035 An error has occurred in the initialization of the logs. An attempt has been made to create backups of the tables and this has failed. No logging or backup has been performed. It is recommended to save the backups or to delete them in order to release memory. 80044 The export of a log was interrupted because Runtime was closed or due to a power failure. It was detected that the export needed to be resume when Runtime restarted. The export resumes automatically. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 343 Appendix A.2 System Alarms Number Effect/cause Remedy 80045 The export of a log was interrupted due to an error in the connection to the server or at the server itself. The export is repeated automatically. Check: * the connection to the server * if the server is running * if there is enough free space on the server. 80046 The destination file could not be written while exporting the log. Check if there is enough space on the server and it you have permission to create the log file. 80047 The log could not be read while exporting it. Check if the storage medium is correctly inserted. 80048 -- -- 80049 The log could not be renamed while preparing to export it. The job can not be completed." Check if the storage medium is correctly inserted and if there is sufficient space on the medium. 80050 The log which shall be exported is not closed. The job can not be completed. Make sure the "CloseAll Logs" system function is called before using the "ExportLog" system function. Change the configuration as required. 90024 No operator actions can be logged due to lack of space on the storage medium for log. The operator action will therefore not be executed. Make more space available by inserting an empty storage medium or swapping out the log files on the server using "ExportLog". 90025 Because of error state of the archive no user actions can be logged. Therefore the user action will not be executed. Check if the storage medium is correctly inserted. 90026 No operator actions can be logged because the log is closed. The operator action will therefore not be executed. Before further operator actions are carried out, the log must be opened again using the system function "OpenAllLogs". Change the configuration as required. 90029 Runtime was closed during ongoing operation (perhaps due to a power failure) or an a storage medium in use is incompatible with Audit Trail. An Audit Trail is not suitable if it belongs to another project or has already be archived. Ensure that you are using the correct storage medium. 90030 Runtime was closed during ongoing operation (perhaps due to a power failure). -- 90031 Runtime was closed during ongoing operation (perhaps due to a power failure). -- 90032 Running out of space on the storage medium for log. Make more space available by inserting an empty storage medium or swapping out the log files on the server using "ExportLog". 90033 No more space on the storage medium for log. As of now, no more operator actions requiring logging will be executed. Make more space available by inserting an empty storage medium or swapping out the log files on the server using "ExportLog". 90040 Audit Trail is switched off because of a forced user action. Activate the "Audit Trail" again using the system function "StartLog". 90041 A user action which has to be logged has been executed without a logged on user. A user action requiring logging should only be possible with permission. Change the configuration by setting a required permission for the input object. 90044 A user action which has to be confirmed was blocked, because there is another user action pending. Repeat the user action if necessary. 110000 The operating mode was changed. "Offline" mode is now set. -- 110001 The operating mode was changed. "Online" mode is now set. -- 344 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Appendix A.2 System Alarms Number Effect/cause Remedy 110002 The operating mode was not changed. Check the connection to the controllers. Check if the address area for the area pointer 88 "Coordination" in the controller is available. 110003 The operating mode of the specified controller was changed by the system function "SetConnectionMode". The operating mode is now "offline". -- 110004 The operating mode of the specified controller has been changed by the system function "SetConnectionMode". The operating mode is now "online". -- 110005 An attempt was made to use the system function SetConnectionMode to switch the specified controller to "online" mode, although the entire system is in "offline" mode. This changeover is not allowed. The controller remains in "offline" mode. Switch the complete system to "online" mode, then execute the system function again. 110006 The content of the "project version" area pointer does not match the user version configured in WinCC flexible. WinCC flexible Runtime is therefore closed. Check: * the project version entered on the controller * the project version entered in WinCC flexible 120000 The trend is not displayed because you configured an incorrect axis to the trend or an incorrect trend. Change the configuration. 120001 The trend is not displayed because you configured an incorrect axis to the trend or an incorrect trend. Change the configuration. 120002 The trend is not displayed because the tag assigned attempts to access an invalid controller address. Check if the data area for the tag exists in the controller, the configured address is correct and the value range for the tag is correct. 130000 The action was not executed. Close all other programs. Delete files no longer required from the hard disk. 130001 The action was not executed. Delete files no longer required from the hard disk. 130002 The action was not executed. Close all other programs. Delete files no longer required from the hard disk. 130003 No data medium found. The operation is canceled. Check, for example, if * the correct data medium is being accessed * the data medium is inserted 130004 The data medium is write-protected. The operation is canceled. Check if access has been made to the correct data carrier. Remove the write protection. 130005 The file is read only. The operation is canceled. Check if access has been made to the correct file. Edit the file attributes if necessary. 130006 Access to file failed. The operation is canceled. Check, for example, if * the correct file is being accessed * the file exists * another action is preventing simultaneous access to the file 130007 The network connection is interrupted. Data records cannot be saved or read over the network connection. Check the network connection and eliminate the cause of error. 130008 The storage card is not available. Data records cannot be saved to / read from the storage card. Insert the storage card. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 345 Appendix A.2 System Alarms Number Effect/cause Remedy 130009 The specified folder does not exist on the storage card. Any files saved to this directory are not backed up when you switch off the HMI device. Insert the storage card. 130010 The maximum nesting depth can be exhausted when, for example, a value change in a script results in the call of another script and the second script in turn has a value change that results in the call of yet a further script etc. The configured functionality is not supported. Check the configuration. 140000 An online connection to the controller is established. -- 140001 The online connection to the controller was shut down. -- 140003 No tag updating or writing is executed. Check the connection and if the controller is switched on. Check the parameter definitions in the Control Panel using "Set PG/PC interface". Restart the system. 140004 No tag update or write operations are executed because the access point or the module configuration is faulty. Verify the connection and check if the controller is switched on. Check the access point or the module configuration (MPI, PPI, PROFIBUS) in the Control Panel with "Set PG/PC interface". Restart the system. 140005 No tag updating or writing is executed because the HMI device address is incorrect (possibly too high). Use a different HMI device address. Verify the connection and check ifthe controller is switched on. Check the parameter definitions in the Control Panel using "Set PG/PC interface". Restart the system. 140006 No tag updating or writing is executed because the baud rate is incorrect. Select a different baud rate in WinCC flexible (according to module, profile, communication peer, etc.). 140007 Tag are not updated or written because the bus profile is incorrect (see %1). The following parameter could not be written to the registry:: 1: Tslot 2: Tqui 3: Tset 4: MinTsdr 5: MaxTsdr 6: Trdy 7: Tid1 8: Tid2 9: Gap Factor 10: Retry Limit Check the user-defined bus profile. Check the connection and if the controller is switched on. Check the parameter definitions in the Control Panel using "Set PG/PC interface". Restart the system. 346 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Appendix A.2 System Alarms Number Effect/cause Remedy 140008 No tag updating or writing is executed because baud rate is incorrect. The following parameters could not be written to the registry: 0: General error 1: Wrong version 2: Profile cannot be written to the registry. 3: The subnet type cannot be written to the registry. 4: The Target Rotation Time cannot be written to the registry. 5: Faulty Highest Address (HSA). Check the connection and if the controller is switched on. Check the parameter definitions in the Control Panel using "Set PG/PC interface". Restart the system. 140009 Tags are not updated or written because the module for S7 communication was not found. Reinstall the module in the Control Panel using "Set PG/PC interface". 140010 No S7 communication partner found because the controller is shut down. DP/T: The option "PG/PC is the only master" is not set in the Control Panel under "Set PG/PC interface." Switch the controller on. DP/T: If only one master is connected to the network, disable "PG/PC is the only master" in "Set PG/PC interface". If several masters are connected to the network, enable these. Do not change any settings, for this will cause bus errors. 140011 No tag updating or writing is executed because communication is down. Check the connection and that the communication partner is switched on. 140012 There is an initialization problem (e.g. when WinCC flexible Runtime was closed in Task Manager). Or: Another application (e.g.STEP7) with different bus parameters is active and the driver cannot be started with the new bus parameters (transmission rate, for example). Restart the HMI device. Or: Run WinCC flexible Runtime, then start your other applications. 140013 The MPI cable is disconnected and, thus, there is no power supply. Check the connections. 140014 The configured bus address is in already in use by another application. Edit the HMI device address in the controller configuration. 140015 Wrong transmission rate Or: Faulty bus parameters (e.g.HSA) Or: OP address > HSA or: Wrong interrupt vector (interrupt does not arrive at the driver) Correct the relevant parameters. 140016 The hardware does not support the configured interrupt. Change the interrupt number. 140017 The set interrupt is in use by another driver. Change the interrupt number. 140018 The consistency check was disabled by SIMOTION Scout. Only a corresponding note appears. Enable the consistency check with SIMOTION Scout and once again download the project to the PLC. 140019 SIMOTION Scout is downloading a new project to the controller. Connection to the controller is canceled. Wait until the end of the reconfiguration. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 347 Appendix A.2 System Alarms Number 140020 Effect/cause Remedy The version in the controller and that of the project (FWX file) do not match. Connection to the controller is canceled The following remedies are available: Download the current version to the PLC using SIMOTION Scout. Regenerate the project using WinCC flexible ES, close WinCC flexible Runtime and restart with a new configuration. 150000 No more data is read or written. Possible causes: * The cable is defective. * The PLC does not respond, is defective, etc. * The wrong port is used for the connection. * System overload. Ensure that the cable is plugged in, the controller is operational, the correct interface is being used. Restart the system if the system alarm persists. 150001 Connection is up because the cause of the interruption has been eliminated. -- 160000 No more data is read or written. Possible causes: * The cable is defective. * The PLC does not respond, is defective, etc. * The wrong port is used for the connection. * System overload. Ensure that the cable is plugged in, the controller is operational, the correct interface is being used. Restart the system if the system alarm persists. 160001 Connection is up because the cause of the interruption has been eliminated. -- 160010 No connection to the server because the server identification (CLS-ID) cannot be determined. Values cannot be read or written. Check access rights. 160011 No connection to the server because the server identification (CLS-ID) cannot be determined. Values cannot be read or written. Check, for example, if * the server name is correct * the computer name is correct * the server is registered 160012 No connection to the server because the server identification (CLS-ID) cannot be determined. Values cannot be read or written. Check, for example, if * the server name is correct * the computer name is correct * the server is registered Note for advanced users: Interpret the value from HRESULT. 160013 The specified server was started as InProc server. This has not been released and may possibly lead to incorrect behavior because the server is running in the same process area as the WinCC flexible Runtime software. 160014 Only one OPC server project can be started on a Do not start a second project with OPC server PC/MP. An alarm is output when an attempt is functionality on the computer. made to start a second project. The second project has no OPC server functionality and cannot be located as an OPC server by external sources. 170000 S7 diagnostics events are not indicated because it is not possible to log in to the S7 diagnostics functions at this device. The service is not supported. 348 Configure the server as OutProc Server or Local Server. -- TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Appendix A.2 System Alarms Number Effect/cause Remedy 170001 The S7 diagnostics buffer cannot be viewed because communication with the controller is shut down. Set the controller to online mode. 170002 The S7 diagnostics buffer cannot be viewed because reading of the diagnostics buffer (SSL) was canceled with error. -- 170003 An S7 diagnostics event cannot be visualized. The system returns internal error %2. -- 170004 An S7 diagnostics event cannot be visualized. The system returns an internal error of error class %2, error number %3. -- 170007 It is not possible to read the S7 diagnostics buffer (SSL) because this operation was canceled with an internal error of class %2 and error code %3. -- 180000 A component/OCX received configuration data with a version ID which is not supported. Install a newer component. 180001 System overload because too many actions running in parallel. Not all the actions can be executed, some are rejected. Several remedies are available: * Increase the configured cycle times or basic clock. * Generate the alarms at a slower rate (polling). * Initiate scripts and functions at greater intervals. If the alarm appears more frequently: Restart the HMI device. 180002 The on-screen keyboard could not be activated. Possible causes: Reinstall WinCC flexible Runtime. "TouchInputPC.exe" was not registered due to a faulty Setup. 190000 It is possible that the tag is not updated. -- 190001 The tag is updated after the cause of the last error state has been eliminated (return to normal operation). -- 190002 The tag is not updated because communication with the controller is down. Select the system function "SetOnline" to go online. 190004 The tag is not updated because the configured tag address does not exist. Check the configuration. 190005 The tag is not updated because the configured controller type does not exist for this tag. Check the configuration. 190006 The tag is not updated because it is not possible to map the controller type in the data type of the tag. Check the configuration. 190007 The tag value is not modified because the connection to the controller is interrupted or the tag is offline. Set online mode or reconnect to the controller. 190008 The threshold values configured for the tag have been violated, for example, by * a value entered * a system function * a script Observe the configured or current threshold values of the tag. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 349 Appendix A.2 System Alarms Number Effect/cause Remedy 190009 An attempt has been made to assign the tag a value which is outside the permitted range of values for this data type. For example, a value of 260 was entered for a byte tag or a value of -3 for an unsigned word tag. Observe the range of values for the data type of the tags. 190010 Too many values are written to the tag (for example, in a loop triggered by a script). Values are lost because only up to 100 actions are saved to the buffer. Increase the time interval between multiple write actions. 190011 Possible cause 1: The value entered could not be written to the configured controller tag because the high or low limit was exceeded. Make sure that the value entered lies within the range of values of the control tags. The system discards the entry and restores the original value. Possible cause 2: 190012 The connection to the controller was interrupted. Check the connection to the PLC. It is not possible to convert a value from a source format to a target format, for example: Check the range of values or the data type of the tags. An attempt is being made to assign a value to a counter that is outside the valid, PLC-specific value range. A tag of the type Integer should be assigned a value of the type String. 190100 The area pointer is not updated because the address configured for this pointer does not exist. Type 1 Warning alarms 2 Error alarms 3 Controller acknowledgment 4 HMI device acknowledgment 5 LED mapping 6 Trend request 7 Trend transfer 1 8 Trend transfer 2 No.: consecutive number shown in WinCC flexible ES. Check the configuration. 190101 The area pointer is not updated because it is not possible to map the PLC type to the area pointer type. Parameter type and no.: See alarm 190100 -- 190102 The area pointer is updated after the cause of the last error state has been eliminated (return to normal operation). Parameter type and no.: See alarm 190100. -- 200000 Coordination is not executed because the address Change the address or set up the address in the configured in the controller does not exist/is not set. controller. 200001 Coordination is canceled because the write access to the address configured in the PLC is not possible. 350 Change the address or set the address in the controller at an area which allows write access. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Appendix A.2 System Alarms Number Effect/cause Remedy 200002 Coordination is not carried out at the moment because the address format of the area pointer does not match the internal storage format. Internal error 200003 Coordination can be executed again because the last error state is eliminated (return to normal operation). -- 200004 The coordination may not be executed. -- 200005 No more data is read or written. Possible causes: * The cable is defective. * The PLC does not respond, is defective, etc. * System overload. Ensure that the cable is plugged in and the controller is operational. Restart the system if the system alarm persists. 200100 Coordination is not executed because the address Change the address or set up the address in the configured in the controller does not exist/is not set. controller. 200101 Coordination is canceled because the write access to the address configured in the PLC is not possible. Change the address or set the address in the controller at an area which allows write access. 200102 Coordination is not carried out at the moment because the address format of the area pointer does not match the internal storage format. Internal error 200103 Coordination can be executed again because the last error state is eliminated (return to normal operation). -- 200104 The coordination may not be executed. -- 200105 No more data is read or written. Possible causes: * The cable is defective. * The PLC does not respond, is defective, etc. * System overload. Ensure that the cable is plugged in and the controller is operational. Restart the system if the system alarm persists. 210000 Jobs are not processed because the address configured in the controller does not exist/has not been set up. Change the address or set up the address in the controller. 210001 Jobs are not processed because read/write access to the address configured in the controller is not possible. Change the address or set up the address in the controller in an area which allows read/write access. 210002 Jobs are not executed because the address format of the area pointer does not match the internal storage format. Internal error 210003 The job buffer is processed again because the last error status has been eliminated (return to normal operation). -- 210004 It is possible that the job buffer will not be processed. -- 210005 A control request with an illegal number was initiated. Check the controller program. 210006 An error occurred while attempting to execute the control request. As a result, the control request is not executed. Observe the next/previous system alarms. Check the parameters of the control request. Recompile the configuration. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 351 Appendix A.2 System Alarms Number Effect/cause Remedy 220001 The tag is not downloaded because the associated communication driver / HMI device does not support the download of Boolean/discrete data types. Change the configuration. 220002 The tag is not downloaded because the associated communication driver / HMI device does not support write access to the data type BYTE. Change the configuration. 220003 The communication driver cannot be loaded. The driver may not be installed. Install the driver by reinstalling WinCC flexible Runtime. 220004 Communication is down and no update data is transferred because the cable is not connected or defective etc. Check the connection. 220005 Communication is up. -- 220006 The connection between the specified PLC and the specified port is active. -- 220007 The connection to the specified controller is interrupted at the specified port. Check if * the cable is plugged in * the controller is OK * the correct port is used * your configuration is OK (interface parameters, protocol settings, PLC address). Restart the system if the system alarm persists. 220008 The communication driver cannot access or open the specified port. The port may be in use by another application or the port used is not available on the destination device. There is no communication with the controller. Close all the applications which access this port and restart the computer. Use another port of the system. 230000 The value entered could not be accepted. The system discards the entry and restores the previous value. Either * the value range has been exceeded * illegal characters have been entered * the maximum permitted number of users has been exceeded Enter a practical value or delete any unneeded users. 230002 The currently logged in user is not granted write access rights. The system therefore discards the input and restored the previous value. Log on as a user with appropriate rights. 230003 Changeover to the specified screen failed because the screen is not available/configured. The current screen remains selected. Configure the screen and check the screen selection function. 230005 The value range of the tag has been exceeded in the IO field. The original value of the tag is retained. Observe the range of values for the tag when entering a value. 230100 During navigation in the web browser, the system returned a message which may be of interest to the user. The web browser continues to run but may not (fully) show the new page. Navigate to another page. 352 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Appendix A.2 System Alarms Number Effect/cause Remedy 230200 The connection to the HTTP channel was interrupted due to an error. This error is explained in detail by another system alarm. Data is no longer exchanged. Check the network connection. Check the server configuration. 230201 The connection to HTTP channel was established. Data is exchanged. -- 230202 WININET.DLL has detected an error. This error usually occurs when an attempt to connect to the server fails or the server refuses to connect because the client lacks the proper authorization. An unknown server certificate may also be the cause if the connection is encrypted by means of SSL. The alarm text provides details. This text is always in the language of the Windows installation because it is returned by the Windows OS. Process values are no longer exchanged. Depending on the cause: When an attempt to connect fails or a timeout error occurs: * Check the network connection and the network. * Check the server address. * Check if the web server is actually running on the destination computer. Faulty authorization: * The configured user name and/or password do not match those on the server. Establish consistency. When the server certificate is rejected: Certificate signed by an unknown CA ( ): * Either ignore this item in your project, or * Install a certificate that has been signed with a root certificate known to the client computer. The date of the certificate is invalid: * Either ignore this item in your project, or * Install a certificate with a valid date on the server. Invalid CN (Common Name or Computer Name): * Either ignore this item in your project, or * Install a certificate with a name that corresponds to that of the server address. 230203 Although a connection can be made to the server, the HTTP server refuses to connect because * WinCC flexible Runtime is not running on the server, or * the HTTP channel is not supported (503 Service unavailable). Error 503 Service unavailable: Check if WinCC flexible Runtime is running on the server the HTTP channel is supported. Other errors can only occur if the web server does not support the HTTP channel. The language of the alarm text depends on the web server. Data is not exchanged. 230301 An internal error has occurred. An English text explains the error in more detail. This may be caused by insufficient memory. OCX does not work. 230302 The name of the remote server cannot be resolved. Check the configured server address. The attempt to connect failed. Check if the DNS service is available on the network. 230303 The remote server is not running on the addressed computer. Wrong server address. The attempt to connect failed TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 -- Check the configured server address. Check if the remote server is running on the target computer. 353 Appendix A.2 System Alarms Number Effect/cause Remedy 230304 The remote server on the addressed computer is incompatible to VNCOCX. The attempt to connect failed. Use a compatible remote server. 230305 The authentication has failed because the password is incorrect. The attempt to connect failed. Configure the correct password. 230306 Error in the connection to the remote server. This may occur as a result of network problems. The attempt to connect failed. Check if * the bus cable is plugged in * there are network problems 230307 The connection to the remote server was shut down because * the remote server was shut down, or * the user instructed the server to close all connections. -- The connection is closed. 230308 This alarm provides information on the connection status. An attempt is made to connect. 240000 WinCC flexible Runtime is operating in demo mode. Install the authorization. You have no authorization or your authorization is corrupted. 240001 WinCC flexible Runtime is operating in demo mode. Load an adequate authorization / powerpack. Too many tags are configured for the installed version. 240002 WinCC flexible Runtime is operating with a time-limited emergency authorization. Restore the full authorization. 240003 Authorization failed. Without authorization, WinCC will run in demo mode. Restart WinCC flexible Runtime or reinstall it. 240004 Error while reading the emergency authorization. Restart WinCC flexible Runtime, install the authorization WinCC flexible Runtime is operating in demo mode. or repair the authorization (see Commissioning Instructions Software Protection). 240005 The Automation License Manager has detected an internal system fault. Possible causes: * A corrupt file * A defective installation * No free space for the Automation License Manager etc. Reboot the HMI device or PC. If this does not solve the problem, remove the Automation License Manager and install it again. 250000 The tag in the specified line in "Status force" is not updated because the address configured for this tag is not available. Check the set address and then verify that the address is set up in the controller. 250001 The tag in the specified line in "Status force" is not updated because the controller type configured for this tag does not exist. Check the set address. 250002 The tag in the specified line in "Status force" is not updated because it is not possible to map the controller type in the tag type. Check the set address. 250003 An attempt to connect to the PLC failed. The tags are not updated. Check the connection to the PLC. Check that the controller is switched on and is online. 354 -- TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Appendix A.2 System Alarms Number Effect/cause Remedy 260000 An unknown user or an unknown password has been entered in the system. The current user is logged off from the system. Log on to the system as a user with a valid password. 260001 The logged in user does not have sufficient authorization to execute the protected functions on the system. Log on to the system as a user with sufficient authorization. 260002 This alarm is triggered by the system function "TrackUserChange". -- 260003 The user has logged off from the system. -- 260004 The user name entered into the user view already exists in the user management. Select another user name because user names have to be unique in the user management. 260005 The entry is discarded. Use a shorter user name. 260006 The entry is discarded. Use a shorter or longer password. 260007 The logon timeout value entered is outside the valid Enter a logon timeout value between 0 and 60 minutes. range of 0 to 60 minutes. The new value is discarded and the original value is retained. 260008 An attempt was made to read a PTProRun.pwl file -- created with ProTool V 6.0 in WinCC flexible. Reading the file was canceled due to incompatibility of the format. 260009 You have attempted to delete the user "Admin" or "PLC User". These users are fixed components of the user management and cannot be deleted. If you need to delete a user, because perhaps you have exceeded the maximum number permitted, delete another user. 260012 The passwords entered in the "Change Password" dialog and the confirmation field are not identical. The password has not been changed. User will be logged off. You have to log on to the system again. Then enter the identical password twice to be able to change the password. 260013 The password entered in the "Change Password" dialog is invalid because it is already in use. The password has not been changed. User will be logged off. You have to log on to the system again. Then enter a new password that has not been used before. 260014 User has unsuccessfully attempted to log on 3 times in succession. The user has been locked out and assigned to group no. 0. You can log on to the system with your correct password. Only an administrator can change the assignment to a group. 270000 A tag is not indicated in the alarm because it attempts to access an invalid address in the controller. Check if the data area for the tag exists in the controller, the configured address is correct and the value range for the tag is correct. 270001 There is a device-specific limit as to how many alarms may be queued for output (see the operating instructions). This limit has been exceeded. The view no longer contains all the alarms. However, all alarms are written to the alarm buffer. -- 270002 The view shows alarms of a log for which there is no data in the current project. Wildcards are output for the alarms. Delete older log data if necessary. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 355 Appendix A.2 System Alarms Number Effect/cause Remedy 270003 The service cannot be set up because too many devices want to use this service. A maximum of four devices may execute this action. Reduce the number of HMI devices which want to use the service. 270004 Access to persistent buffer is not possible. Alarms cannot be restored or saved. If the problems persist at the next startup, contact Customer Support (delete Flash). 270005 Persistent buffer damaged: Alarms cannot be restored. If the problems persist at the next startup, contact Customer Support (delete Flash). 270006 Project modified: Alarms cannot be restored from the persistent buffer. The project was generated and transferred new to the HMI device; The error should no longer occur when the device starts again. 270007 A configuration problem is preventing the restore (a DLL is missing, a directory is unknown, etc.). Update the operating system and then transfer your project again to the HMI device. 280000 Connection is up because the cause of the interruption has been eliminated. -- 280001 No more data is read or written. Possible causes: * The cable is defective. * The PLC does not respond, is defective, etc. * The wrong port is used for the connection. * System overload. Check if * the cable is plugged in * the controller is OK * the correct port is used 280002 The connection used requires a function block in the controller. The function block has responded. Communication is now enabled. -- 280003 The connection used requires a function block in the controller. The function block has not responded. Check if * the cable is plugged in * the controller is OK * the correct port is used Restart the system if the system alarm persists. Restart the system if the system alarm persists. Remedy depends on the error code: 1: The function block must set the COM bit in the response container. 2: The function block must not set the ERROR bit in the response container. 3: The function block must respond within the specified time (timeout). 4: Go online to the PLC. 280004 The connection to the controller is interrupted. There is no data exchange at present. Check the connection parameters in WinCC flexible. Ensure that the cable is plugged in, the controller is operational, the correct interface is being used. Restart the system if the system alarm persists. 290000 The recipe tag could not be read or written. It is assigned the start value. The alarm can be entered in the alarm buffer for up to four more failed tags if necessary. After that, alarm 290003 is output. Check in the configuration that the address has been set up in the controller. 356 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Appendix A.2 System Alarms Number Effect/cause Remedy 290001 An attempt has been made to assign a value to a recipe tag which is outside the value range permitted for this type. The alarm can be entered in the alarm buffer for up to four more failed tags if necessary. After that, alarm 290004 is output. Observe the value range for the tag type. 290002 It is not possible to convert a value from a source format to a target format. The alarm can be entered in the alarm buffer for up to four more failed recipe tags if necessary. After that, alarm 290005 is output. Check the value range or type of the tag. 290003 This alarm is output when alarm number 290000 is triggered more than five times. In this case, no further separate alarms are generated. Check in the configuration that the tag addresses have been set up in the controller. 290004 This alarm is output when alarm number 290001 is triggered more than five times. In this case, no further separate alarms are generated. Observe the value range for the tag type. 290005 This alarm is output when alarm number 290002 is triggered more than five times. In this case, no further separate alarms are generated. Check the value range or type of the tag. 290006 The threshold values configured for the tag have been violated by values entered. Observe the configured or current threshold values of the tag. 290007 There is a difference between the source and target Insert the specified data recipe tag in the source structure of the recipe currently being processed. structure. The target structure contains an additional data recipe tag which is not available in the source structure. The data recipe tag specified is assigned its start value. 290008 There is a difference between the source and target Remove the specified data recipe tag in the specified structure of the recipe currently being processed. recipe from the project. The source structure contains an additional data recipe tag which is not available in the target structure and therefore cannot be assigned. The value is rejected. 290010 The storage location configured for the recipe is not Check the configured storage location. permitted. Possible causes: Illegal characters, write protection, data carrier out of space or does not exist. 290011 The data record with the specified number does not exist. Check the source for the number (constant or tag value). 290012 The recipe with the specified number does not exist. Check the source for the number (constant or tag value). 290013 An attempt was made to save a data record under a data record number which already exists. The action is not executed. The following remedies are available: * Check the source for the number (constant or tag value). * First, delete the data record. * Change the "Overwrite" function parameter. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 357 Appendix A.2 System Alarms Number Effect/cause Remedy 290014 The file specified to be imported could not be found. Check: * The file name * Ensure that the file is in the specified directory. 290020 Message reporting that the download of data records from the HMI device to the PLC has started. -- 290021 Message reporting that the download of data records from the HMI device to the PLC was completed. -- 290022 Message reporting that the download of data records from the HMI device to the PLC was canceled due to an error. Check in the configuration whether: * The tag addresses are configured in the controller * The recipe number exists * The data record number exist * The "Overwrite" function parameter is set 290023 Message reporting that the download of data records from the PLC to the HMI device has started. -- 290024 Message reporting that the download of data records from the PLC to the HMI device was completed. -- 290025 Message reporting that the download of data records from the PLC to the HMI device was canceled due to an error. Check in the configuration whether: * The tag addresses are configured in the controller * The recipe number exists * The data record number exist * The "Overwrite" function parameter is set 290026 An attempt has been made to read/write a data record although the data record is not free at present. This error may occur in the case of recipes for which downloading with synchronization has been configured. Set the data record status to zero. 290027 Unable to connect to the controller at present. As a result, the data record can neither be read nor written. Possible causes: No physical connection to the controller (no cable plugged in, cable is defect) or the controller is switched off. Check the connection to the PLC. 290030 This alarm is output after you selected screen Reload the data record from the storage location or retain which contains a recipe view in which a data record the current values. is already selected. 290031 While saving, it was detected that a data record with the specified number already exists. Overwrite the data record or cancel the action. 290032 While exporting data records it was detected that a file with the specified name already exists. Overwrite the file or cancel the process. 290033 Confirmation request before deleting data records. -- 358 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Appendix A.2 System Alarms Number Effect/cause Remedy 290040 A data record error with error code %1 that cannot be described in more detail occurred. The action is canceled. It is possible that the data record was not installed correctly on the controller. Check the storage location, the data record, the "Data record" area pointer and if necessary, the connection to the controller. Restart the action after a short time. If the error persists, contact Customer Support. Forward the relevant error code to Customer Support. 290041 A data record or file cannot be saved because the storage location is full. Delete files no longer required. 290042 An attempt was made to execute several recipe actions simultaneously. The last action was not executed. Trigger the action again after waiting a short period. 290043 Confirmation request before storing data records. -- 290044 The data store for the recipe has been destroyed and is deleted. -- 290050 Message reporting that the export of data records has started. -- 290051 Message reporting that the export of data records was completed. -- 290052 Message reporting that the export of data records was canceled due to an error. Ensure that the structure of the data records at the storage location and the current recipe structure on the HMI device are identical. 290053 Message reporting that the import of data records has started. -- 290054 Message reporting that the import of data records was completed. -- 290055 Message reporting that the import of data records was canceled due to an error. Ensure that the structure of the data records at the storage location and the current recipe structure on the HMI device are identical. 290056 Error when reading/writing the value in the specified line/column. The action was canceled. Check the specified line/column. 290057 The tags of the recipe specified were toggled from "offline" to "online" mode. Each change of a tag in this recipe is now immediately downloaded to the controller. -- 290058 The tags of the specified recipe were toggled from "offline" to "online" mode. Modifications to tags in this recipe are no longer immediately transferred to the controller but must be transferred there explicitly by downloading a data record. -- 290059 Message reporting that the specified data record was saved. -- 290060 Message reporting that the specified data record memory was cleared. -- 290061 Message reporting that clearing of data record memory was canceled due to an error. -- 290062 The data record number is above the maximum of 65536. This data record cannot be created. Select another number. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 359 Appendix A.2 System Alarms Number Effect/cause Remedy 290063 This occurs with the system function "ExportDataRecords" when the parameter "Overwrite" is set to No. An attempt has been made to save a recipe under a file name which already exists. The export is canceled. Check the "ExportDataRecords" system function. 290064 Message reporting that the deletion of data records has started. -- 290065 Message reporting that the deletion of data records has successfully completed. -- 290066 Confirmation request before deleting data records. -- 290068 Security request to confirm if all data records in the recipe should be deleted. -- 290069 Security request to confirm if all data records in the recipe should be deleted. -- 290070 The data record specified is not in the import file. Check the source of the data record number or data record name (constant or tag value). 290071 During the editing of data record values, a value was entered which exceeded the low limit of the recipe tag. The entry is discarded. Enter a value within the limits of the recipe tag. 290072 When editing data record values, a value was entered which exceeds the high limit of the recipe tag. The entry is discarded. Enter a value within the limits of the recipe tag. 290073 An action (e.g. saving a data record) failed due to an unknown error. The error corresponds to the status alarm IDS_OUT_CMD_EXE_ERR in the large recipe view. -- 290074 While saving, it was detected that a data record with the specified number already exists but under another name. Overwrite the data record, change the data record number or cancel the action. 290075 A data record with this name already exists. The data record is not saved. Please select a different data record name. 300000 Faulty configuration of process monitoring (e.g. using PDiag or S7-Graph): More alarms are queued than specified in the specifications of the CPU. No further ALARM_S alarms can be managed by the PLC and reported to the HMI devices. Change the controller configuration. 300001 ALARM_S is not registered on this controller. Select a controller that supports the ALARM_S service. 310000 An attempt is being made to print too many reports in parallel. Only one log file can be output to the printer at a given time; the print job is therefore rejected. Wait until the previous active log was printed. Repeat the print job if necessary. 310001 An error occurred on triggering the printer. The report is either not printed or printed with errors. Evaluate the additional system alarms related to this alarm. Repeat the print job if necessary. 360 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Appendix A.2 System Alarms Number Effect/cause Remedy 320000 The movements have already been indicated by another device. The movements can no longer be controlled. Deselect the movements on the other display units and select the motion control screen on the required display unit. 320001 The network is too complex. The faulty addresses cannot be indicated. View the network in STL. 320002 No diagnostics alarm selected. The unit belonging to the alarm could not be selected. Select a diagnostics alarm from the ZP_ALARM alarm screen. 320003 No alarms exists for the selected unit. The detail view cannot visualize any networks. Select the defective unit from the overview screen. 320004 The required signal states could not be read by the PLC. The faulty addresses cannot be found. Check the consistency between the configuration on the display unit and the PLC program. 320005 The project contains ProAgent elements which are not installed. ProAgent diagnostic functions cannot be performed. In order to run the project, install the optional ProAgent package. 320006 You have attempted to execute a function which is not supported in the current constellation. Check the type of the selected unit. 320007 No error-triggering addresses were found on the networks. ProAgent cannot indicate any faulty addresses. Switch the detail screen to STL layout mode and check the status of the addresses and exclusion addresses. 320008 The diagnostic data stored in the configuration are not synchronized with those in the PLC. ProAgent can only indicate the diagnostic units. Download the project to the HMI device again. 320009 The diagnostic data stored in the configuration are not synchronized with those in the PLC. The diagnostic screens can be operated as usual. ProAgent may be unable to show all diagnostic texts. Download the project to the HMI device again. 320010 The diagnostic data stored in the configuration are not synchronized with those in STEP7. The ProAgent diagnostics data is not up-to-date. Download the project to the HMI device again. 320011 A unit with the corresponding DB number and FB number does not exist. The function cannot be executed. Check the parameters of the "SelectUnit" function and the units selected in the project. 320012 The "Step sequence mode" dialog is no longer supported. Use the ZP_STEP step sequence screen from the corresponding standard project for your project. Instead of calling the Overview_Step_Sequence_Mode function, call the "FixedScreenSelection" function using ZP_STEP as the screen name. 320014 The selected controller cannot be evaluated for ProAgent. The Alarm view assigned to the "EvaluateAlarmDisplayFault" system function could not be found. Check the parameters of the "EvaluateAlarmDisplayFault" system function. 330022 Too many dialogs are open on the HMI device. Close all dialogs you do not require on the HMI device. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 361 Appendix A.2 System Alarms 362 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 B Abbreviations CPU Central Processing Unit CSV Comma Separated Values CTS Clear To Send DC Direct Current DCD Data Carrier Detect DIL Dual-in-Line (electronic chip housing design) DP Distributed I/O DSN Data Source Name DSR Data Set Ready DTR Data Terminal Ready EMC Electromagnetic Compatibility EN European standard ES Engineering System ESD Electrostatic Discharge, the components and modules endangered by such ESD Electrostatic Sensitive Device GND Ground HF High Frequency HMI Human Machine Interface IEC International Electronic Commission IF Interface IO Input and Output LED Light Emitting Diode MOS Metal Oxide Semiconductor MPI Multipoint Interface (SIMATIC S7) MS Microsoft MTBF Mean Time Between Failures n. c. Not connected OP Operator Panel PC Personal Computer PG Programming device PLC Programmable Logic Controller PPI Point-to-Point Interface (SIMATIC S7) RAM Random Access Memory RJ45 Registered Jack Type 45 RTS Request To Send TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 363 Abbreviations 364 RxD Receive Data SELV Safety Extra Low Voltage SP Service Pack STN Super Twisted Nematic Sub-D Subminiature D (plug) TAB Tabulator TCP/IP Transmission Control Protocol/Internet Protocol TFT Thin Film Transistor TxD Transmit Data UL Underwriter's Laboratory TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Glossary "Transfer" mode an operating mode of the HMI device in which an executable project is transferred from the configuration computer to an HMI device. Acknowledge Acknowledging an alarm confirms that you have noted it. AG Controller of the SIMATIC S5 series such as the AG S5-115U, for example Alarm logging Output of user-specific alarms to a printer, in parallel to their output to the HMI device screen. Alarm, acknowledging Acknowledging an alarm confirms that you have noted it. Alarm, activated Moment at which an alarm is triggered by the controller or HMI device. Alarm, deactivated Moment at which the initiation of an alarm is reset by the controller. Alarm, user-specific A user-specific alarm can be assigned to one of the following alarm classes: Error Operation User-specific alarm classes A user-specific alarm designates a certain operating status of the plant connected to the HMI device via the controller. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 365 Glossary Array Area reserved in configured screens for the input and output of values. AS Controller of the SIMATIC S7 series such as a SIMATIC S7-300 AS 511 Protocol of the programming device interface of a SIMATIC S5 controller Boot loader Used to start the operating system. Automatically started when the HMI device is switched on. A start screen appears during startup. After the operating system has been loaded, the Loader opens. Configuration PC General term for programming devices (PGs) and PCs on which plant projects are created using an engineering software. Control request Triggers a function via the controller. Controller General term for devices and systems with which the HMI device communicates, e.g. SIMATIC S7. Display duration Defines whether and how long a system alarm is displayed on the HMI device. EMC Electromagnetic compatibility is the ability of electrical equipment to function properly in its electromagnetic environment without influencing this environment. Engineering software Software for the creation of projects for process visualization - see also project, process visualization and runtime software 366 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Glossary Event Functions are triggered by defined incoming events. Events can be configured. Events which can be assigned to a button include "Press" and "Release", for example. Fault time Refers to the time interval between an activated and deactivated alarm. Figure Form of the visualization of all logically related process data for a plant. The visualization of the process data can be supported by graphic objects. Flash memory Non-volatile memory with EEPROM chips, used as mobile storage medium or as memory module installed permanently on the motherboard. Function key Key on the HMI device which supports user-specific functions. A function is assigned to the key in the configuration. The assignment of the keys may be specific to an active screen or not. Half brightness lifetime Time period until the brightness degrades to 50% of its original value. The specified value is dependent on the operating temperature. Hardcopy Output of the screen content to a printer. HMI device image a file which can be transferred from the configuration computer to the HMI device. The HMI device image contains the operating system and elements of the runtime software required to run a project. Infotext Configured information on objects within a project. An alarm infotext, for example, may contain information on the cause of the fault and troubleshooting routines. IO field Enables the input or output of values on the HMI device which are transferred to the controller. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 367 Glossary Notation System consisting of characters, symbols and rules. In particular used to define the write format of a programming language in data processing. Object Component of a project. Example: screen or alarm. Objects are used to view or enter texts and values on the HMI device. Operator control object Component of a project which is used to enter values and trigger functions. A button, for example, is an operator control object. Plant General term referring to machines, processing centers, systems, plants and processes which are operated and monitored on an HMI device. Process visualization Visualization of processes from the areas of production, logistics and services in text-based and graphics format. Configured plant screens allow operator intervention in active plant processes by means of the input and output data. Project Result of a configuration using an engineering software. The project normally contains several screens with embedded system-specific objects, basic settings and alarms. The project file of a project configured in WinCC flexible is saved under the file name extension *.hmi. You need to distinguish between the project on the configuration computer and that on an HMI device. A project may be available in more languages on the configuration PC than can be managed on the HMI device. The project on the configuration PC can also be set up for different HMI devices. Only the project set up for a particular HMI device can be transferred to that HMI device. Project file File which is generated based on a source file for a specific HMI device when the configuration is completed. The project file is transferred to the corresponding HMI device and is used to operate and monitor plants. Refer to Source file. Recipe Combination of tags forming a fixed data structure. The data structure configured can be assigned data on the HMI device and is then referred to as a data record. The use of recipes ensures that when a data record is downloaded, all the assigned data is transferred synchronously to the controller. 368 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Glossary Runtime software is a process visualization software which can be used to test a project on a configuration computer. Also refer to "Project" and "Engineering software." Screen object Configured object for operating and monitoring the system, e.g. a rectangle, an IO field or a recipe view. Source file File from which various project files can be created, depending on the configuration. The source file is not transferred and remains on the configuration computer. The file name extension of a source file is *.hmi. Refer to Source file, compressed and Project file. Source file, compressed Compressed form of the source file. Can be transferred in addition to the project file to the corresponding HMI device. "Enable Backtransfer" must be set in the project on the configuration computer. The file extension of a compressed source file is *.pdz. The standard memory location for a compressed source file is the external MMC. Refer to Source file. To restore a source file, it is necessary to use the same WinCC flexible version which was used to configure the project. STEP 7 Programming software SIMATIC S7, SIMATIC C7 and SIMATIC WinAC controllers. STEP 7 Micro/WIN Programming software for controllers of the SIMATIC S7-200 series. Symbolic IO field Box for the input/output of a parameter. Contains a list of default entries from which one can be selected. System alarms Assigned to the "System" alarm class. A system alarm refers to internal states on the HMI device and the controller. Tab order In the configuration, this sets the sequence in which objects are focused on pressing the key. TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 369 Glossary Tag Defined memory location to which values can be written to and read from. This can be done from the controller or the HMI device. Based on whether the tag is interconnected with the controller or not, we distinguish between "external" tags (process tags) and "internal" tags. Transfer The transfer of an executable project to the HMI device. 370 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Index A B Accessories Accessory kit, 22 Accessory kit, 22 Acknowledging Alarm, 282, 288 Error alarm, 282, 288 Address assignment in the TCP/IP network, 133 LAN network, 181 Addressing, 178 Admin, 242, 243, 274, 276 Alarm, 279, 284 Acknowledging, 282, 288 Editing, 283, 289 Alarm buffer, 24, 280, 285 Alarm class, 280, 281, 285, 287 Alarm event, 279, 284 Alarm indicator, 282, 288 Alarm line, 285 Alarm text window, 281 Alarm view, 280, 285 Alarm window, 280, 285 Alarms, 24 Displaying, 285 Alphanumerical screen keyboard, 233, 254, 256 Alphanumerical value changing, 257 Changing, 255 Entering, 255, 257 Alphanumerical values, 231 Changing, 234 Entering, 234 Ambient temperature Impermissible, 41 Angle adapter, 22 Appearance Slider control, 262 Approvals, 36 Automatic Transfer, 200 Automation License Manager, 224 Backing up, 203, 204, 206 With ProSave, 206 With WinCC flexible, 204 Backlighting Reducing, 158 Setting, 143 Backup, 142, 188 Registry information, 143 Registry Information, 156 Temporary files, 156 to external storage device, 142, 186 Backup to memory card, 105 Booting, 162 Bottom view, 16, 18, 19, 21 Brightness Changing, 157 Bus parameters Profile, 177 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 C Cable cross section, 55 Calculation functions, 24 Calibrating Touch screen, 87, 113, 143, 150 Care, 317 Certificate Delete, 185 Deleting, 142 Displaying, 142 Importing, 142, 185 Certifications, 31 Changing Brightness, 157 Character repeat, 142 Screen keyboard, 147 Clean screen, 318 Clearance TP 177A, 44 Climatic Shipping conditions, 38 371 Index Storage conditions, 38 Communications properties, 131 Compatibility conflict, 203 Configuration phase, 193 Configure Network, 179 Operating system, 138 Screen keyboard, 142, 146 Configuring Data channel, 93, 126 Interfaces, 60 Network, 129 Operating system, 81, 96 PC / PPI cable, 63 Configuring the network General procedure, 130 Connecting Configuration PC, 61 Connection sequence, 50 Controller, 58 Equipotential bonding, 53 HMI device, 50 Peripherals, 66 UPS, 58 USB device, 65 Connecting a configuration PC Connection configurator, 61 Connecting peripherals Wiring diagram, 66 Connecting the PLC Wiring diagram, 58 Connecting the terminal block, 56 Connection configurator Configuration PC, 61 Connection sequence, 50 Connections Number, 26, 27 Contrast Changing, 84, 111 Control Panel, 98, 141 MPI, 176 MPI / DP settings, 91, 120 Open, 142 Opening, 82, 98 Operating, 144 Password protection, 82, 97, 139 PROFIBUS, 176 Screen keyboard, 145 Controller Configuring the interface, 60 Controllers Number, 26, 27 Creating 372 Recipe data record, 302, 310 Currency, 143 D Data channel Authorizations, 197 Backing up, 197 Configuring, 93, 126 Enabling, 126 Locking, 126, 172 Parameter assignment, 143 Restoring, 197 Transferring, 197 Updating the operating system, 197 Data flow, 295 Date, 142 Setting, 153 Synchronizing, 154 Date and time, 231 Entering, 236, 258 Synchronizing, 109 Date format, 143, 155 Date/time properties, 142, 153 Decimal, 253 Decimal places, 231 Default gateway, 134, 181 Degree of protection, 43 Delay time Changing, 84 Setting, 143, 169 Delete Certificate, 185 Recipe data record, 304, 312 Deleting Certificate, 142 Device name For network operation, 131, 180 Setting, 143 DHCP, 134, 181 DIP switch Setting, 60 Direct connection, 132 Direct key, 249 disabling SecureMode, 140 disabling Password protection, 153 Display OP 177B, 331 TP 177A, 328 TP 177B 4", 329 TP 177B 6", 330 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Index Display format, 252 Displaying Certificate, 142 HMI device information, 143 Information on the TP 177B 4", 164 Memory information, 166 System information, 165, 166 DNS, 134, 182 Server, 178 DNS server, 129 Documentation Enclosed, 47 Domain Logon, 135 Double-click, 142 Setting, 148 E EC Declaration of Conformity, 30 Editing Recipe data record, 303, 311 Electrostatic charge, 336 Element list, 297, 309 E-Mail Setting, 143, 184 Emission, 33 Enhanced Recipe View, 296 Entering Alphanumerical value, 255, 257 Alphanumerical values, 231, 234 Date and time, 231, 236, 258 Numerical value, 253 numerical values, 232 Numerical values, 230 symbolic values, 235 Symbolic values, 231, 258 Text box, 251 Equipotential bonding Connecting, 53 Wiring diagram, 54 Equipotential Bonding Requirements, 53 Equipotential bonding cable, 53 Error alarm Acknowledging, 282, 288 Ethernet settings IP address, 181 Exporting Recipe data record, 315 External Keyboard, 144 Mouse, 144 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 F Factory setting With ProSave, 219 With WinCC flexible, 216 Feedback Optical, 247 File Backup, 110 Forcing Permissions in remote operation, 266 Formats, 230 Front view, 16, 17, 19, 20, 21 Function Additional, 25 Function keys, 73 Global function assignment, 248 Labeling, 78 Local function assignment, 248 Function test, 69 G Gauge, 260 H High frequency radiation, 29 HMI device Bottom view, 16, 18, 19, 21 Cold restart, 162 Connecting, 50 EMC-compliant mounting, 36 Front view, 16, 17, 19, 20 Information, 143 Initial startup, 194 Interfaces, 51, 52 Mounting, 42, 49 Mounting position, 41 Rear view, 17, 18, 20, 21 Recommissioning, 194 Restarting, 143 Side view, 16, 17, 19, 20 Switching off, 69 Switching on, 68 Testing, 68 HMI device image, 86, 112 HMI Input Panel Options, 146 373 Index I L Identification, 183 Importing Certificate, 142, 185 Recipe data record, 316 Info texts, 25 Information for the HMI device, 164 Security, 33 Infotext Displaying, 236, 259, 281, 287 Initial startup HMI device, 194 Input on the HMI device Using function keys, 248 Using operator controls, 227, 246 Input Panel, 142 Input unit OP 177B, 331 TP 177A, 328 TP 177B 4", 329 TP 177B 6", 330 Installing Option, 221, 223 Instructions Security, 29 Working on the control cabinet, 29 Interface Rated load, 65 Interfaces, 51, 52 Configuring, 60 Rated load, 67 TP 177B 4", 329 Interference Pulse-shaped, 37 Sinusoidal, 37 Internal clock, 154 Internet Settings, 143, 184 Internet settings, 136 IP address, 181 Ethernet, 181 Setting, 143 Labeling Certifications, 31 EC Declaration of Conformity, 30 Function keys, 78 Labeling strips Dimensions, 78 Printing, 78 LAN connection, 143 Language Setting, 229, 250 LEDs PROFINET interface, 333 License information, 89 License key, 224 Transferring, 225 Transferring back, 226 Limit value test, 231, 252 Limit values For password, 239 For user, 239 For user view, 239 Limits For password, 271 For user, 271 For user view, 271 Lists, 24 Loader, 81, 96, 138 Open, 139 Logoff User, 272 Users, 240 Logoff time, 238, 269 Logon Users, 239, 271 Logon data, 183 in the TCP/IP network, 135 K Keyboard External, 144 Keyboard properties, 103, 142 374 M MAC address, 133, 170 Maintenance, 317, 323 Manual Transfer, 199 Mechanical Shipping conditions, 38 Storage conditions, 38 Memory OP 177B, 331 TP 177A, 328 TP 177B 4", 329 TP 177B 6", 330 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Index Memory card, 23 Backup to, 105 Ejecting, 75 First use, 186 Inserting, 74, 76 removing, 77 Restoring file system, 156 Restoring from, 105 Memory information, 143 Displaying, 166 Memory management, 143, 167 Monitoring mode Sm@rtClient view, 265 Mounting, 49 EMC-compliant, 36 HMI device, 42 Horizontal mounting, 42 Vertical, 42 Mounting clamp, 42 Mounting cut-out Dimensions, 44 Preparing, 44 Mounting location Selecting, 43 Mounting position HMI device, 41 Mouse External, 144 Mouse properties, 104, 142 MPI Setting, 143, 176 MPI / DP settings, 91, 120 Multi-key operation, 248 Multimedia card, 73 MultiMedia card, 76 N Name server, 182 Name Server, 134 Network Configure, 179 Logon data, 143 Set up, 178 Setting, 181 Network & dial-up connections, 143 Network ID, 143 Network operation Device name, 180 Options, 143 Network settings, 133 Number format, 143, 155 Numerical TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Screen keyboard, 252 Numerical screen keyboard, 231 Numerical value Changing, 253 Decimal places, 253 Display format, 252 Entering, 253 Limit value test, 252 numerical values Changing, 232 Entering, 232 Numerical values Decimal places, 231 Entering, 230 Formats, 230 Limit value test, 231 O Offices, 7 Offline, 195 Recipe tag, 300 Test, 202 Online, 195 Recipe tag, 300 Test, 202 OP 177 Clearance, 44 OP properties, 86, 87, 92, 112, 113, 124, 143 Device, 164 Memory monitoring, 167 Persistent storage, 156 Touch, 150 Open Control Panel, 142 Loader, 139 Operate Recipe menu, 310 Recipe screen, 310 Operating Control Panel, 144 Operating elements OP 177B, 72 TP 177A and TP 177B 6", 71 TP 177B 4", 71 Operating mode Offline, 195 Online, 195 Overview, 195 Switching, 195 Transfer, 68, 195 Operating system Configure, 138 375 Index Configuring, 81, 96 Update via ProSave, 215 Updating, 208, 212 Updating using WinCC flexible, 214 Operation Recipe screen, 301 Operation feedback, 227, 246 Optical, 228 Operator control options, 144 Operator controls Recipe view, 301 Simple recipe view, 308 Optical feedback, 247 Optical operation feedback, 228 option, 221 Option Installing with ProSave, 223 Installing with WinCC flexible, 221 Removing with ProSave, 223 Removing with WinCC flexible, 222 Options, 26 Network operation, 143 P Parameter assignment Data channel, 143 Password Deleting, 90, 116 Entering, 90, 115 Password, 238 Password Restore, 239 Password Back up, 239 Password, 270 Password Restore, 271 Password Back up, 271 Password list, 238, 270 Password properties, 90, 115, 143, 151 Password protection, 82, 97, 139, 143 disabling, 153 Set up, 152 Windows CE taskbar, 139 PC / PPI Cable, 22 Configuring the cable, 63 Setting the adapter, 63 PC connection, 132 Peripherals Rated load, 67 376 Permission, 237, 269 Pin assignment PROFINET interface, 333 RJ45 plug connector, 333 PLC Reading recipe data record, 306, 313 Transferring recipe data record, 307, 314 PLC_User, 242, 243, 274, 276 Potential differences, 53 Potentially explosive atmosphere, 33 Power failure, 203 Power supply Cable cross section, 55 Connecting, 57 Connecting the terminal block, 56 Reverse polarity protection, 56 Setting, 143 State, 143 TP 177A, 328 Wiring diagram, 55 Printer Setting, 117 Setting properties, 143 Printer connection Setting, 160 Printer properties, 143, 160 Printing Labeling strips, 78 via a network printer, 129 Via network printer, 179 Process control phase, 193 PROFIBUS bus connector, 23 PROFIBUS DP Setting, 143, 176 PROFINET, 129, 178 Addressing, 178 PROFINET interface LEDs, 333 Pin assignment, 333 PROFINET IO Disabling direct keys, 170 Enabling direct keys, 170 Setting, 143 Project Closing, 244, 278 Offline testing, 202 Operating, 227, 246 Testing online, 202 transferring, 194 Protective cover, 319 Dismantling, 323 Installation, 321 Protective cover set, 23 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Index Protective foil, 23, 318 Protocol SIMATIC controllers, 26, 27 Third-party controllers, 28 Proxy Server, 184 Proxy server, 136 R Radiation High frequency, 29 Radio interference, 33 Range of functions additional, 25 Alarm buffer, 24 Alarms, 24 Calculation functions, 24 Info texts, 25 Lists, 24 Recipes, 25 Screens, 24 Tags, 24 Values, 24 Rated load Interface, 65, 67 Rated voltage, 45 Reading Recipe data record, 306 Reading out Recipe data record, 313 Real-time clock Internal, 154 Rear view, 17, 18, 20, 21 Recipe, 292 Control, 293 Data flow, 295 Data record, 293 Field of application, 291 Recipe screen, 296 Recipe view, 296 Synchronizing tags, 305 Recipe data record Creating, 302, 310 Delete, 304, 312 Editing, 303, 311 Exporting, 315 Importing, 316 Reading from PLC, 306, 313 Synchronize with PLC, 303 Transferring to PLC, 307, 314 Recipe list, 297, 309 Recipe menu TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Operate, 310 Recipe screen, 298 Operate, 310 Operating, 301 Overview, 298 Recipe tag Offline, 300 Online, 300 Synchronizing, 299, 305 Recipe view, 296 Expanded, 296 Menu commands, 309 Operator controls, 301, 308 Simple, 297 Recipes, 25 Recommissioning HMI device, 194 Record list, 297, 309 Regional and language settings, 143, 155 Regional settings, 155 Changing, 118 Registry information Backup, 110, 143 Registry Information Backup, 156 Remote control Forcing permission, 266 Removing Option, 222, 223 Representatives, 7 Resetting to factory settings, 209 Restore, 142, 186 from memory card, 105 Restoring, 203, 205, 207 from external storage device, 142, 188 From memory card, 156 With ProSave, 207 With WinCC flexible, 205 Reverse polarity protection, 56 RJ45 plug connector Pin assignment, 333 RS 422 / RS 232 converter, 22 Ruler, 245, 267 S S7 transfer settings, 143 Safety instruction Backlighting, 158 Changed tag name, 305 Cold restart, 162 Compatibility conflict, 203 Data channel, 208, 213 377 Index Data loss, 186, 208, 212 Device name, 170 Direct key, 249 Functional problem, 65 General, 33 License key, 213 Loss of data possible, 188 Memory card, 75, 77 Memory distribution, 166 Path, 168, 169 Power failure, 203 Preventing inadvertent operation, 317, 318 Project file, 168, 169 Recipe data record in background, 297 Remote control for channel 1, 173 Time-dependent reactions, 154 Transfer mode, 175 Transfer mode channel 2, 173 unauthorized cleaning products, 317 Unintentional response, 317, 318 Unintentional transfer mode, 173 USB connection sequence, 64 USB port, 65 Safety instructions High frequency radiation, 29 Potentially explosive atmosphere, 33 Working on the control cabinet, 29 Screen Changing the orientation, 84 Screen keyboard, 142, 230, 250 Alphanumerical, 233, 254, 256 Change layout, 146 Character repeat, 147 Configure, 146 For Control Panel, 145 Keyboard level, 254, 256 Keyboard levels, 233 Language change, 254, 256 Numerical, 231, 252 Representation types, 145 Setting the character repeat, 103 Symbolic, 235 Screen keyboard Outside an open project, 100 Screen saver, 143, 159 Setting, 92, 124, 158 Screen settings Changing, 143 Screen settings Changing, 84, 111 Screens, 24 SecureMode, 140 disabling, 140 378 Security, 237, 269 Security system, 237, 269 Selection list, 258 Service On the Internet, 7 Service pack, 323 Set up Network, 178 Password protection, 152 SecureMode, 140 Setting Backlighting, 143 Date, 108, 153 Date format, 155 Date/Time, 142 Delay time, 143, 169 Device name, 143 Double-click, 148 E-Mail, 143 E-mail connection, 184 IP address, 143 MPI, 143, 176 Name server, 143 Network, 181 Number format, 155 PC / PPI adapter, 63 Power supply, 143 Printer connection, 160 Printer properties, 143 PROFIBUS, 176 PROFIBUS DP, 143 PROFINET IO, 143 Regional data, 155 Screen saver, 158 Storage location, 168 Time, 108, 153 Time format, 155 UPS, 190 Setting the date, 108 Setting the delay time, 123 Setting the double-click, 104 Setting the time, 108 Setting the time zone, 108 Settings Internet, 143 Language, 143 Regional, 143 regional-specific, 155 S7-Transfer, 143 Shipping conditions, 38 Side view, 16, 17, 19, 20 Siemens HMI input panel options, 142 SIMATIC controller TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 Index Protocol, 26 Protocols, 27 Simple recipe view, 297 Simple Recipe View Menu commands, 309 Operator controls, 308 Slider control, 262 Appearance, 262 Sm@rtAccess, 26 Sm@rtClient view, 265 Monitoring mode, 265 Use, 265 Sm@rtService, 26 SMTP server, 136, 184 Software options, 26 Specifications TP 177A, 328 Start HMI device, 162 Starting HMI device, 112, 143 Status force, 263 Operating elements, 264 Status force view, 263 Storage conditions, 38 Storage device Restoring from external, 188 Saving to external, 186 Storage directories, 123 Storage location Setting, 168 Subnet mask, 134, 181 Supply voltage OP 177B, 331 TP 177B 4", 329 TP 177B 6", 330 Support On the Internet, 7 Switching off HMI device, 69 Switching on HMI device, 68 Symbolic screen keyboard, 235 symbolic values Changing, 235 Entering, 235 Symbolic values, 231 Changing, 258 Entering, 258 Synchronizing, 109 Date and time, 154 Recipe tag, 299, 305 System, 125 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1 System alarms Parameter, 337 System features, 143 System information Displaying, 125, 165, 166 System properties, 143 Device name, 180 General, 165 Memory, 166 T Tags, 24 Taskbar, 138 TCP/IP address, 133 Technical specifications Display, 328, 329, 330, 331 Input unit, 328, 329, 330, 331 Interfaces, 329 Memory, 328, 329, 330, 331 OP 177B, 331 PROFINET interface, 333 RJ45 interface, 333 Supply voltage, 328, 329, 330, 331 TP 177B 4", 329 TP 177B 6", 330 Technical Support, 7, 86, 112 Temporary files Backup, 156 Testing HMI device, 68 Text box, 251 Third-party controllers Protocols, 28 Time, 142 Entering, 236, 258 Setting, 153 Synchronizing, 154 Time format, 143, 155 Time zone Setting, 153 Time-dependent reactions, 154 Touch screen, 72 Calibrating, 87, 113, 143, 150 Note, 72 TP 177A Resetting to factory settings, 207 TP 177B Clearance, 44 TP 177B 4" Interfaces, 329 TP 177B 4" Displaying information, 164 379 Index Trademarks, 6 Training Center, 7 Transfer, 195 Automatic, 200 Cancel, 68 Manual, 199 Transfer mode MPI / PROFIBUS DP, 95 Unintentional, 94, 127, 173 Via MPI, 175 Via PROFIBUS DP, 175 Transfer settings, 95, 128, 143, 172 Channel, 172 Directories, 168, 169 transferring Project, 194 Transferring License key, 225 Recipe data record, 307, 314 Transferring back License key, 226 Transport damage, 47 Trend view, 244, 267 Value table, 245, 267 Trends Limit violation, 244, 267 Trends, 244 Trends, 267 Type of fixation, 42 In industry, 33 In residential areas, 33 In the potentially explosive atmosphere, 33 With additional measures, 39 User Logoff, 272 User data Back up, 239, 271 Restore, 239, 271 User group, 237, 269 User name, 183 User view, 238, 270 Users, 237, 269 Admin, 242, 243, 274, 276 Change password, 242 Changing group assignments, 242 Changing the logoff time, 242 Changing the user name, 242 Changing user data, 242 Creating, 241, 273 Deleting, 243, 276 Logoff, 240 Logon, 239, 271 PLC_User, 242, 243, 274, 276 U W Unintentional transfer mode, 94, 127, 173 Updating About ProSave, 215 Operating system, 64, 208, 212 using WinCC flexible, 214 Updating the operating system, 64 UPS Connecting, 58 Setting, 190, 191 Status, 191 Wiring diagram, 58 UPS properties Configuration, 190 USB Connection sequence, 64 USB connection sequence Safety instruction, 64 USB device Connecting, 65 Use Conditions, 39 WinCC flexible internet settings, 136 E-mail, 184 E-Mail, 143 Windows CE taskbar, 96, 138 Password protection, 97, 139 WINS, 182 Server, 178 WINS server, 129 Wiring diagram Connecting peripherals, 66 Connecting the equipotential bonding, 54 Connecting the PLC, 58 Connecting the power supply, 55 UPS, 58 Working on the control cabinet, 29 380 V Value table, 245, 267 Values, 24 TP 177A, TP 177B, OP 177B (WinCC flexible) Operating Instructions, 08/2008, 6AV6691-1DG01-0AB1